This is only a preview of the October 2014 issue of Silicon Chip. You can view 29 of the 104 pages in the full issue, including the advertisments. For full access, purchase the issue for $10.00 or subscribe for access to the latest issues. Items relevant to "Currawong Stereo Valve Amplifier: A Preview":
Items relevant to "Courtesy LED Light Delay For Cars":
Items relevant to "Digital Effects Processor For Guitars/Musical Instruments":
Items relevant to "Passive Direct Injection (DI) Box":
Items relevant to "Create Eerie Music With The Opto-Theremin, Pt.2":
Purchase a printed copy of this issue for $10.00. |
OCTOBER 2014
9
PP255003/01272
$ 95* NZ $ 12 90
INC GST
INC GST
HOW TO REMOVE RUST
BY ELECTROLYSIS
BOLT-BY-BOLT: PROJECTS TO BUILD: WE REVIEW:
Assembling
the new
Velleman
3D Printer
Digital
Effects
Processor
Signal Hound USB
Spectrum Analyser
covers 1Hz to 4.4GHz!
Passive
D-I
Box
Courtesy
Compact 2-Channel
Mixed Signal �SScope
from Rohde & Schwarz
Light
Delay
KITS BUILD THEM!
Online & in store
AV & Special Effects Kits
Crazy Cricket and Freaky Frog Kit
IR Remote Extender MKII Kit
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine June 2012
Designed to imitate the chirping noise of a
cricket or gentle croaking of a frog
(alternates at power up). It
activates in darkness and stops
when disturbed by light.
• PCB: 30 x 65mm
KC-5510
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine October 2006
Operate your DVD
player or digital
decoder using its
remote control from
another room. Picks
up the signal from the
remote control
and sends it via a 2-wire cable
to an infrared LED located close to
the device.
1995
$
Kit includes PCB, preprogrammed IC,
battery and electronic components.
• Requires 9VDC and
2-wire cable for
extending the IR-Tx lead
(use WB-1702 $0.50/m)
• PCB: 79 x 47mm
KC-5432
Jacob's Ladder MK3 Kit
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine Feb 2013
A spectacular rising ladder of bright and
noisy sparks for theatre special effects with
even more zing and zap than it's
previous design from April 2007.
$
Requires a VS Commodore 12V
ignition coil (available separately
from auto stores and parts recyclers).
4995
Kit includes case, screen printed front panel,
PCB with overlay and all electronic components.
Kit includes PCB, case and electronic components.
See website for alternate capacitors to suit.
USB Power Monitor Kit
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine Dec 2012
Plug this kit inline with a USB device to display the
current that is drawn at
any given time. Displays
current, voltage or power.
Auto-ranging and will
read as low as a few
microamps and up to
over an amp.
• PCB: 65 x 36mm
KC-5516
5995
$
Kit includes double sided, solder masked and screen-printed
PCB with SMD components pre-soldered, LCD screen, and
components. Laptop and USB lead not included.
2 Silicon Chip
• Powered from 8 - 25VDC
• No heatsink required!
• PCB: 85 x 46mm
KC-5530
NEW!
$
4995
To order call 1800 022 888
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine
August 2014
Convert a 240VAC freezer
into a fridge, a fridge into a
wine cooler or control
heaters in home-brew
setups, etc. or control 12V
or 24V fridges or freezers.
NEW!
3995
$
Kit includes short-form with PCB,
relay, temp sensor and components. Requires
case, sockets and cable to suit your configuration.
Automotive & Power Kits
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine October 2013
Like modern cars, this kit will turn your car
headlights on automatically when it gets dark.
Features under-voltage cut-out, adjustable light
sensitivity and switch-off delay.
95
Kit includes PCB with overlay, pre-machined
case and all specified components.
• 12VDC / 150mA
• Immune to relay chatter
problems
• Temp range: -23 to 47˚C
• PCB size: 80 x 104mm
KC-5529
Automatic Headlights Kit
39
$
7495
$
TempMaster Electronic
Thermostat MK3 Kit
Kit includes double sided, solder-masked and
screen-printed PCB, and ALL SMD components
pre-soldered to the PCB.
Home & Computer Kits
Mains Timer Kit for Fans & Lights
• Requires 12V power supply
(MP-3147 $17.95)
• PCB: 85 x 145mm
KC-5475
Mini-D 2 x 10W Class-D
Amplifier Kit
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine September 2014
Can deliver more
than 10W per
channel or 30W
mono. Features
on-board volume
control, low-power
shutdown mode and overtemperature/current protection.
Compact design and highly efficient.
Kit includes silk-screened PCB,
diecast enclosure (111 x 60 x 30mm),
pre-programmed PIC, PCB mount
components and pre-cut wire/ladder.
Ref: Silicon Chip Mag August 2012
This simple circuit provides a
turn-off delay for a 230VAC
light or a fan, such as a
bathroom fan set to run for a
short period after the
switch has been tuned off.
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine
March 2009
Create your own
eerie science fiction
sound effects by simply
moving your hand near the
antenna. Features
skew control to vary
the audio tone from
distorted to clean.
Easy to set up and
build.
New Jaycar Kits
• Powered from a 12V 7Ah SLA (SB-2486 $29.95)
or 12V car battery (not included)
KC-5520
• Consumes no standby
power when load is off
• PCB: 60 x 76mm
KC-5512
2695
$
Theremin Synthesiser
MKII Kit
• 11.5-15VDC
KC-5524
$
5995
Kit includes double sided, solder-masked and screenprinted PCB, diecast case, buzzer and electronic
components. Cabling not included. Some SMD
soldering required.
REGISTER
ONLINE
TODAY!
240V 10A Motor Speed Controller Kit
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine Feb/Mar 2014
An improvement on our successful
KC-5478 Motor Controller Kit.
Designed for
controlling typical
brush motor tools such
as electric drills, saws
and routers. The case
has the tricky cut-outs
pre-machined, but a little
bit of extra drilling is
required to complete the
project.
$
• Soft starting
• Over-load/current protection
KC-5526
14900
Kit includes machined case, overlay PCB and
electronic components.
SIGN UP NOW & BE REWARDED
Earn a point for every dollar spent at any Jaycar
Company store* & be rewarded with a $25 Rewards
Cash Card once you reach 500 points!
*Conditions apply.
See website for T&Cs
Register online today by visiting
www.jaycar.com.au/rewards
siliconchip.com.au
www.jaycar.com.au
Prices valid until 23/10/2014
Contents
Vol.27, No.10; October 2014
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Features
14 Review: Building The Velleman K8200 3D Printer
3D printers look set to be the next big thing. We take a close look at the popular
Velleman K8200 3D printer which you build yourself – by Alan Ford
27 How To Remove Rust By Electrolysis
You might be surprised at how easy it is to restore rusted items to their (almost!)
former glory using electrolysis – by Dr David Maddison
76 Review: Signal Hound USB-SA44B Spectrum Analyser
Currawong Stereo Valve Amplifier
Preview – Page 24.
USB-powered mini spectrum analysers based on SDR technology are evolving
fast. The Signal Hound USB-SA44B compares favourably with high-end selfcontained analysers, for a fraction of their price – by Jim Rowe
88 Review: Rohde & Schwarz HMO1002 2-Channel Scope
This ‘entry-level’ digital scope from Rohde & Schwarz features two channels,
50MHz bandwidth and a host of standard features – by Nicholas Vinen
Pro jects To Build
24 Currawong Stereo Valve Amplifier: A Preview
We swore we’d never do a stereo valve amplifier but we’ve finally given in. This
unit uses eight valves, delivers around 10W RMS/channel and even includes
remote volume control. Here’s a preview – by Leo Simpson & Nicholas Vinen
Courtesy LED Light
Delay For Cars – Page 34.
34 Courtesy LED Light Delay For Cars
If you swap your car’s interior filament lamps for LED lamps, then the delay
circuit may no longer work. This new courtesy light delay works with both
filament and LED lamps – by John Clarke
58 Digital Effects Processor For Guitars/Musical Instruments
Deceptively simple unit provides 10 different adjustable effects, including echo,
reverb, tremolo, fuzz, compression, flanging and phasing – by Nicholas Vinen
66 Passive Direct Injection (DI) Box
Hum and noise plaguing your performance? A DI box that converts an unbalanced signal from a musical instrument into a balanced output signal is the
answer – by John Clarke
Digital Effects Processor
For Guitars – Page 58.
82 Create Eerie Music With The Opto-Theremin, Pt.2
Second article on our versatile new Opto-Theremin completes the construction
and describes the test and adjustment procedure – by John Clarke
Special Columns
42 Serviceman’s Log
Sometimes you just have to give it a go – by Dave Thompson
72 Circuit Notebook
(1) PICAXE-Based Bistro Paging System; (2) Micromite-Based GPS Dual Clock
With 7-Day Alarm
92 Vintage Radio
The Mullard 5-10 Ten Watt Valve Amplifier – by Malcolm Fowler
Departments
2 Publisher’s Letter
4 Mailbag
siliconchip.com.au
57 Subscriptions
87 Online Shop
98 Ask Silicon Chip
103 Market Centre
104 Advertising Index
Passive Direct Injection (DI) Box
– Page 66.
October 2014 1
SILICON
CHIP
www.siliconchip.com.au
Publisher & Editor-in-Chief
Leo Simpson, B.Bus., FAICD
Production Manager
Greg Swain, B.Sc. (Hons.)
Technical Editor
John Clarke, B.E.(Elec.)
Technical Staff
Ross Tester
Jim Rowe, B.A., B.Sc
Nicholas Vinen
Photography
Ross Tester
Reader Services
Ann Morris
Advertising Enquiries
Glyn Smith
Phone (02) 9939 3295
Mobile 0431 792 293
glyn<at>siliconchip.com.au
Regular Contributors
Brendan Akhurst
Rodney Champness, VK3UG
Kevin Poulter
Stan Swan
Dave Thompson
SILICON CHIP is published 12 times
a year by Silicon Chip Publications
Pty Ltd. ACN 003 205 490. ABN 49
003 205 490. All material is copyright ©. No part of this publication
may be reproduced without the written consent of the publisher.
Printing: Hannanprint, Warwick
Farm, NSW.
Distribution: Network Distribution
Company.
Subscription rates: $105.00 per year
in Australia. For overseas rates, see
our website or the subscriptions page
in this issue.
Editorial office:
Unit 1, 234 Harbord Rd,
Brookvale, NSW 2100.
Postal address: PO Box 139,
Collaroy Beach, NSW 2097.
Phone (02) 9939 3295.
Fax (02) 9939 2648.
E-mail: silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
ISSN 1030-2662
Publisher’s Letter
GPS car navigation still not perfect
Just recently, I purchased a new Sydney street directory
and others in the SILICON CHIP office laughed at me. “What
do you need that for? You’ve got GPS and that makes street
directories unnecessary”. Well, call me conservative but if
at all possible I like to know where I am going and I like
to know the general route before I get into the car.
Now I think GPS is great. I still boggle at how marvellous it is when, after driving for several hours or maybe
even a whole day, the GPS says, “you have arrived at your
destination, at such and such address”.
But I have also driven up a few byways in other cities before I realised that I
was nowhere near my selected destination and unless I had a real map, I was to be
stranded somewhere out in “woop woop”. Only last month, I had a lunch engagement
with one of our regular contributors, Kevin Poulter, at a restaurant in Cloudehill
Gardens, in Monbulk, on the outskirts of Melbourne.
I had programmed the address into the GPS on my Garmin Android phone as a
matter of routine. The route took me and my wife through the very scenic Dandenongs and as we were driving along a steep, narrow, winding, dirt road, the GPS
suddenly said “recalculating”. Now as anyone who has used a GPS knows only
too well, this is the GPS politely saying “You’ve just taken the wrong turn-off, you
stupid idiot”. And since I didn’t know the area, I thought that I had done just that.
But after trekking back and forth, going up and down narrow lanes which were
dead-ends and becoming more and more angry and frustrated, I had to admit defeat
and phone Kevin to tell him we were going to be late – very late! So how did I get
out of that one? Fortunately, I had a Melbourne street directory in the car. I was
able to retrace the route until I could find a street sign and then I was able to navigate in the old-fashioned way – with a proper map! We arrived an hour late and it
took me a while to calm down and enjoy the meal. By the way, I had not taken the
wrong turn-off.
It turns out that this experience is not at all uncommon, especially in hilly country
areas or built-up city streets and with cloudy conditions whereby the GPS loses
reception of the satellites. The waitress at the restaurant had seen all this before –
many times.
But it is not just intermittent loss of satellites that can get GPS units into trouble.
Even if the stored maps are supposedly up-to-date, who has not been barrelling
down a freeway somewhere and then been instructed to take the first exit at the
next round-about? And there is no round-about for the next 50km? Or maybe you
are in a city area where they have recently made a lot of changes to the roads and
you end up driving into a hotel foyer – or at least you would if you had blindly followed the instructions of the GPS. Don’t laugh; people do such stupid things and
some have died as a result.
You also have to be careful to see that the GPS route selection criteria are correct
for your purpose. Do you want the quickest route or the shortest? Do you want to
avoid toll-ways? And so on. These can make a dramatic difference to the time (and
cost) of your journey. By the way, you can plan your route point-by-point on the
GPS instead of merely plugging in the destination address and then putting your
faith in its digital machinations.
But there is another reason why I like proper maps. Several years ago I had an
evening meeting with a sales representative in a Melbourne restaurant. I arrived on
time but he arrived very late and he apologised profusely. I asked him why and he
said that he had inadvertently left his Tom-Tom GPS in his other car – he could not
find his way without getting repeatedly lost. And he had been a Melbourne resident
for several years! I laughed but I wonder how many people these days would also
be lost and unable to proceed without a GPS?
Leo Simpson
Recommended and maximum price only.
2 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Rohde & Schwarz:
German engineered
quality at an
unexpected price.
Established more than 80 years ago, Rohde & Schwarz is a leading
global supplier in the fields of test and measurement, broadcasting, secure
communications, and radiomonitoring and radiolocation.
We help you develop the technologies of the future. Here are our
latest innovations in the field of oscilloscopes and power supplies.
Want to know more?
Visit: www.rohde-schwarz.com/value
NEW
¸HMO1002 Signal Oscilloscope
NEW
¸HMC8041/2/3 Power Supply
sales.australia<at>rohde-schwarz.com
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 3
MAILBAG
Letters and emails should contain complete name, address and daytime phone number. Letters
to the Editor are submitted on the condition that Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd may edit and
has the right to reproduce in electronic form and communicate these letters. This also applies to
submissions to “Ask SILICON CHIP” and “Circuit Notebook”.
Earth conductivity has
always been a problem
The Publisher’s Letter and related
article on the MEN system, house water pipes and electrical safety brings to
mind a situation I experienced back in
the mid-1960s as a designer of HMV
electronic equipment. This was the
time when ‘rectification’ first became
a problem with the ‘new’ HMV transistor amplifiers, both from noisy appliances and AM broadcast stations. At
about the same time, hot water ‘ripple
tone’ switching was introduced, with
interference coming from the mains
wires as they entered the chassis. This
was another unrelated, capacitancelinked problem.
On visiting an affected home, the
combined rectified (audio) output
from 2CH and 2SM at Carlingford
was heard loudly at minimum volume
setting, even before the AM tuner was
switched on! We later minimised this
problem with copious use of input
‘base-stopping’ resistors (read ‘gridstoppers’) and bypassing of external
wires, including the shield of shielded
wires, as they entered the chassis, with
a ceramic capacitor. Admittedly the
home I visited was part of a new estate
in the shadow of the transmitter tower.
The relatively high RF impedance
Query on MEN
fault current
I was most interested to read your
article entitled “Your House Water
Pipes Could Electrocute You” in the
August 2014 issue.
With regard to the panel on page
19 stating that “currents can flow
even when the power is turned off!”,
where was this measured current
actually coming from?
Many years ago I was working on
a technical research project and I
measured a voltage on the Neutral
line. Aghast, I contacted the resident
qualified electrician and it was explained that this was quite normal.
In relation to the current you meas4 Silicon Chip
above “real” earth of the mains earth
wiring compounded the problem.
A second problem for the householder was that if a neighbour’s ELCB
(Earth Leakage Circuit Breaker) was
tripped, theirs would also. On returning from a week-end away, the householder would be greeted with a ‘dead’
fridge full of bad food.
I immediately contacted the local
electricity retailer who resolved the
tripping problem. Fifty years may have
‘seniored’ my memory, however I believe the tripping problem was caused
by relatively high soil resistivity in that
locality. After that, I suspect that the
electricity retailer may have inserted
deeper Earth stakes at each home for
better earth conductivity.
With apologies to Sunbeam, concerning the ‘rectification’ problem,
when developing new amplifiers,
my favourite noise generator when
testing a prototype was a Sunbeam
Shavemaster!
Also at that time, Club electronic
lighting dimmers first became popular.
These dimmers were heard loudly in
the amplifiers. PA amplifier and mixer
designers had previously designed
their units for a perfect world. Again,
bypassing the ineffectual “balanced”
microphone leads from the outer
ured in paragraph two, which way
was it flowing?
I well realise that with an AC
system current flows both ways! But
consider only one half of the Hertz
(cycle) or an even more simplified
DC approach. If the supply Neutral
has a higher potential than the
ground potential, then the current
flowing in the water pipe should be
identical to that of the Neutral but
opposite in direction.
This could be an inherent problem with the M.E.N. system, for
the mains Neutral and the property
Neutral are tied to the common bar of
the property in question and are not
disconnected when the main supply
shield via a ceramic capacitor at external point of entry to the chassis
usually cured the problem. This way
earth loops were avoided. Anyone who
has designed car radios and antenna
entry would know about this!
Neville Snow,
Burwood, NSW.
Products purchased on-line
can be unsafe
Further to your article on electrical
safety last month, I have encountered
an issue which you might like to make
more widely known. A friend of mine
purchased thirteen 10W and 20W LED
floodlights from an internet supplier
for use in stage lighting for musical
events. The lights are similar in outward appearance to the ones supplied
by Oatley Electronics and featured
in separate articles in February and
November 2012 issues of SILICON
CHIP.
The lights my friend purchased were
manufactured in China. The casings
are metal and the lights are operated
from the 230VAC mains via a standard
3-pin plug which is fitted to the lead
(Active) switch is open-circuit.
So, if you could have opencircuited the mains Neutral at the
same time as the Active was opencircuited, would the ground (water
pipe) current have measured near
zero? I believe the answer would
be yes.
Ray Smith,
Hoppers Crossing, Vic.
Leo Simpson comments: the current
would cease to flow if the Neutral
link was disconnected but that
would not indicate where the actual
fault lay. All that could be certain
was that the fault was elsewhere,
with one or more of the the neighbours having a Neutral fault.
siliconchip.com.au
Query on range of
RC substitution box
With respect to the Resistance/Capacitance Substution Box in the August 2014 issue, I am a bit puzzled
by the capacitance values you state this box can
produce.
On page 77 as an example, the truth table states that
when the switch is set to 9, pins 1 and 8 are joined
together. Now if you look at the circuit diagram on page
78, pin 1 has a 10µF capacitor and pin 8 has eight 10µF
capacitors. These capacitors are all in parallel which
to my way of thinking makes 90µF not 9µF. Taking
all the other switches into account, this would mean
that the total capacitance with all the switches set to
9 would be 99.9999µF not 9.99999µF as you state.
B. Dodding,
via email.
Comment: you are correct.
on each light. A small sealed LED driver is used inside
each light to convert the 230VAC mains to LED voltage.
One of the lights stopped functioning and my friend asked
me to have a look at it. After examining this light I asked
him to let me have a look at the other twelve.
Of the 13 lights, only two were properly earthed. The
earthing is supposed to be achieved by a tag washer
crimped to the Earth wire which is then screwed to the
metal body of the light inside the rear cover. I found a
variety of faults on the units such as:
• missing tag washers on the Earth wire so that earthing
is achieved at best via a few strands of copper under the
(mostly countersunk) screw head;
• the earthing screw bedded on the plastic insulation of
the Earth wire instead of the copper;
• screws used in a blind hole which were too long to tight
en against the tag washer so that the Earth wire was loose;
• countersink screws used instead of round-head screws
which had caused the tag washer to fracture, resulting in
only a minimal area of contact against the casing;
• casings screwed down so that screw heads were digging
into the mains wiring.
A check with a continuity tester showed only two valid
Earth connections. If a fault developed in the LED driver, it
would seem to be possible for the casing to become live at
230VAC. There are a number of external unpainted screws,
brackets and other items which could easily be contacted
by an unsuspecting person. The potential disaster which
could have resulted from this situation is unpleasant to
contemplate.
These lights have neither an on/off switch nor a fuse
and unfortunately there is insufficient space in the casing
to fit either one.
I appreciate that policing of safety standards for goods
purchased via the internet is all but impossible. Accordingly, it would seem that compliance with the most basic
safety standards in inexpensive equipment operated from
mains voltage cannot be assumed and users should have
such equipment examined by a competent person before
operating it.
Barrie Davis,
Hope Valley, SA.
siliconchip.com.au
NEW
IP Advanced
Radio System
ip100h
Icom Australia has released a revolutionary
new IP Advanced Radio System that works
over both wireless LAN and IP networks.
The IP Advanced Radio System is easy to
set up and use, requiring no license fees
or call charges.
To find out more about Icom’s IP networking
products email – sales<at>icom.net.au
ICOM 716
www.icom.net.au,
October 2014 5
Mailbag: continued
Keyless car entry
& flat batteries
Having a passion for cars, I am
always interested in car-related
service stories whenever they appear
in the Serviceman’s Log pages. I’ve
always wondered about those cars
that only offer a fob and no key as
such, as the key and fob are one in
the same. Or the key is actually just
a remote that is like a credit card or a
swipe card in such cars as Mercedes
Benz etc.
A lot of much cheaper cars are
coming out with this type of key
fob which allows smart key entry.
Carbon dioxide emissions from
volcanoes deliberately understated
I have read the articles on both sides
of the argument of global warming over
the last few editions with interest.
However, the letter entitled “Volcanoes not major emitters of carbon dioxide” in the August 2014 edition has
prompted me to write in total amazement on the gullibility of some who
accept poorly prepared guesswork
and estimations wrapped in a sham
of authority to be a credible source.
More surprisingly, the opening line
criticises John McDonald for “not verifying his facts”, which unfortunately
The thing that always intrigues me
is that you can’t just push the button
on the fob to get into the car if the
battery in the fob is flat for instance.
You can’t put a key in the door of a
Mercedes Benz but a lot of cars with
smart key and pushbutton start often
have buttons on the doors instead of
just a spot to put the key in case of
emergency entry if the fob doesn’t
work.
But if the car has a flat battery you
can’t even get into the car in that
particular case, can you?
Kyle Cogan,
Wangaratta, Vic.
and actually is the writer’s; of that
letter, greatest failing.
The referenced web site (http://volcanoes.usgs.gov/hazards/gas/climate.
php) appears to be a biased compilation from the promoters of the climate
warming religion. If one actually reads
the suggested site volcanoes.usgs.gov
and looks up the reference reports (to
verify the facts), one cannot but get
the feeling that the outcome of low
levels of CO2 emissions from volcanoes has been based on poor estimates
and guesses, masquerading as a peerreviewed report.
Delving deeper into the analysis,
it is even clearer that the selection of
volcanoes chosen to study and the assumptions made had the result of an
outcome skewed to the ultra-low end
of CO2 output.
For instance, eight of the world’s
10 most active volcanoes are omitted
from Kerrick’s study and making the
unscientifically based assumption that
the net CO2 output of all the world’s
submarine volcanoes (those under the
oceans) is zero completely makes the
report absolutely worthless and totally
misleading.
The referenced website bases its
findings on a “projected” CO2 output
of 35GtCpa in 2010, based on “global
magmatic” carbon dioxide emission
yet the IPCC (the bastion of Global
Warming exaggerations) attributes
only 9.7 GtCpa to anthropogenic CO2
emissions – see: http://www.ipccdata.org/sim/gcm_clim/SRES_TAR/
ddc_sres_emissions.html
However, based on the “preferred”
and widely used units of measure, this
coverts to 0.071GtCpa or 71MtCpa for
anthropogenic emissions. This is a
tried and proven way of obfuscating
report outcomes by using a parallel
unit of measure.
In contrast, Morner & Etiope (2002)
published a somewhat more representative estimate of sub-aerial volcanogenic CO2 output based on a more
comprehensive selection and found
as a bare minimum that sub-aerial
“Rigol Offer Australia’s Best
Value Test Instruments”
RIGOL DS-1000E Series
NEW RIGOL DS-1000Z Series
50MHz & 100MHz, 2 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
USB Device, USB Host & PictBridge
FROM $
339
ex GST
NEW RIGOL DS-2000 Series
70MHz & 100MHz, 4 Ch
1GS/s Real Time Sampling
12Mpts Standard Memory Depth
FROM $
654
70MHz, 100MHz & 200MHz, 2 Ch
2GS/s Real Time Sampling
14Mpts Standard Memory Depth
ex GST
FROM $
934
Buy on-line at www.emona.com.au/rigol
6 Silicon Chip
ex GST
siliconchip.com.au
Remote Controlled, Seriously
Bright White LED Panel
On-Off
Dimming and
Flashing
Complete KSLC18 Kit
$21.70
inc GST - Pack and Post FREE
Light your backyard, your tent, campsite or caravan No more getting out
of a warm sleeping bag to turn this 2.6W dazzler down or off. The 433MHz
UHF hand-piece reaches about 30metres to the LED controller, rated at
12Amps, peak, at 12VDC.
The KSLP18 LED panel features an
aluminium substrate that may be
bolted directly onto metal surfaces.
Need more light?
Find these and
Extra LED Panels
ea
are yours for only inc GST - Pack and Post FREE of kits & modules at:
$8.70
100s
www.kitstop.com.au
P.O. Box 5422 Clayton Vic.3168
Tel:0432 502 755
Radio, Television & Hobbies:
ONLY 0
the COMPLETE
0
$ 2
6 0 P&P archive on DVD
+ $1
• Every issue individually archived, by month and year
• Complete with index for each year
• A must-have for everyone interested in electronics
This remarkable collection of PDFs covers every
issue of R & H, as it was known from the
beginning (April 1939 – price sixpence!)
right through to the final edition of R, TV
& H in March 1965, before it disappeared
forever with the change of name to
Electronics Australia.
For the first time ever, complete and in one
handy DVD, every article and every issue is covered.
If you're an old timer (or even young timer!) into vintage radio, it
doesn't get much more vintage than this. If you're a student of
history, this archive gives an extraordinary insight into the amazing
breakthroughs made in radio and electronics technology following
the war years. And speaking of the war years, R & H had some of the
best propaganda imaginable!
Even if you're just an electronics dabbler, there's something here to
interest you.
NB: Requires a computer with DVD reader to view
– will not work on a standard audio/video DVD player
Use
the from
handy
order form
Order online
www.siliconchip.com.au
or use the handy
in this issue
included
in order
thisform
issue
8 Silicon Chip
Mailbag: continued
SILICON CHIP covers a
diverse range of topics
While browsing the latest issue of SILICON CHIP magazine and having in mind that magazine’s name, I was
intrigued by how wide the area of interest has spread
and wonder if SILICON CHIP should have a secondary
name (a bit like the evolution of R&H, RTV & H, EA
etc). The name SILICON CHIP is certainly relevant and
has its roots following EA/ETI from the 1960s and
the advent of silicon-based semiconductors and ICs.
The Letters pages and reader comments/submissions
span automotive topics, volcanic study, medicine, environmental science and atmospherics – along with the
evolution of silicon-based (that’s broad!) technologies.
Heck, one of your major advertisers even sells lathes
and metalworking tools!
Engineering in general has remained on a relatively
direct path, augmented by the benefits of computing
and electronics to optimise and speed up project analysis and delivery. It seems the digital migration of electronics and simulation/augmentation technology has
stepped over the line into general engineering and an
electronics engineer is rarely a person that builds ham
sets or fixes radios any longer. He/she now regularly
addresses other real-world problems with colleagues
in other disciplines for the present and future.
To this end, perhaps the magazine banner could
reflect something like this progress, with a sub-title:
SILICON CHIP – Resources for Electronics and Engineering Experimenters or similar.
Michael Coop,
Rowville, Vic.
volcanogenic CO2 emission is on the order of 163MtCpa.
Submarine volcanic output is magnitudes greater than subaerial volcanoes based alone on the significantly greater
number (thousands more) and higher level of activity of
submarine volcanoes. Together these will diminish the effect of the effective 71MTCpa from anthropogenic sources
using the accepted preferred units.
A very interesting and somewhat more credible website
covering this area of study and completely debunking the
August article and the referenced website is http://carbonbudget.geologist-1011.net/ It is well worth reading to get
the feel of a well-presented and scientific-based document.
Charles Camenzuli,
Seven Hills, NSW.
Electric shock from water taps
can be due to other Earth faults
It is with great interest that I read the article about faulty
Neutral connections causing electric shocks. However, as
an electrician I have been called to two separate incidents
where occupants in houses received electric shocks in the
shower and their Neutrals were in good order.
In the first case, a person would sometimes receive an
electric shock when turning the taps on in the shower while
siliconchip.com.au
a dishwasher downstairs was running.
I found that the Earth connection was
missing on the outlet the dishwasher
was plugged into.
In the second case, a person would
sometimes receive an electric shock
when turning the taps on in the shower.
There was a clothes washing machine
in the same room as the shower and
I found that the outlet the washing
machine was plugged into and several
others were not earthed. A shock could
be received even when the washing
machine was not running but just
plugged in.
Providing an Earth connection to
the outlets that the machines were
plugged into fixed the problem in both
cases. What I believe was happening
is that both of these machines were
discharging waste water that had some
connection to the Active supply and
water with impurities conducts electricity. And both machines’ chassis and
electrics were not earthed at the time.
As the waste water pipes are plastic,
a person walking into the shower and
turning on the taps would be quite
safe at this point. As the person has
a shower, water would run down the
shower waste and through the plastic
pipes, creating an electrical connection with live discharge water or moist
plumbing connections to the nonearthed washing machine. The person
having a shower would not be aware
that they are standing in a puddle of
water which has become electrically
live until they touch something else
to complete the circuit. When they are
finishing their shower and reach out to
turn the taps, which are earthed, they
will receive a shock.
This is a very difficult problem to
diagnose, as it appears to the person
having a shower that the taps are live
but it is actually the shower floor that
was live while the water was running
down the floor waste. And of course,
the water has dried up in the plastic
waste pipe by the time an electrician
arrives and his test equipment will
show everything is safe in the shower
area and the taps are properly earthed.
It is worthwhile plugging in a tester
that indicates an Earth connection and
Ground stakes must not be
surrounded with concrete
I should comment on the photos
of the Earth stakes in the Mailbag
pages of the September 2014 issue
of SILICON CHIP (page 10). While
the Earth stake may be correctly
wired, it may not have been installed correctly. Nor should it be
surrounded with concrete which
prevents it from being inspected.
The stake is supposed to maintain effective contact with moist
soil that is not subject to excessive
drying out.
Guy Reece,
Kelso, Qld.
can test trip the RCD (safety switch) on
outlets that these types of appliances
are plugged into regularly, at least
once a year.
Donald Whittle,
Phillip Bay, NSW.
Sandy coastal areas
cause MEN problems
I would like to add a comment to
the feature in the August 2014 issue
See R
S ILICONevCiew
Septemb HIP
er
P32-33 2014
silicon chip add.indd 1
siliconchip.com.au
31/07/14
2:35 PM
October
2014 9
Mailbag: continued
SIGNAL HOUND
USB-based spectrum analyzers
and RF recorders.
SA44B: $1,320 inc GST
•
•
•
•
•
Up to 4.4GHz
Preamp for improved
sensitivity and reduced
LO leakage.
Thermometer for
temperature correction
and improved accuracy
AM/FM/SSB/CW demod
USB 2.0 interface
SA12B: $2,948 inc GST
•
•
•
Up to 12.4GHz plus all
the advanced features
of the SA44B
AM/FM/SSB/CW demod
USB 2.0 interface
The BB60C supercedes the
BB60A, with new specifications:
•
•
•
•
•
The BB60C streams 140
MB/sec of digitized RF to
your PC utilizing USB 3.0.
An instantaneous
bandwidth of 27 MHz.
Sweep speeds of 24 GHz/sec.
The BB60C also adds new
functionality in the form of
configurable I/Q.
Streaming bandwidths
which will be retroactively
available on the BB60A.
Vendor and Third-Party
Software Available.
Ideal tool for lab and test bench
use, engineering students,
ham radio enthusiasts and
hobbyists. Tracking generators
also available.
Silvertone Electronics
1/8 Fitzhardinge St
Wagga Wagga NSW 2650
Ph: (02) 6931 8252
contact<at>silvertone.com.au
10 Silicon Chip
Plastic pipes &
smart water meters
We are a smart meter manufacturer based in Brisbane, Queensland.
While primarily electricity metering
experts, one of the new products
we sell is a plastic smart meter for
water. It records 460 days of daily
data, has burst, leak, reverse flow
and tamper detection and transmits
this encrypted data at 923MHz via
Wireless M-Bus every 16 seconds for
remote reading, all with a 16-year
battery life!
The ultrasonic (transient time)
meter has no mechanical parts and
is completely made of moulded composite material. Obviously this meter
would provide a nice “isolator” on
any water-pipe earthing system.
In fact, since 1976, you have not
been able to use the water pipes as
an Earth in new dwellings. It is a
requirement to provide equipotential bonding for protection but this
is just that, equipotential bonding,
not earthing.
At the time many bulletins were
issued, like this one at: www.esv.
vic.gov.au/Portals/0/Gas%20Professionals/Files/EARTHING%20
OF%20ELECTRICAL%20INSTALLATIONS%20USING%20THE%20
WATER%20RETICULATION%20
SYSTEM.pdf
What you need to remember is that
these days most internal plumbing
is plastic and now most mains and
take-offs to the meter are plastic.
Copper is still used above ground
for UV resistance, usually just where
the meter is installed, where outdoor
hose taps are installed and when
meters are installed above ground
(in Victoria and parts of New South
Wales) but poly pipe is installed
from the mains to the meter and from
the meter to the house.
Only older premises may have
the MEN system Earth anchored to
the water pipes but as water main
replacement is now commonplace,
the mains which were providing the
majority of the earthing on pre-1976
buildings (usually through the water
utilities’ large concrete-lined cast
iron pipes) are being replaced with
non-conductive plastic ones.
For some reason, it seems the
water utilities (like Sydney Water)
are taking on the responsibility of
making sure the premises are cor-
“Your House Water Pipes Could Electrocute You”.
The last section on page 19 is of
interest as an MEN system can import
power system imbalance and problems
to the domestic installation. In sandy
coastal areas where the main Earth can
be a poor or even an intermittent conductor, the MEN system is recognised
as a good solution as it connects all
Earths together.
However, in sandy coastal holiday
areas where the load balance on each
phase is unpredictable due to intermittent occupation, considerable Neutral
displacement can occur, especially
where single phase loading is high,
aluminium conductors are used and
street earthing is weak, unreliable or
corroded and the distance between
transformers is considerable.
Where a house is constructed on a
concrete slab on the ground, a situation
can arise where an uncomfortable volt-
age may be imported from the power
system via a displaced Neutral. The
house metal pipes and its main Earth
are connected to the substation Neutral
via many components.
If there is no connection between
the main Earth and the concrete slab
reinforcement, the slab will remain
floating at local Earth potential.
Plumbing fittings can present these
two occasionally contrasting voltages,
especially in a shower.
A simple but interesting observation
can be made by connecting a voltage data logger between a seemingly
uninvolved metal fence post remote
from your house and your main Earth
connection for a day or two. The fence
post in this case is the “local natural
Earth”. Any voltage observed is possibly that imported from the unbalanced
power system. As long as the ‘step and
touch’ is within acceptable limits, it is
not generally noticed.
siliconchip.com.au
rectly earthed (using an Earth stake)
rather than the Electricity Network
Operators and NSW Resources and
Energy (who actually do have this
responsibility).
How do we, as a supplier of meters, manage our legal risks when
the practice of earthing dwellings
using the water reticulation system
has been outlawed since 1976 when
it became mandatory to fit Earth
electrodes to all new dwellings?
What is the position where one
could argue that a brass meter (or
one that has a pathway through it)
that conducts electricity could be
a hazard because it makes a good
electrical path? How do you prove
the current rating of a brass water
meter or piping system?
By knowingly providing an electrical pathway through the meter,
would we breach the rules that
impose responsibility for electrical
supply networks and associated
earthing on NSW Resources and
Energy and the Electrical Network
Operators (ENOs)?
By knowingly providing an electrical pathway do we compromise
the property owner’s obligation to
ensure the safety of their electrical
mains and the earthing system on
their property?
This characteristic may not be contained to the area fed by your substation only as in many cases the Neutral
is usually connected between substations to enhance the MEN effect. It may
follow that Earth problems in other
areas could also be imported to your
area. Low-voltage lines running parallel to heavily loaded transmission lines
may also induce a problem.
William Fleming,
Launceston, Tas.
Comment on accuracy
of Argo measurements
The Argo article by Dr David Maddison in the July 2014 issue of SILICON
CHIP was superb and I compliment him
on it. However, there was one thing
that caught my attention and that was
the accuracies that were quoted. In
particular, the temperature accuracy
seemed too good to be true. Since reading the article, I have searched the insiliconchip.com.au
Helping to put you in Control
16x2 Character LCD
Basic 16 character by 2 line
display. Black text on Green
background. Utilises the
extremely common HD44780
parallel interface chipset.
Interface code is freely available. You will
need ~11 general I/O pins to interface to
this LCD screen.
SKU: LCD-002
Price:$13.95 +GST
3.2 Kg Servo
A simple, low-cost, high quality servo for all your mechatronic needs. 3.2 kg·cm
torque at 6 VDC. Comes with
standard 3-pin power, control
cable and mounting hardware.
SKU: MOT-311
Price:$14.38 +GST
SMA Female To SMA Male Cable
This plastic smart meter has no
external metal and does not provide
any path for AC currents flowing in
water pipes.
An interesting article on this topic
can be seen at: www.wioa.org.au/
conference_papers/08_nsw/documents/johnwerda.pdf
Robert Stewart,
Technical Director,
Smart Building Services Pty Ltd,
Kallangur, Qld.
ternet and found that GEC Instruments
sell thermistor temperature measuring
units which have an initial accuracy
of ±0.002°C (or better) between -10°C
and +35°C.
So the accuracy is achievable
although there are no deterioration
figures. Also, GEC Instruments quote
that at 0°C, the resolution of their instruments is 0.0001°C but note that it
is resolution, not accuracy.
I know that very high accuracies
can be achieved and maintained in
laboratories but it requires regular
checking and calibration. What is done
with the sensors on the Argo drones?
There appears to be no further human
intervention after the drones are cast
adrift. Assuming that the sensors suffer
from ageing etc, what is the accuracy
after the Argo drones have been operating for some time? The drones are
not recovered. How is sensor operation confirmed? I am very curious to
Basic SMA male to female
connector cable. Each cable
is 25 cm long and has a 50 Ω
impedance that can handle
frequencies up to 17 GHz.
Suitable for most consumer
GPS, cellular and other RF applications.
SKU: SFR-004
Price:$5.95 +GST
7 Digit LCD Hour Timer
Compact size, self powered
timer (interal battery) that
accepts NPN input signal or
relay contact to common and
counts up to 999999.9 hours.
The unit is equipped with a
reset button on the front panel.
SKU: THH-007
Price:$42.50 +GST
Asymmetrical Cyclic Timer
DIN-rail mount cyclic
timer with configurable on
and off times. Features
selectable “pulse first”
or “pause first” for initial
timing function. 4PCO
relay output, selectable multi-time range
from 1s to 100 days. 12 to 250 VAC/DC
powered.
SKU: NTR-110
Price:$74.95 +GST
Adjustable Voltage Regulator
The S7V8A switching stepup/step-down regulator efficiently produces an adjustable output between 2.5 V
to 8 V from input voltages
between 2.7 V and 11.8 V.
SKU: POL-2118
Price:$9.95 +GST
Motorised Slide Pot
The slide contains two separate 10 kΩ linear taper potentiometers so that you can
use one as servo-feedback in
order to read the position of
the slider and use the other
to control whatever your target is. Motorised potentiometers are useful when you need the ability to
jump to preset positions or when you want
physical feedback from virtual controllers.
Audio taper and accessories also available.
SKU: SFC-091
Price:$22.94 +GST
For OEM/Wholesale prices
Contact Ocean Controls
Ph: (03) 9782 5882
oceancontrols.com.au
October 2014 11
ANTRIM
TRANSFORMERS
manufactured in
Australia by
Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd
harbuch<at>optusnet.com.au
Toroidal – Conventional Transformers
Power – Audio – Valve – ‘Specials’
Medical – Isolated – Stepup/down
Encased Power Supplies
Toroidal General
Construction
OUTER
INSULATION
OUTER
WINDING
WINDING
INSULATION
INNER
WINDING
CORE
CORE
INSULATION
Comprehensive data available:
www.harbuch.com.au
Harbuch Electronics Pty Ltd
9/40 Leighton Pl, HORNSBY 2077
Ph (02) 9476 5854 Fax (02) 9476 3231
MaxiMite
miniMaximite
or
MicroMite
Which one do you want?
They’re the beginner’s computers that the
experts love, because they’re so versatile!
And they’ve started a cult following around the
world from Afghanistan to Zanzibar!
Very low cost, easy to program, easy to use –
the Maximite, miniMaximite and the Micromite
are the perfect D-I-Y computers for every level.
Read the articles – and you’ll be convinced . . .
You’ll find the articles at:
siliconchip.com.au/Project/Graham/Mite
Maximite: Mar, Apr, May 2011
miniMaximite: Nov 2011
Colour MaxiMite: Sept, Oct 2012
MicroMite: May, June 2014
plus loads of Circuit Notebook ideas!
PCBs & Micros available from PartShop
12 Silicon Chip
Mailbag: continued
Non-genuine USB power
adaptors are a risk
There’s been a lot discussion surrounding the use of non-genuine
and non-approved USB power adaptors and rightly so – these things
can be dangerous! However, while
it’s commendable for governments
and industry to recommend that
consumers look for the Australian
approval markings, there is still a
hidden danger.
There are quite a large number of
adaptors available which are ‘copies’ of the adaptors supplied by a
well-known US phone and tablet
manufacturer. I use the term ‘copies’
very loosely because while these
may look like the OEM product in
question, inside the case it is a different story, as the following site shows:
www.righto.com/2012/10/a-dozenusb-chargers-in-lab-apple-is.html
The problem arises from the fact
that when the copycats reproduce
the case, they copy everything – including any safety approval markings that may be present. I myself
bought one of the 2-pin US style
adaptors some time ago and this is
indeed the case – even down to the
original manufacturer’s inspection
mark that’s placed on the original
article. The copycats do remove the
know what was done to maintain the
accuracies. It could make for a good
sequel to the Argo article.
Also do the researchers prevent
aliasing from affecting their results?
I know that it seems silly to ask such
a question but there are no frequency
limits to this effect.
On another subject, a few years ago,
I watched a cloud move slowly above
Brisbane and then disappear. The water mist had evaporated. The cloud did
not change elevation so I assumed that
radiant heat was the reason and not a
“thermal”. Since then, I have realised
that there is a possible mechanism by
which infrared-absorbing molecules
like carbon dioxide or methane could
facilitate cloud removal or prevent
cloud formation. Since clouds are the
major barrier to the expulsion of heat
original manufacturer’s branding
though.
So the average person is going to
see the approval markings and think
everything is good – which as indicated from the above website, isn’t
necessarily true! The copycats play
to the consumer’s taste in that these
chargers are quite small and stylish,
with seemingly little regard to safety.
A quick Google search will reveal
this is a worldwide problem, with
said famous-name phone manufacturer offering an exchange program
in the US in an effort to get these
dodgy products off the streets.
The morals – use only genuine
parts and/or shop at a reputable
place where the markings are genuine. There are good third-party USB
adaptors out there, styled along the
‘traditional’ plugpack style. Sure
most of them are black and a little
bigger but they are safe – at the end
of the day it is just a phone charger
that sits at home or in a bag most of
the time.
Also, if you must use your phone/
tablet/MP3 when the battery is flat,
why not consider one of the many
battery-based ‘power banks’ now on
the market?
Paul Mansell,
Ryde, NSW.
from the Earth, carbon dioxide, methane etc could facilitate some cooling
of the Earth.
The physics of the mechanism is
as follows. Carbon dioxide molecules
absorb low-level infrared radiation
and effectively, their temperature
is increased. Some of this energy is
transferred to surrounding molecules
of nitrogen, oxygen and water molecules etc.
If, and I emphasise “if”, the water
molecules are close to changing state
from gas to liquid or liquid to gas, the
extra energy will increase the temperature of the water molecules and ensure
that they are gaseous. In other words,
carbon dioxide and methane etc can
reduce existing cloud or reduce the
generation of clouds. A reduction in
clouds results in more heat being radisiliconchip.com.au
New pricing for Celestion drivers
ated to space and the Earth becoming
cooler.
A simple mind experiment suggests
that this mechanism is self-stabilising,
preventing possible thermal runaway.
If the Earth’s surface temperature
increases, more infrared radiation is
produced and more is absorbed by carbon dioxide etc. This would result in
less cloud cover and more heat would
be released into space. Consequently,
the Earth’s surface temperature would
reduce.
Conversely, a cooling of the Earth’s
surface temperature would result in
more cloud cover but not necessarily
a rise in temperature. I have no proof
that this mechanism exists but I would
be very surprised if it did not. Also, I
have no way of gauging its effect on
the world’s temperature without laboratory experiments and supporting
weather data. I will, however, challenge the claim that a rise in carbon
or methane levels will ensure a global
temperature rise. This mechanism suggests that may not be the case.
George Ramsay,
Holland Park, Qld.
Coupler needed for Ethernet
over 3-phase power
I have followed the discussions
in SILICON CHIP magazine regarding
Ethernet over 3-phase power with
great interest. I recalled seeing a
device that would enable this to happen and it took me some time to find
it again. Jaycar Electronics do sell a
Thanks for the excellent coverage of the Celestion tweeter in the articles
on the Majestic loudspeaker system (SILICON CHIP, June & September 2014).
However, I should note that there has been a change in our direct pricing and
that some constructors may wish to employ the Celestion 15-inch woofer.
The pricing is now: FTR15-4080FD woofer = $339; CDX1-1730 compression driver = $189; T-5134 horn (H1-7050) = $35 (total = $563)
We’ll adjust our pricing for October 2014 so that the combined pricing
for these three components is $499, as a ‘special offer’ for SILICON CHIP
magazine. This is effectively 2 x $499 for a stereo pair of cabinets.
Mat Bolt, National Sales Manager,
Electric Factory Pty Ltd,
Preston, Vic.
www.elfa.com.au
unit manufactured by ‘Kemo’, called
a ‘Phase Coupler Module’ (Jaycar Cat.
AA-0268). It needs to be installed by a
registered electrician, presumably in
the switchboard.
With reference to Peter Lowe’s letter
in the Mailbag section of the August
2014 issue, I would assume that there is
most probably a small copper inductor
in the circuit breaker that’s part of the
magnetic short-circuit trip section of
that breaker. This inductor (along with
the probably high capacitance of the
[presumed] underground cable) may
have prevented the HF signals from his
brother’s Ethernet system from reaching his workshop. Peter didn’t say but
I hope his brother replaced that circuit
breaker with a newer type!
On another topic, I have also read
some of the discussions about ‘climate
change’ that many people are making.
I have a very good friend who’s a recently retired dairy farmer who insists
that this ‘climate change stuff’ is a load
of codswallop. I can absolutely swear
that something has changed. When I
was a young boy in the late 1960s and
early 1970s, I would often trot off to
school on a frosty morning and walk
along the grass berms and crunch
through the frost – often in bare feet.
Not only that but any puddles of
water would have a layer of ice on top
of them too. My Dad also had an old
‘copper’ out in his garden which was
always full of water that he used to
wash his feet in. On those hard frosty
mornings, I would often be able to pull
the 1/2-inch (about 13mm) of glass-like
ice off the top and I enjoyed dropping
this onto the ground and jumping onto
the top of it to break it, or smashing it
with a hammer.
He had that copper until it was stolen not that long ago but the ice rarely
formed on the top of it any longer. As
for climate change, something has
definitely changed over the last 45odd years.
Peter Walsham,
SC
Pukehoe, NZ.
Desktop 3D Printer
Bring your imagination to life.
Automatic Bed Levelling
High Print Resolution
Automatic Material
Recognition
Up to 300% Faster
Faster and More Accurate Setup
For Software Selection of Heat
Profiles using SmartReel™
Down to 20 Microns
Dual Nozzle System
See our website for more details
www.wiltronics.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
$1495.00
inc. GST
Includes 2 SmartReel™ reels of filament!
October 2014 13
“Hands On” Product Review. We build the Velleman/Jaycar Electronics
If last month’s ‘Electronex’ show is any indication, 3D printers are ‘the
next big thing’ (if they’re not already!). Here we take a detailed look at
the popular Velleman K8200 3D printer that you first build before you
can print. Even one (optional) part of the printer itself can be 3D printed!
3D
printers have now featured a few times in
SILICON CHIP, some ready-built but some – probably of more interest to the typical SC reader –
being for the home constructor.
When a major electronics supplier such as Jaycar decides
to stock a kit, you can be sure that they’ve thoroughly researched the market and decided on an item which will
give maximum satisfaction and minimum difficulty.
Team that with the European quality of the well-known
Velleman company from Belgium and we’re off to a flying
start!
ably with a plain surface (ie, definitely not a shag-pile
carpet!).
You will drop at least one part of this kit on the floor
during construction and that will probably be one of the
tiny grub screws in the kit (OK, I speak from experience!).
If the floor does not start off immaculate, you will never
find that part.
Now back to space. As you will find, the kit instructions
frequently direct you to ‘take the bag labelled n out of the
box’. The box contains 41 numbered bags and one or two
that are not numbered, so finding bag n will not be a trivial
task, especially when you start the build.
Not for the faint hearted!
You are also frequently directed to use a particular plastic
First, a warning: This kit is not for Dad and Uncle Bert piece, which you can find ‘...in the bag containing plastic
to throw together on Christmas Eve for young Billy to play parts’. This bag is crammed with all manner of strangely
shaped components, which at first sight look quite different
with the next day.
The kit calls for a substantial expenditure of time and to those in the instructions, especially if you have them a
although there are detailed and on the whole accurate different way up!
The solution to both of these problems is to have enough
and unambiguous instructions, mechanical and electronic
skill as well as the ability to download and run a range of space to lay out all of the bags of parts and all of the plastic
components.
software are required.
This is in addition to the space in which to build the
These skills include a small amount of surface mount
machine. For this last purpose I built a mobile trolley so that
soldering, so all-in-all this is not a kit for the beginner.
I could move the machine
Having said that, the inaround as construction prostructions are extraordinarily
gressed and get easy access
detailed and accompanied by
to any part of it.
numerous photographs — in
Finally, with regard to
fact just the build phase is
the work environment, the
covered by over 850 photowork area should also have
graphs in 20 chapters, and
internet access, in my case a
that does not include testing
laptop machine.
and setting up!
For a long time now, nearly
A clear space
all suppliers have dispensed
with those glossy instruction
There are two environmenbooks that were such a pleastal things you will need if
ure to curl up with on the
you are to successfully build
sofa or in bed. It is cheaper
this kit: plenty of workbench
space and a completely clean Most components are clearly numbered to make assembly to supply a CD or DVD.
If the user wants a hard
(read spotless!) floor, prefer- easy – but some are not, just to make life interesting!
14 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
The completed Velleman K8200 3D Printer from Jaycar. Putting it together is
not something you’ll achieve in one evening (or perhaps even one weekend!)
However, the instructions are very good – just don’t assume anything. . .
copy it has to be printed at home.
On-line instructions
This kit takes this a stage further: The 3D printer kit
instructions are on-line at www.k8200.eu/locale/
On-line instructions are an advantage to the user as well
as the suppliers because they can be amended or corrected
as necessary and the changes will take immediate effect
worldwide. In fact, some of my suggestions and comments
may well have been taken into account by the time you
start building your own machine.
First up we have ‘Start Building’ at www.k8200.eu/
manual/building where there are 20 chapters starting with
Chapter 0, ‘Tools Required’ and ending at Chapter 19, ‘Assembling the Hot End’.
These chapters can be downloaded as PDF files individually but I found it easier to work directly on-line; plus,
there may be cases where the PDF has not been updated
to synchronise with the on-line version.
This happened to me when I downloaded the very last
chapter — which turned out to be not up-to-date!
My kit was supplied with a new pattern of extruder
head (‘hot end’) thermistor which called for a different
siliconchip.com.au
assembly procedure.
Although the website had special instructions for this,
the PDF had not been updated. Velleman are aware of this
via the forum (more later) and this may have been updated
since.
The tools you need
The instructions start with an illustrated list of tools. Most
of them are tools that any electronics person will already
have: a screwdriver, wire cutters/strippers, a multimeter,
soldering iron and solder and plastic tuning needle set.
In relation to this last item, what is needed is not your
normal IF core tweaker but a really tiny, plastic cross-point
tuning/adjustment tool, for adjusting the motor control
potentiometers on the controller board as part of the setting up procedure.
Also required are some mechanical tools: a small file set,
steel tape measure, digital callipers, metric Allen keys, a set
of metric open-end spanners (you will need up to 13mm)
and another vital item – circlip pliers.
Circlip pliers
This tool, essential on several occasions during the
October 2014 15
build, is variously described as ‘combination snap ring
pliers’ or ‘classic circlip pliers for outer rings (shafts)’. It is
used to tension (hold apart) a circlip while easing it into a
matching groove on the exterior of a shaft (or in this case
a linear bearing).
You may have never heard of or tried to use such a tool.
It is tempting to try opening a circlip with ordinary pliers.
From one who admits to once trying this years ago in desperation on a Sunday afternoon when all relevant shops
were shut, in one word — DON’T!
You will not succeed and you could either break the circlip, lose it altogether as it springs away violently, or badly
damage an eye; possibly all three! In use, the correct tool
engages in holes at the ends of the circlip and enables it to
be opened enough to slip onto the shaft or bearing without
risking breakage, blinding or other disasters.
As well as the tools recommended, there are one or two
omissions in the list. You will find a hot air blower (eg, a
hair dryer) essential for heat shrinking the various sleeves
to be placed over wire joints.
If you wish to make sure you tighten the extruder nozzle correctly as recommended, you will also need a torque
wrench that reads down to 3.5 Newton-metres as well as
a matching 13mm socket. Also, I found it useful to have
at hand a 30cm steel rule, scissors (for the bags) and small
spirit level. Finally, you will need a small vice and (unless
you have superb eyesight) a maggy lamp for the surface
mount work. I also found a miniature high-speed handheld
grinder set useful on one occasion.
Before leaving the tools, I should also mention the soldering iron. The instructions specify ‘ceramic soldering iron
30W’. Don’t worry about ‘ceramic’ but the iron should have
a very fine point (for the one excursion to surface mount
work) and sufficient capacity to quickly solder various connectors and wires, so a 25/30W instrument is best.
As for supplies, everything is in the kit except for solder
- and it is also advisable to obtain some isopropyl alcohol
from the chemist for cleaning the print bed later.
At last – opening the box!
With everything prepared and all tools at the ready, at
last I opened the box, to reveal a very large assortment of
parts, mostly in plastic bags labelled with numbers.
The reason for the heavy weight of the box quickly be-
It’s helpful to lay out the plastic mouldings.
16 Silicon Chip
came apparent. Although the frame for this printer consists
of cleverly designed extruded aluminium alloy members
with various aluminium plates, a major item is the four
heavy stepper motors which are the heart of the machine.
The main moving parts of the machine centre around heavy
stainless steel shafts.
3D printing – a refresher
We’ve covered the operating principles of 3D printers
before but for the newcomer I’ll briefly revise. The purpose
of a 3D printer is to fabricate some solid object which can be
any shape provided it fits into the available work-space and
can be any material within the capabilities of the machine.
For a home printer this is invariably a form of plastic such
as PLA (PolyLactic Acid).
Traditional fabricating methods are subtractive. That is,
we start off with a piece of material, be it plastic, metal or
as required. We then machine off chunks (typically on a
lathe, mill or drill) and finish up with the shape we require
plus a pile of shavings/filings (which in some cases can
be recycled).
By contrast, 3D printing is an additive process. For the
typical home 3D printer, we start off with a plastic material
(such as PLA) in the form of a filament a couple of millimetres thick and we draw it into a heated extruder head
which melts it to a malleable state. It is then deposited on
a heated printing bed in a thin thread to start to build up
the shape we require.
If you think of a conventional (or 2D) computer printer,
it prints in two axes, side-to-side on the page (the X-axis)
and up-and-down the page (the Y-axis). 3D printing adds
an extra axis, the Z-axis, which adds vertical thickness.
It does this by moving the relative position of the extruder
head under tight control in those three planes.
Note that the expression is relative position. In theory
this could be achieved by moving the extruder itself in the
three dimensions. In practice, in this particular machine,
the X and Y movements are both accomplished by means
of moving the printing bed (on which the fabricated object
will be built) backwards, forwards and from side to side,
while the Z-axis is dealt with by moving the extruder head
up and down.
The frame is constructed from heavy-duty aluminium
extrusion which helps maintain precision.
siliconchip.com.au
SPECIFICATIONS: Velleman K8200 3D Printer (when completed from kit)
Mechanical resolution:
X and Y: 0.015mm
(smallest step the printing plate can move in the X and Y direction)
(nominal)
Z:
0.781m
(smallest step the printing plate can move in the Z direction)
Printing resolution:
Wall thickness (X,Y):
0.5mm
(nominal)
Layer thickness (Z):
0.20 - 0.25mm
Typical printing speed: 120mm/s
Maximum print speed:
150 to 300mm/s (depending on the object to be printed)
Extrusion nozzle:
0.5mm
Extrusion thermistor:
NTC 100kΩ
Extruded aluminium profiles: 27.5mm wide
Movement:
4 NEMA 17 stepper motors
Linear ball bearings:
8 and 10mm
Technology:
FFF (Fused Filament Fabrication) for PLA and ABS
FTDI USB 2.0 to Serial:
Arduino compatible (Sanguino derived motherboard)
Printable area:
200(L) x 200(W) x 200(H)mm
Software:
Repetier version 0.84 and up
System Requirements:
Windows, Mac or Linux computer to print from
An internet connection for manual and construction instructions
Power supply:
15V / 6.6A max
Complete unit size:
620(H) x 500(W) x 420(D)mm
Imagine now that we want to fabricate a box. We need to
arrange that the molten plastic is deposited on the print bed
in a line of the given length, then at right angles, and again
at right angles, again a third time, coming back to where
we were. So far we have a thin layer of plastic shaped like
a rectangle.
Now if we raise the extruder head slightly and repeat
the process, the new plastic will be deposited on top of the
old and we will have a slightly thicker line. Repeating this
process over and over will build up the sides of our box.
Clearly, we need to ensure that the plastic is extruded
at just the right rate (and the right temperature) and that
the printing bed is moved in the X and Y-axes while the
extruder head is moved in the Z-axis – all under tight control
determined by the object we want to create.
This is accomplished mechanically by stepper motors,
toothed belts and cogs, controlled by an electronic unit
itself driven by software. In particular, this form of what
we call CNC (computer numeric control) operation makes
use of the G code.
G code is a standardised form of issuing instructions to
move tools by exact distances and in exact directions, as
well as commanding such operations such as changing
drills (CNC drilling machines), changing pens (CNC 2D
plotters) or in this case, stopping and starting the flow of
plastic from the extruder head.
The stepper motor is a critical component in the movement in the three planes and in gradually building up the
3D ‘image’. As its name suggests, a stepper motor, rather
than rotating at speed, rotates in a more sedate manner and
often by just a small fraction of one revolution as instructed.
Parts for the X-Y axis assembly.
The X-stepper motor in position, held by hex-head bolts
and square nuts.
siliconchip.com.au
The build
Let’s now move on to the nitty gritty and start building.
The first part of the machine to be built (at Chapter 1) is
the simple spool holder assembly, which Velleman call the
‘coil support’ and which is used to support the spool of
October 2014 17
raw material (plastic filament). This is not a part with any
critical dimension or even function; indeed some printers
don’t have a spool holder, relying on paying out the filament from a loose pile beside the machine.
Once built, the spool holder is put aside until the machine
is virtually finished. So I think the reason for building it
first is to accustom the user to the method of instruction
accompanied by the excellent illustrations.
Actually I found that I tended to hit my face against the
spool holder from time to time as I bent over the machine
during construction, setting up and testing, so having fitted it when instructed I subsequently removed it until the
machine was completely finished and calibrated.
The instructions break down the construction of the
printer into easy chunks and all follow a similar format.
The user is first instructed to take an easily identifiable
major piece (such as part of the framework) or a bag of
given number, in which case the parts inside are clearly
listed and shown, both in words (usually) and by means
of a clear illustration.
Usually, all the parts in a given bag are used in the construction step that immediately follows. In rare cases some
of the parts are used later so before opening the next bag,
if there are pieces left from the current bag they should be
popped back in as the bag number will be referred to later.
Follow the instructions!
After the parts are listed, the detailed instruction for
that step follow and often are accompanied by measurements where the rule or calliper comes into play. At this
stage I should warn that the length of bolts is critical. If a
10mm M4 bolt is specified, don’t fit a 15mm one or else
you will find a later step cannot be accomplished. I found
only one case where I had to reduce the size of bolts, as
advised in Chapter 9 (using a file) where in fact I used a
small grinder tool.
There are 20 separate chapters in the build section and a
total of 858 high quality photographs accompanying them.
These illustrations are not captioned as such but a glance
further down the screen will reveal the photograph jpg
number in each case.
This is in the format of chapter/illustration, eg 004/043
for Chapter 4, illustration number 43. I have used the same
convention when discussing the steps.
Details of the X-Y axis assembly – linear bearings sliding
on steel rods.
18 Silicon Chip
One of the toothed belts. The first length to be cut is
critical. Follow the instructions!
Do you tend to skim (or even skip!) instructions and
work by ‘common-sense’ like those people who proudly
claim their method of testing an electronic item is to try
using it before looking at the manual? That approach is not
appropriate for this kit and will lead to much frustration
as the build progresses. These instructions deserve very
careful following to a precise degree.
If a washer is shown under a bolt, that is where to place
it and not under the mating nut. If the instructions say ‘do
not tighten this nut yet’ be sure to follow them — there
will be a good reason.
Later, when you know more about what you are doing
there may be one or two occasions where you can depart
slightly from the exact instructions.
Don’t force or over-tighten!
If a part doesn’t appear to fit it is almost certainly the
wrong part. Nothing should need forcing and nothing
should require that last resort of the kit builder — the
hammer!
Also, if you are one of those ‘no half measures’ folk and
especially if you often work on larger mechanical jobs like
a car or bike, you must avoid over-tightening. Screwing up
tight does not mean yanking the spanner with all your might
until it’s locked solid. Smaller diameter nuts and bolts will
need much less force than the larger ones.
In this regard, the length of common right-angled Allen
(hex) keys in particular is related to the leverage and force
to be applied and for this reason I avoid those admittedly
comfortable Allen keys with plastic T handles and rely on
the traditional pattern of hex key as illustrated at the start
of the instructions.
How far to tighten small fixings is largely a matter of feel
and sometimes sad experience! A guide is the state of the
star (spring) washer that is on most nut/bolt assemblies.
Where tightening is instructed, the bolt and nut should be
tightened so that the washer (viewed from the side) begins
The X-Y axis assembly assembled and sliding smoothly!
siliconchip.com.au
to be noticeably compressed but not screwed hard down
so that it cannot be moved any further.
I found that all the parts but one were of very high quality.
The one exception was an adaptor that secures a threaded
rod to the Z-stepper motor, which I found to be minutely
eccentric, although perfectly usable. I did find that some of
the aluminium plates had sharp edges in one or two places
and this was improved by a very light application of a file.
As you will find as the build progresses, the framework
is made of cleverly extruded aluminium in which square
nuts are located as required to locate numerous other parts,
with the aid of cast corner pieces or plastic mouldings.
The plastic mouldings are themselves of precision
manufacture with no ‘slop’ whatever detected in fitting.
The X and Y print bed movements are accomplished by
moving the carriages smoothly with the aid of linear bearings running on precision ground bars. The Z movement
is by courtesy of a rotating lead screw
The copious instructions and photos are very nearly
perfect. I’ll mention the rare problems that I found in the
order that they occurred.
One general anomaly is that although at first the terms
‘bolt’ and ‘nut’ are correctly used to mean male and female
fasteners respectively (‘screw’ being sometimes used in
Australia to mean ‘bolt’), they are reversed in some of the
instructions (but not all of them). The illustrations make it
clear when a ‘nut’ is really a bolt and vice versa!
Linear bearings and circlips
At 002/011 and subsequent illustrations in this chapter
we have our first introduction to linear bearings. The plastic
holders are of high quality as already mentioned but an
even greater degree of precision is given by the inserted
linear bearings which will later slide on the bars. These
bearings are secured using circlips in grooves and it is worth
repeating the caution that they should only be fitted using
proper circlip pliers that locate in the circlip end holes.
If you’ve never used circlips before, you need to remember that their flexibility is limited. The correct way
to apply one is to engage the circlip pliers in the small
holes, then offer up the circlip to the shaft or in this case
bearing and gently squeeze on the pliers just enough to
allow the circlip to slide onto the bearing, until it locates
in the groove provided. Tension is then released and the
I managed to break a belt clamp – fortunately there were
spares.
siliconchip.com.au
clip should click into place.
Aligning the bearings
As instructed, you will not at first fully tighten the plastic
mouldings onto the X-plate but it is helpful to align them
by eye. This will be refined when the bearing bars are fitted,
and the aim is to allow a smooth sliding movement over
the bars, before attempting to tighten the fixing bolts. The
same applies later with the other linear bearings.
By 002/064 we come to the mounting of the first of the
four stepper motors. This was one place where the design
was found to be good rather than excellent, in that the wires
to this motor pass through the aluminium plate that makes
up the X carriage rather close to the edge of the provided
hole (002/068). Care needs to be taken that the wires do
not chafe here.
When it comes to 002/072 and successive illustrations,
you need to be very careful about two things. The instruction rightly emphasizes that there should be exactly 127
teeth in the 63.5 cm length of belt that you cut. The length
of this piece of belt is indeed critical and the old adage
‘measure twice and cut once’ comes into play!
Also you need to be careful tightening the clamp. Although mindful of my general warning (and previous
experience), I still managed to over-tighten my belt clamp
and break it. What I should have borne in mind is that
the clamp presses against an inherently flexible material
- viz rubber - and an even more gentle hand is required
as tightening never reaches the invisible ‘wall’ that we
instinctively aim for!
Fortunately, spare belt clamps were included in the
number of parts I had left over!
Care with exact measurements
A good example of the care that needs to be taken over
the correct choice of plastic parts is at 004/008. In fact
there are several pieces of very similar appearance but only
some have the 10mm recesses required at this stage while
others have 8mm. The illustration emphasises this in red.
First anomaly
In Chapter 7 I came across the first real anomaly. The
instructions for fitting the Z-motor bracket are that the bottom of this bracket should be fitted at a height of between
They look alike but some are for 8mm rods while some are
for 10mm rods.
October 2014 19
4cm and 4.5cm from the top of the frame, and illustrations
007/008 to 007/011 confirm this. But by 007/016 the bracket
is shown level with the top of the frame, with the fitted
motor correspondingly lower.
That new position is shown in later illustrations such as
007/022. However, if you fit the motor in the lower position
as I did, you will find that near the end of the construction
it becomes apparent that the Z-axis end stop microswitch
will not be actuated until the extruder head has collided
with the print bed! The higher position is the correct one!
Incidentally, the instructions preceding 007/008 emphasize the need to ensure that the Z-motor bracket is fitted perfectly horizontally. The reason for this is that the threaded
Z-rod to be added to the motor spindle in due course will
not fit or run correctly as it won’t be truly vertical if the
bracket is even slightly out of kilter.
This is where the spirit level comes in and by the way, it
is not good enough to have the bubble ‘about’ in the middle of the sight. It must be exactly in the middle (assuming
that the workbench itself is also level)! If the spirit level
refuses to settle down, there may be a small manufacturing
pip on the bracket (in which case carefully file that down).
At 008/007 there is an instruction to ‘...take the short
M5 bolt...’. This is better understood as ‘...take a short M5
bolt...’, since there are three in bag 28, as shown in 008/001.
(The other two are used at 008/015 to 008/017).
At 008/012 and 013, the instructions again indicate that
the motor bracket should be perfectly horizontal. A small
spirit level is of course helpful here – if not essential – but
you may find that it is irritatingly difficult to set, as I did.
This may well require a manufacturing pip to be carefully
filed off so that the spirit level will seat correctly.
At 009/068 the illustration shows Philips head bolts
but those supplied in my kit were much better hex head
ones, a sign that the instructions and/or kit are subject to
continuous improvement.
At 012/014 I found (for the one and only time) that the
M3 bolt was just too short. I had to relieve a lip on the side
of the microswitch as well as omit the flat washer.
At 012/016, the illustrations show the microswitch secured through the hole nearest to the switch pivot. This was
one case where I departed from the instructions as the far
hole positioned the switch more appropriately in relation
to the actuating screw on the X-carriage.
Relief for electronic people
The heated print bed. If not perfectly flat, it can be pressed
until it is.
Assembling the Z-axis bearing carriage. A bench vice is
very handy here.
20 Silicon Chip
At Chapter 15 we begin the all-important wiring process.
Subsequent instructions call for the stripping and tinning
of various wire ends, followed in due course by joining
them. Since successfully soldering together two already
tinned wires can require three hands, I have a preference
for twisting joints together first and then soldering them.
As you will see, all soldered joints are covered by heat
shrink tubing. Most electronics enthusiasts have had the
experience of soldering (often one of the older multiway
connectors) and then realising that they had forgotten the
end cap which should have gone on the wires first! This
is the mistake you only make once or twice! Similarly,
remember to place heat shrink sleeves over the wires before
soldering joints. Again, clear and illustrated instructions
are given to this effect.
A minor anomaly in the instructions concerns the colours
involved in the occasional need to snip off the middle wire
on a three wire polarised header. For example, in 016/028
this is said to be orange but on my 3-way connectors the
middle wire is in fact red, leaving orange and brown connected. In 016/035 the connections should therefore be
(in the order of ribbon cable to connector cable): red -->
orange, and brown --> brown. This also occurs at 017/021
and 018/057.
018/002 the instructions say ‘...twist the wires from
Group 2 and 3 together’. It would be clearer to say ‘...twist
the wires from group 2 together with each other as well
as the wires from group 3 together with each other...’, as
shown in 018/003.
In 019/043 the larger heat shrink sleeve should be first
placed over two wires from the hot end and not four.
At the end of the build I had several parts left over. These
included an extruder head thermistor (very thoughtful as
this part is easily damaged), six square nuts, a couple of
washers and in particular, quite a few plastic mouldings
siliconchip.com.au
(three of which were belt clamps, an easily broken part).
There were no parts missing during the build, but despite
being careful with recommended lengths I did run out of
heatshrink sleeving just before the end (thankfully I had
a stock).
Setting up and printing
We now move on the various tests, downloading and
setting up software and finally printing an object!
These activities are described under ‘Start Printing’ at
www.k8200.eu/manual/printing
There are seven chapters in this section, this time starting
with Chapter 001 and finishing at Chapter 007.
Chapter 001 The Basics: This is a brief summary of the
basic principles involved in 3D printing.
Chapter 002 Connecting the printer: This chapter starts
with instructions on downloading the USB driver for the
controller board, that for Windows being downloaded from
http://ftdichip.com/Drivers/VCP.htm (at the time of writing,
drivers for Mac and Linux were under development). This
is a Zip file so be sure to extract before you try to run it.
That process finishes with establishing which COM port
will be in use for the controller board.
After connecting the controller board to the computer via
the miniature USB plug, you will find that red and green
LEDs on the board come on.
Once that is done, the next step is to download the main
software for operating the 3D printer. This is found at
www.repetier.com At the time of writing, the Velleman
notes recommend using version V0.84, although the instructions may change in due course as there are now later
versions available. This file is valid for Windows, Mac and
Linux. The download process ends with the placing of the
Repetier icon on the desktop.
There are then detailed Repetier instructions for setting
the COM port (which you have noted earlier) and various
parameters on the printer, such as the dimensions of the
workpiece, temperature of the extrusion head and print bed.
Note that so far the controller board has not been energised (apart from incidentally via the USB port). The illustrations of the 15V DC power supply that follow (002/010
to 002/016) show the mains lead (after the outer sleeve has
been stripped) being wrapped around a ferrite filter. The
power supply unit that I received already had a filter built
The Z-axis arm in position, with three guide rods.
siliconchip.com.au
in, so a much shorter length of wire had to be stripped.
When connecting the power supply, at 002/019 there
is a warning that if “anything happens when you do this,
disconnect the supply immediately”. Certainly at this stage
no motors should operate but in fact something should
happen, and that is that the red and green LEDs (which
come on when the USB port is correctly connected and
configured) should now go off.
When it comes to 002/025, Adjusting driver voltages,
the parts involved are extremely small and you will note at
002/030 that three hands are necessary to carry out this task.
The easiest — delegated to my assistant — was holding the
negative probe of the test meter in contact with the negative
DC supply screw. Extreme care is needed when holding
the positive probe on each driver sub-board via, when the
tip of the finest probe looks as delicate as a telegraph pole
under a lens, in comparison with the job at hand!
The actual adjustment of the driver voltage is very tricky.
Unless you have just the right tool there will be considerable backlash. The recommended voltage is 0.425V but note
that striving for the last digit is pointless. For example, an
error of 0.005V here amounts to about 1% — meaningless
— and ±5% (reasonable) would take the setting from 0.404V
to 0.446V. Indeed, we are instructed that any of the three
motor drives may be increased to as much as 0.550V (approximately 29% higher) if the motor mechanical linkages
are too stiff for the setting first recommended. This is more
likely on the Z-axis where the trueness of the threaded rod
adaptor is critical.
Tests
We now come to tests via the Repetier software, notably
movement of the motors and positioning gear. If you have
wired everything correctly, then these are very satisfying
and in my case went without a hitch.
During this setup process (in 002/068) you are asked
to move the print bed completely to the left. How far, I
wondered? Against the frame or to line up the print head
with the extremity of the bed?
The answer is that it doesn’t matter at this time because
the only reason for moving the bed to the left is to allow
room to test the X-motor microswitch (on the right). Similarly for the Y-microswitch (at the back). When testing the
Z-microswitch you have more time/room to carry out tests as
The extrusion head carrier components, including the
main bolt and bearings.
October 2014 21
A small torque wrench with 13mm socket is advisable for
setting the hot end.
the Z movement when the lead-screw turns is much slower.
Do not allow yourself to be distracted during these tests
or failure to stop the motor travel may cause collisions or
even injury!
At 002/079 at the end of the tests on the Z limit microswitch, you are told ‘If the microswitch is working correctly the Z-carriage will stop.’ The X and Y movements
do instantly stop when their respective microswitches are
operated but the behaviour of the Z-carriage is slightly different. When the microswitch is operated it first stops and
then immediately backs off (up) a couple of millimetres.
This was confirmed as normal.
Calibrating the printer
In Chapter 3 we move on to calibrating the printer. As the
instructions say, this stage is critical to good print quality.
I did have problems here with my Z-motor stalling with
a buzz when the print head was still some millimetres
from the print bed — probably caused by the very slight
eccentricity of my threaded rod/motor adaptor — despite
resetting the Z-motor potentiometer to 0.55V (the permitted
upper limit explained in just before 002/031).
I worked around the problem by re-positioning the print
head arm assembly down a few millimetres in the frame
so that the print head was closer to the print bed while
the Z-nut was not quite so far down on the threaded rod.
I also found that my print bed was not quite flat which was
initially frustrating. However, there is a critical sentence
in the penultimate paragraph ‘The heated bed, cardboard
isolator and aluminium bed plate can be forced a little bit
until the bulge in the middle is gone.’ As advised earlier,
brute force techniques should never be needed or employed
in this build, and I found that judicious pressing on the
centre of the print bed was effective in due course
Configuring Slic3r
There appears to be a minor error in the first sentence
of Chapter 4, which reads ‘After you have calibrated your
printer and printed...’. At this stage you will not have
Starting on the extrusion head carrier.
22 Silicon Chip
Some of the hot end components. In use they become hot!
printed so those last two quoted words can be deleted.
The configuration file K8200-PLA-STANDARD “download” will be found at www.velleman.eu, navigating via
support > downloads where you will find K8200-PLASTANDARD.INI. This is a Zip file and you will need to
extract it before loading it into Repetier as instructed.
You now set the print, filament and printer settings to
match the Velleman printer, save the settings and that’s the
configuration done.
The first print
Velleman have chosen for the first print a fairly ambitious model, being a cover for the controller board on the
printer itself.
I say ‘ambitious’ not because the model is particularly
complex but because it is fairly large, uses quite an amount
of PLA filament and takes a long time to build.
At 005/011 you are instructed to download the
K8200BOARDCOVER.STL file, which you will find at www.
k8200.eu/support/downloads or at www.thingiverse.com
where it is thing No. 15524. STL can either stand for STereoLithography or Standard Tessellation Language and is
the native 3D file that specifies the solid model exactly and
in a form which Repetier can slice (via Slic3r) and interpret
into the G Code that actually controls the printer.
Again, this is a Zip file, so will need to be extracted.
Pressing the LOAD button on Repetier now results in a
navigation pane from which you can access the newly
extracted STL file.
Of course you are not limited to the one model! There are
a host of STL files available on the net, an especially good
selection being found at www.thingiverse.com/
Problems?
For problems generally, you may find the answer on
Feed mechanism taking shape!
siliconchip.com.au
4DSC Oct Ad final.pdf 1 8/28/2014 11:26:31 AM
%
5
1
SAVE
UCTS
ROD C 1 5
P
D
S 4
CTE
: 4D
SELE E n te r C o d e mber 201
s
Expire
st N o v e
on 1
*Conditions apply
INTELLIGENT DISPLAY MODULES
A perfect solution for any design requiring a
brilliance of color, animation or images on
any application
4D Systems designs, develops and manufactures intelligent graphics solutions using the latest
OLED and LCD technology available, with custom graphics processors that enable both stand
alone and host dependent solutions suitable for a very wide range of applications and projects.
NEW
NEW
NEW
Picadillo-35T
uLCD-220RD
uLCD-35DT
uOLED-96-G2-AR
uLCD-144-G2-AR
uLCD-32-PTU-AR
DISPLAY MODULES for ARDUINO*
Providing a quick and easy-to-use display
solution for any Arduino project
DISPLAY MODULES for RASPBERRY PI*
NEW
Broaden the variety of your Raspberry Pi
projects by integrating a display solution
uLCD-24-PTU-PI
4DPI-35
uLCD-28-PTU-PI
DISPLAY MODULEs for bEAGLEBONE*
Attach a primary display to your Beaglebone
Black with a 4D LCD CAPE
4DCAPE-43
*Trademarks do not belong to 4D Systems.
All trademarks belong to their respective owners.
SC
www.4dsystems.com.au
4DCAPE-43T
www.facebook.com/4DSystemsAU
4DCAPE-70T
www.twitter.com/4DSystems
the excellent forum which can be found at http://forum.
velleman.be/ There, beginners and old hands exchange
information and you are likely to find a post from someone
who has had the same problems as yourself as well as the
solution.
Conclusion
This has been a marvellous journey lasting several days,
and like many journeys the joy has been in getting there –
making it – even more than in the successful arrival. Apart
from very minor instruction anomalies easily overcome
with commonsense, the instructions have been accurate,
detailed and helpful. The copious illustrations – hundreds
of them – have been extremely effective in clarifying the
steps to take.
I have no hesitation in warmly recommending this kit;
the components are robust and extremely well made. Building the Velleman K8200 printer is a major project that will
provide hours of enjoyment, a notable absence of frustration
and will result in a practical machine which will reward
continuing study and experimentation.
The 3D printing world has not yet fully matured so you
get a feeling of pioneering when using the finished item.
At the same time this is no flimsy and partly thought-out
kit. It will form a solid basis for further learning.
Where from, how much?
The controller board. All wiring terminates here, mostly on
polarised headers.
siliconchip.com.au
The Velleman K8200 3D Printer we reviewed came from
Jaycar Electronics and is available at all Jaycar stores, resellers and online (www.jaycar.com.au). The kit retails for
$1299.00 (Cat No TL4020).
SC
October 2014 23
Introducing:
’
‘The Currawong
By LEO SIMPSON
& NICHOLAS VINEN
A 21st Century, All-Australian Audio Amplifier featuring both
Valve and Solid State Technology
The Currawong is a paradox: a stereo amplifier design that’s as modern
as tomorrow but uses a 1950s-era valve power amplifier design! It has
a power output of around 10 watts per channel into 8-ohm loads and
is mainly built on one PCB. Using the tried and tested ultra-linear
class AB configuration with four valves in each channel, it would be
a great match for our recently-described Majestic 2-way loudspeakers.
W
e have had this amplifier
under development for
about six months but it has
been the subject of lively discussion
in the SILICON CHIP offices for considerably more time than that, with
extra stimulation from occasional
correspondence from readers with a
deep desire to build and own a modern
valve amplifier.
And while it might have seemed as
though we have ignored these plaintive requests, we have had it in mind
to “do something” about a definitive
“modern” valve amplifier, if only to
finally settle the debate about the relative merits of solid-state versus valve
amplifiers.
Well, this amplifier is ultra-modern
in a number of respects. It uses a large
double-sided PCB with plated-through
holes for virtually all of the circuitry,
apart from a small daughter board for
the infrared remote control and the
connections to the power transformers. It also uses very compact modern
PC-mount electrolytic capacitors for
the high voltage filter and bypass
capacitors.
No electrolytics are used for signal
coupling. Instead, we have employed
dipped polyester (polyethylene terapthalate) capacitors for the high
voltage signal coupling and MKT
24 Silicon Chip
We believe this to be very close to the final PCB layout, although there may
be some minor component changes as we tweak performance. Apart from the
power transformers, almost everything mounts on one double-sided board.
siliconchip.com.au
While it’s pure valve in the preamp and
power amp, we will upset the purists by
using semiconductor diodes in the power
supply along with a few LEDs . . .
polyester capacitors for low voltage
signal coupling.
And all the low power resistors
are modern 1% tolerance metal film
resistors. The valve line-up in each
channel consists of two 12AX7 twin
triodes and two 6L6 (or KT66) beam
power tetrodes.
So apart from the valves themselves,
the components are modern and far superior to those available in the heyday
of these amplifiers.
The Currawong circuit
So what does the circuit configuration look like? Since the amplifier is
still in the development and testing
stage, it is too early to publish the circuit. We aim to do that – and present
the construction details – very soon.
However, by sheer coincidence, this
month’s Vintage Radio section carries
an article about the restoration of a
Mullard 5/10 valve power amplifier
(see pages 92-97).
This was a highly-regarded mono
amplifier for hobbyists that was first
published in 1954. Two were needed
for stereo operation. A stereo version,
the Mullard 10-10, was produced
much later, with a very similar circuit
arrangement but instead of 6L6s in the
output stages, it used 6GW8 triodepentodes. It also used two large PCBs,
siliconchip.com.au
. . . and we probably should
mention the infrared remote volume control also has a
few semiconductors, too. Then again, we’ve never seen a
valve-powered infrared remote!
one for each channel.
It just happens that the circuit arrangement of the 60-year old Mullard
5/10 is very similar to that of the Currawong, except that the Mullard valve
line-up includes an EF86 pentode as
a preamplifier stage rather than the
12AX7.
Preamplifier stage
With regard to the preamp stage, we
can be much more specific because it
is based on the 12AX7 valve preamplifier published in the February 2004
issue of SILICON CHIP, with only slight
changes to the component values.
In brief, the preamp is a two-stage
design with negative feedback applied
from the plate of the second triode to
the cathode of the first. The heaters
for all four 12AX7s are fed from a
regulated 12V DC supply, to ensure
low hum.
Power amplifier stage
Following the preamp stage, the circuit of the Currawong is conceptually
very similar to that of the Mullard 5/10.
The two 6L6s drive an output
transformer in Class-AB mode, essentially meaning that one valve
handles the positive half (or swing)
of the signal while the second valve
handles the negative swing, similar to
a transformer-coupled Class B transistor output stage.
The transformer primary is centretapped and the primary leads are
connected to the respective plates
(anodes) of the valves. Thus the transformer provides the high voltage DC
to the plates but the magnetic fields
produced by the separate valve currents are cancelled in the transformer
core; otherwise it would be liable to
saturate.
Since the output stage works in
push-pull mode, the signals to the
grids of the two output valves must
be out-of-phase (ie, 180° phase shift
between them).
These out-of-phase signals are
derived by the two triodes within
the second 12AX7 in what would be
regarded today as a “long-tailed pair”
(similar to a 2-transistor differential
amplifier). An “in-phase” signal comes
from the plate of the second triode,
while the out-of-phase signal comes
from the plate of the first triode.
The input signal to the “long-tailed
pair” is fed to the grid of the first triode
while the grid of the second triode is
effectively grounded. This will be fully
explained in the circuit description
(when we publish those details).
The other significant feature of the
output stage is the “so-called” ultraOctober 2014 25
As a concession to
21st century operating
convenience, this little
remote control PCB
(shown at left very close
to life size) is suspended
underneath the main PCB
(shown in situ at right). It
employs a microprocessor
to control a motor-driven
volum potentiometer, also
suspended under the main
PCB. Of course, if you
must have genuine 1950s
operation, you could always
substitute a standard pot . . .
linear output connection whereby the
screens of the tetrodes are connected
to 80% taps on the primary of the
transformer. This is (and was) a very
highly regarded configuration providing much lower distortion.
There is also limited negative
feedback from the secondary
of the output transformer to
the cathode of the second
valve in the 2-stage preamplifier. Again, all of this is quite
similar to the configuration of
the Mullard 5/10.
The valves
Like most valves these
days, those in The Currawong
are of Russian manufacture,
typically branded Sovtek or
electro-harmonix and available
in Australia from Altronics Distributors or Jaycar Electronics.
Our initial results show that
the harmonic distortion will be
quite low (maybe around 0.2%
in the mid frequencies), about
what we would expect.
But the amplifier will be particularly quiet, mainly as a result
of the DC fed to the filaments of the
small signal triode stages. Any more
detail about performance will have to
wait until the final amplifier design is
present, maybe in a month or so.
The power supply is based on two
toroidal power transformers, one to
supply the AC and DC rails for the
valve heaters while the other provides
the DC HT (high tension) rails for the
valve plates (or anodes).
And while the 12AX7 heaters are
fed with DC from an adjustable 3-terminal regulator, the HT rail is also a
departure from 60-year old practice.
26 Silicon Chip
In this case, the DC supply is derived from two 1000V silicon diodes
and two 470F 400V capacitors in a
voltage-doubler configuration to develop about 310V DC.
This configuration is
very similar to that
used in valve TV sets
produced in Australia in the 1960s.
Our up-date of the
circuit is to feed
to the DC from the
voltage doubler to a
3-transistor capaciThe valve line up
consists of two
6L6s (left) and
two 12AX7s in
each channel.
tance multiplier which greatly reduces
the 100Hz ripple on the HT rail. This
also contributes to the general quietness of the amplifier.
This part of the circuit also provides
a switch-on delay for the HT rail so
that no DC is fed to the valves until
their filaments have provided a suitable preheating. Both these features
could have only been dreamed of in
the 1950s.
Mind you, these measures will have
little effect on the overall quality of the
“valve sound” apart from the overall
quietness. We hope the purists won’t
mind...
Other refinements
While there are no solid-state devices used in the signal path in the
main amplifier, we have made some
concessions to 21st Century operating
convenience.
In other words it will have an infrared motor-driven volume control that
is quite similar to the volume control
for the Ultra-LD Mk3 amplifier (See
SILICON CHIP, November 2011).
The only other “refinement” worth
mentioning at this stage is that we have
added blue LEDs on the PCB to illuminate the output transformers. This
is purely a cosmetic feature. Again, if
the purists don’t like the LEDs (“but
LEDs weren’t invented in the 1950s!”),
they could be omitted.
Mention of the transformers brings
us to the other interesting feature
of this amplifier. As old-time valve
amplifier enthusiasts will attest,
the output transformer was always
the most critical and most expensive
component in a high quality circuit.
It still is. In fact, high quality ultralinear output transformers typically
run to several hundred dollars each!
Gulp.
And this is the interesting feature.
We have employed standard 100V
line transformers normally used in
PA amplifiers. Conveniently, we are
able to use the power taps on the
transformer for the screen connections
to the tetrodes.
Intrigued? It works quite well. But
you will have to wait patiently until
we have fully checked the final design.
Until then, stay tuned...
SC
siliconchip.com.au
Electrolytic
Rust Removal
By Dr David Maddison
Got something old and rusted lying about that you’d rather have old and
not-so-rusty? We cannot promise miracles but you might be surprised
how easy it is to restore rusted items to their (somewhat!) former glory!
T
here are plenty of objects
around most homes that would
benefit from rust removal, for
example old tools, old car or engine
parts for use in restorations, components of antique electrical items (eg,
a rusted battery holder), garden furniture and many other items.
And there are many methods and
products to remove rust, which have
various levels of success.
Common methods include me-
chanical techniques in which rust
is removed by the abrasive action
of sandpaper, a wire brush or high
speed particles from a sandblaster; or
chemical techniques in which rust is
removed or converted to something
more stable by a chemical agent such
as an acid.
All these methods have some disadvantages, such as the removal of good
metal – not just the rust – or the conversion (but not removal) of the rust
This rusty mint tin was found by the side of the road. It’s not
in the best of condition . . .
siliconchip.com.au
to something more stable, thus losing
information as to the original shape
of the object and obliterating features
such as markings in the original metal.
In addition, proprietary chemicals for
rust removal or conversion can be
expensive and somewhat toxic.
The aim is to restore the artefact
to as close to original condition as
possible, not just make it look pretty!
Another promising method of rust
removal that has increasing popularity
. . . but after treatment, came out quite well. The paint was
removed but that’s usual with electrolytic rust removal.
October 2014 27
APPLICABILITY OF METHOD
While this method has been widely tested by numerous people
and in various places, as with any new procedure, before using it on
an important object, you should test the process in your particular
circumstances and with your own setup on a test part for which
it does not matter if the process does not work to expectations.
This article deals specifically with mild steel items that have
rusted in air (due to the action of humidity or rain) or have been
submerged in fresh water or have been buried in soil.
A slightly different and more sophisticated method is required
for the restoration of items that have been submerged in seawater
that does not seem to affect the original metal is to use molasses; however
this takes a very long time. Interested
readers may wish to Google this.
Electrolysis
Apart from the above methods,
there is another way. It involves the
use of electrolysis to remove rust. This
method only removes rust and leaves
the base (un-rusted) metal intact.
It may also reveal many details in
the original metal such as patterns
or stampings of numbers and letters
which seem completely obliterated by
the rust, which may not be preserved
using other methods.
This method has also been known
to restore items with moving parts
which were rusted solid and thought
to be completely beyond hope of restoration to working condition.
The method is simple and inexpensive and involves only household
items, apart from a low-voltage power
supply or maybe a car battery charger,
which most SILICON CHIP readers
would likely own anyway.
The details of the method will be
discussed in detail later but in essence, a container holding an aqueous solution of a common chemical
is set up with two electrodes and a
power supply, thus establishing an
electrolytic cell.
One electrode, the anode, is made of
mild steel and is gradually sacrificed
in the process. The other electrode is
the iron/steel piece under restoration.
Note that rust damage is permanent. This method will remove rust
for long periods. Since such artefacts (eg, ancient cannons and
anchors such as from the HMB Endeavour) are likely to be in the
realm of marine archaeology, this topic will not be discussed here.
Suffice to say, with such artefacts it becomes very important to
remove the chloride ions from the rusted artefact which takes a
long time and the chloride levels coming out of the artefact need
to be monitored until there are no more.
In addition, a different electrolyte chemical is used in the case
of objects rusted by salt water – for example sodium hydroxide
instead of sodium carbonate.
but no method will return original
metal that has disappeared. It is best
to store and maintain tools and other
items in an appropriate way to prevent them rusting in the first place.
What is rust?
Before discussing the electrolysis
process it is necessary to first discuss
the nature of rust.
Put simply, rust is iron metal combined with oxygen to form chemical
compounds known as various forms
of iron oxide.
The chemical reaction by which
rusting occurs is an electrochemical
one, since the flow of an electric current is involved. Iron loses electrons
and both oxygen and water take up
electrons and iron metal chemically
combines with oxygen.
The rusting of iron is said to be
an oxidation reaction. In effect, this
process forms a type of galvanic cell.
In the process to be described, the
objective is to reverse this rusting
process (to the extent possible via an
electrolytic process) via the opposite
of the oxidation reaction, called the
reduction reaction.
An electrolytic process is the opposite of an electrochemical one. In
an electrochemical process, reactions
are spontaneous (eg, rusting) but in an
electrolytic one, reactions only occur
when energy in the form of an electric
current is supplied.
There are several forms and colours
of iron oxide, depending upon the
conditions of formation. To form rust,
iron or steel requires contact with
both oxygen and water and if salts or
salt spray is present, rusting occurs
much more quickly.
Red rust
The most destructive type of rust
is the loose, poorly adherent, flaky,
porous material which occurs on
severely rusted items.
This rusted material has a significantly greater volume than the original metal from which it is derived.
When it happens in a constrained
space, such as with reinforcing bars
set in concrete, its expansion causes
destruction of the surrounding material (a condition commonly known as
“concrete cancer”).
The rusting of this material is nonreversible and represents a complete
and permanent loss of the original
metal.
This type of corrosion is often
called “red rust” and generally has
the chemical formula Fe2O3·nH2O
(hydrated ferric oxide) when the process has occurred in the presence of
oxygen and moisture.
This material has minimal or no
electrical conductivity.
The non-hydrated form of this
compound is the mineral haematite,
from which iron is originally derived.
Because of the limited electrical
conductivity of this type of rust it is
mainly unaffected by the electrolytic
process in terms of reducing it back
to iron.
However, because it is porous the
electrolyte solution will generally
go through it and conduct electric
This rusty nut and bolt combination was first processed as one piece as one nut had seized. After a period of electrolysis
the nut could be removed and the pieces were processed separately.
28 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
(connected to the positive terminal).
At the cathode, which is the rusty
object to be restored, it is hoped that
as much of the oxidised iron as possible is reduced to iron metal. As
explained above, not all rust (such
as most of the flaky red rust) can be
reduced in this way (although some
may be reduced to black rust) but the
black rust, between the original metal
and the red rust, mostly can be.
What can be reduced back to metal
will be although this will mostly be
poorly adherent as will most of the
This horseshoe was buried in the ground for at least 90 years. It cleaned up very
rust remaining after treatment and it
nicely. If the same horsehoe had been in seawater even for a relatively short time,
will fall away or can be brushed away.
treatment would be very much different and probably not as successful.
As pure water does not conduct
current to the base metal. This is sig- original metal.
electricity to any significant degree,
nificant and will be discussed later.
It may be possible to revert this ma- an electrolyte chemical is added to
When the rust is not so severe that terial back to unoxidised (unrusted) the water to make it conduct. The
loose flakes of rust are generated, this metal by the electrolytic process de- electrolyte chemical is chosen on
same type of red rust may still be pre- scribed here. This reaction to convert the basis that it does not itself have
sent in the form of small “islands” of the oxide back to metal involves the adverse reactions that interfere with
rust, or as a thin continuous coating iron atom gaining electrons and los- the process.
all over an object.
ing oxygen.
Washing soda, also known as
While not necessarily being
soda ash or sodium carbonate,
strongly adherent, it can still be
Na2CO3 is most commonly used
difficult to remove.
in this process and is the basis
This is possibly the most
of this description.
familiar form of rust and may
It is safer to handle than the
As a general rule, antique objects are often signifibe present on tools or other obother frequently used electrocantly
devalued
by
attempts
to
clean
them,
including
jects that have been left in the
lyte, sodium hydroxide, NaOH,
the removal of rust.
open but not for so long that the
which is often used with restoCollectors appreciate the original “patina” of an
aforementioned type of rust can
ration of marine artefacts.
object so if you have a genuine antique, you should
develop.
Oxygen gas is evolved at the
consult an appropriately qualified antique expert as
sacrificial
anode and hydrogen
to whether the object should be cleaned or left as-is.
Black rust
gas
is
evolved
at the work piece
Our experience suggests the latter.
Beneath the red rust and
(cathode).
above the original uncorroded
As hydrogen is inflammable
This black rust is electrically con- and both gases together are explosive,
metal is usually a layer of “black
rust” which has the chemical formula ducting and magnetic and is also the container in which electrolysis
Fe3O4 (iron(II,III) oxide or more com- known as the mineral magnetite.
is done must be wide-open and the
monly ferrous-ferric oxide) and unprocedure must be done in a welllike red rust, this form of rust does not The electrolytic process
ventilated, open area free of ignition
During the electrolytic process, sources.
occupy a significantly greater volume
than the base metal from which it was a power supply causes a current to
The formation of hydrogen gas
derived. Therefore it is adherent and be passed via an electrolyte (a solu- bubbles within the rust layer also
tion which will conduct electricity) helps to mechanically clean the part
does not flake.
This layer is somewhat protective between the item under restoration as the expanding gas bubbles within
and may preserve some details such (the cathode, connected to the nega- the porous rust cause pieces of rust
as decorative stamp marks from the tive terminal) and a sacrificial anode to be pushed off.
Should you remove rust
from antiques?
(Above): A heavily rusted item (railway spike), shown
at right being processed. Note the evolution of gas from
the item. During electrolysis rust flakes fall away from
the object as shown. This item did not start to electrolyse
at first, so the voltage was increased to break whatever
barrier was causing the high resistance that was preventing
electrolysis and then the voltage was lowered.
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 29
Washing soda (sodium carbonate)
as used for the electrolyte. It is
available in the laundry section of
most supermarkets; swimming pool
‘pH increaser’ from pool shops or
hardware stores can also be used.
A plot of current versus voltage for one sample showing how the current starts
to rapidly rise at a certain point corresponding to a rapid increase in the
chemical reactions occurring. The reactions include the reduction of various
iron oxides and gas evolution corresponding to the electrolysis of water. The
current decreases as any new voltage increment is adjusted to so these currents
are recorded at the moment that the new voltage is set.
As the sodium carbonate is not
significantly consumed in the process
the solution can last indefinitely; it
only being necessary to top up the
water lost due to evaporation or gas
formation. However, sooner or later
the solution will become brown with
rust and will need to be replaced.
While the solution is not especially
toxic if only mild steel has been used
in both the cathode and the anode, it
is wise to consider where to dispose
of it. (Some plants might not like an
iron rich soil, for example.)
Experiment with the process to see
what you can do. For example, for
long parts like saw blades you can use
PVC plumbing pipe as a container.
Or for cleaning in tight places like an
engine block you could try putting a
wire anode inside a hose with lots of
small holes in it or a permeable drip
hose to get the electrode close to the
work part.
In such cases pay extreme care to the
build up of oxygen and hydrogen in
confined places and take appropriate
precautions. For parts that cannot be
submerged, perhaps a sponge soaked
in electrolyte can be used to make
contact with the part to be cleaned.
The sacrificial anode
The sacrificial anode should be
made of mild steel and should surround (but not touch) the object under
restoration to ensure that the electric
field on the object is evenly applied.
The sacrificial anode is eventually
dissolved so make sure it is a scrap
piece. Platinum (extremely expensive) or graphite can also be used for
the anode and will not dissolve like
mild steel.
While certain grades of stainless
steel can theoretically be used for
the anode, they should be avoided
because of the possibility of highly
toxic and carcinogenic chromium
ions being released into the solution.
Part of the anode should be above
the liquid level and this is where the
electrical connection to it is made. If
it is made within the liquid the connector will be destroyed.
The metal of the sacrificial anode
should not be coated. Commonly
available materials that are suitable
include scrap uncoated sheet metal
from car body work and uncoated steel
reinforcing bar and mesh.
A scrap piece of rebar mesh was
used for this story and was obtained
free from a nearby building site (with
permission!).
The mesh (shown in photo opposite)
was galvanised so the coating was
removed below the electrolyte level.
Most rebar you see on building sites
is uncoated and has that characteristic
red rust colour from being exposed to
the elements for a while.
SAFETY AND OTHER PRECAUTIONS
Both hydrogen and oxygen gas is generated with this procedure.
In combination, these gases can be explosive. Also, oxygen by
itself enhances combustion. This procedure MUST be conducted
in a well-ventilated area, away from sources of spark or flame (eg,
don’t smoke anywhere nearby!).
Turn the power supply off first before connecting or disconnecting
wires to avoid sparks.
For the sacrificial anode, only use mild steel (or graphite or
platinum if you can afford it!). Do not use stainless steel as toxic
chromium will go into the solution, even from 316 grade under
certain conditions. This also creates a disposal problem. Do not
30 Silicon Chip
allow the liquid solution to splash on the power supply or other
electrical devices.
As with all chemical processes, use safety glasses and latex
or other protective gloves as per good practice. Do not use this
process if you are not comfortable with using electricity or chemicals or are not confident or understanding of what you are doing.
If it is a valuable or rare part you are treating, try the process
on a non-valuable item first to ensure the process works to your
satisfaction.
Make sure the correct polarity is used as the incorrect polarity
will destroy the part you are trying to treat.
siliconchip.com.au
The setup (left), including a look
inside ‘The Bucket’ (above). Note
how the sacrificial anode surrounds
any object to be treated. The water
becomes rust-coloured as shown. The
black wire is for attachment to the
object under restoration (although
there is no item shown here) and the
red wire goes to the sacrificial anode.
To form the rebar mesh into a cylindrical form it was found to be convenient to place it diagonally across a
stone gutter and strike it with a heavy
club hammer in the unsupported area,
gradually moving along the length of
the piece.
Doing a bit at a time, the flat mesh
was gradually transformed into a
cylindrical electrode. Of course, thin
sheet metal would be much easier to
shape.
Coated steel can be used as a sacrificial anode but make sure to sand off
the protective coating first.
The anode is where the process of
oxidation takes place (electrons are
removed from the chemical structure).
Electrical connection to the
item under restoration
It is important that a good electrical
connection is established to the item
under restoration.
For a severely rusted item with a
thick layer of insulating rust it may
be necessary to scrape or grind away
some rust to get down to original metal
with which a good electrical connection can be made.
Alternatively a powerful, good
quality alligator/crocodile clip could
be used if it has enough ‘bite’ to get
through the rust layer. It may have to
be moved side to side to help it ‘dig’
through the rust to establish a good
connection.
Another possibility is to fabricate
some type of clamp with sharpened
siliconchip.com.au
contact points that, when tightened,
will go through the rust layer and
make contact with the base metal. You
can test how good the connection is
with a multimeter.
The electrolyte
The concentration of the electrolyte
solution is not critical but a 5 to 10%
solution by weight seems to work well.
The percentage by weight for a certain
volume of solution is determined by
the mass of the solute (matter to be
dissolved) in grams divided by the volume of solution in ml, all times 100.
To have one litre of a 10% solution
of washing soda (Na2CO3) it would
be necessary to have 100 grams of the
soda dissolved in one litre of solution.
To make such a solution, one would
weigh out 100g and dissolve this in
slightly less than one litre of water.
To facilitate the dissolving of the soda
it would be best to use warm water.
Once the solution is fully dissolved,
or at least is dissolved as it can be
(since not all the material may dis-
Correct polarity is VITAL!
We can’t repeat this too many times:
POSITIVE goes to sacrificial anode,
NEGATIVE goes to item to be restored.
It is critical that you get the polarity correct, otherwise the object
under restoration will be dissolved!
Always test your set up with a
non-valuable piece first.
solve), water can be added to bring
the solution to one litre.
If you do not have a method of
directly measuring one litre you can
determine the volume of 1 litre by
pouring 1 kg of water (1 litre) into a
container and marking the level on the
side of the container. This will then be
your 1 litre measuring vessel.
(Note that this procedure is NOT
the same as just adding 1 litre of water
to 100 grams of the soda, a common
mistake).
You must use protective gloves and
eyewear when making and using the
solution as, although washing soda is a
household chemical, it is still alkaline
and possibly harmful to the eyes.
The power supply
A 12V car battery charger is commonly used for this process but this
doesn’t allow any form of current/
voltage control. For a little more convenience you could use an adjustable
bench power supply.
A standard car battery charger is
sometimes used but has the disadvantage that very high currents may be
drawn due to the highly conducting
nature of the electrolyte solution.
High currents may be too high for
the de-rusting process and further,
these chargers may not be designed to
have high currents drawn for the long
periods of time this process may take.
For these reasons, we do not recommend the use of a car battery charger
for this process.
October 2014 31
REQUIRED
MATERIALS
+VE CONNECTION
TO REBAR (ANODE)
Here’s the setup we generally use
for small to medium size jobs.
The rebar mesh must be bright
steel (ie, not zinc plated).
SACRIFICIAL
ANODE MADE
FROM MILD STEEL
(EG, REBAR MESH)
A plastic bucket or container large
enough to contain the item(s) to
be restored.
A sacrificial anode made of uncoated mild steel which preferably surrounds the part to be
restored. Graphite or platinum
is also suitable but platinum is
extremely expensive.
Washing soda powder (sodium
carbonate) as distinct from
baking soda. A 1kg packet costs
around $4 in supermarkets.
A popular brand is Lectric.
What is not used will not be
wasted as there are numerous
household uses for this chemical (see manufacturer’s website). This chemical can also be
purchased as a swimming pool
pH increaser (to make the water
more alkaline and less acidic) for
about $10 for 2.5kg.
A power supply capable of at least
12V (up to 20V or so is better)
and ideally up to 2 or 3A
capacity, although lower capacity
will suffice. It is preferable that
the supply has a variable output
voltage, as is the capability to
measure voltage and current.
The power supply used for this
article was a Manson NP-9615
with an output of 0 to 30V at 5A
and built in current and voltage
meters but a much less capable
supply will be suitable.
A car battery charger is used by
some people but is not recommended.
Two polarised leads with clips (ie,
red and black) to connect the
power supply to the electrodes.
Rubber gloves and safety glasses.
Scales with which to weigh out
the required amount of washing
soda.
A way to measure the volume of
water (or weigh it – remember
that one litre of water weighs
one kilogram).
And last of all . . .
the rusty part(s) to be restored!
32 Silicon Chip
PLASTIC
BUCKET
VOLTS DC
–
POWER
SUPPLY
ELECTROLYTE
(TO COVER
WORK)
AMPS DC
RUSTED OBJECT
UNDER
RESTORATION
+
–VE CONNECTION
TO WORK (CATHODE)
The procedure
1. To start, choose an appropriate
size plastic vessel (such as a water
bucket) and install in it an uncoated
mild steel sacrificial anode.
2. Make up a 5 or 10% weight-byvolume solution of electrolyte as
described above and pour into the
container. Normally you would
want to ensure there is enough
to cover the object to be restored
but in some cases it might only
be necessary to treat part of an
object, so the part not needing treatment can be above the solution.
Some people have reported success with much less concentrated
solutions such as ‘a (US) tablespoon
to a (US) gallon of water’. You may
wish to try lower concentrations to
see if that works with the particular
artefacts that you want to restore.
The actual concentration is not
likely to be critical, as long as the
amount of electrolyte makes the
water conduct electricity well.
Note also that any paint on an object will likely be damaged or even
removed by this process as the solution softens it. Any paint remnants
can be removed with paint remover
if desired or even before treatment if
the paint layer is particularly robust.
3. Make sure loose dirt and rust is
brushed off from the item to be restored and that any oil or grease is
removed with a degreaser.
4. Attach the positive wire to the
sacrificial anode and the negative wire to the work piece (ie,
the rusty piece being restored).
The clip attached to the work
piece will not be significantly damaged but the one attached to the
PLYWOOD PLATE
TO HOLD REBAR IN
PLACE (IF REQUIRED)
sacrificial anode will likely dissolve
if it is not connected above the electrolyte level.
5. The item to be restored is placed
in the cell and the power supply
turned on to about 12 volts. Gas
evolution should be noticed on
both the sacrificial anode and the
item under restoration – the time
for this to happen depends a lot on
the voltage/current applied.
6. Periodically, items should be removed and examined. Turn the
power supply off before removing
the item as sparks could ignite gases
present.
Each time an object is removed
from the solution (wear rubber
gloves and safety eyeglasses) it
should be washed under cold water
and loose rust brushed off with a
nylon or brass brush. A sharp instrument may be needed to get material
out of crevices.
Notes
• This article primarily refers to rust
on mild steel and other low alloy steels only and was not tested
or intended to be used on stainless steel (some grades of which
do rust) or other metals such as
copper, brass and aluminium.
If you want to use this process on
other materials, do your own tests.
The amount of time the process
takes depends on many factors but
can take as little as tens of minutes
to many hours or even days for
heavily rusted items with deep recesses, such as nuts on bolts.
• When an item is removed and replaced it is important that the position of the electrode clip is moved
siliconchip.com.au
Providing a drill bit is still in reasonable state (ie, not too rusted or flaking), it can be restored to working condition.
•
•
•
•
and also that the restoration object
is placed in a variety of positions
to ensure all areas are treated and
none are shielded.
As red rust is electrically insulating
the number of bubble sites on heavily rusted items may be relatively
few at first. However, since red rust
is also porous, as the electrolyte
penetrates to the more conducting
layers gas evolution will start to occur. The bubbles expanding within
the porous red rust help to remove it.
For very heavily rusted items it was
found that the current and number
of bubbling sites increased and then
eventually the current decreased as
the process moved to completion.
Sometimes, on heavily rusted
objects, no significant gas evolution would happen for a long
time. It was found that the process
could be facilitated by increasing the voltage to a point that
gas evolution became apparent.
After a while the voltage could
be reduced but gas evolution would
continue, as the impediment to current flow had been cleared.
There is a critical voltage at which
the appropriate electrochemical
reactions occur. But without using a
special reference electrode such as a
‘standard hydrogen electrode’ (SHE)
this voltage needs to be guessed.
It is the point at which significant gas evolution occurs and the
current starts to increase rapidly.
The voltage should not be set so
high that there is extremely vigorous gas evolution. Generally 12V is
enough but as mentioned above,
it is sometimes advantageous to
go beyond this in order to get the
process started more quickly if
there is a high initial resistance.
(A DC voltage of 12 to around 30
volts is more than adequate for any
conceivable cleaning operation).
NEVER attempt to connect to mains
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
voltage – (a) it would be extremely
dangerous and (b) being AC, it
wouldn’t work!
Concerning the optimal current to
use (obtained by varying the voltage) it is not critical but it should
be set to a level where there is a
somewhat vigorous stream of bubbles coming from the artefact. In
professional restoration of marine
artefacts current densities in the
range of anything from 0.001-0.1A
per square centimetre of object area
have been successfully used.
Don’t let the rusted item touch the
sacrificial anode or you will short
out the power supply.
Make sure bubbles come from all
areas on the part. With multipart
objects a failure for bubbles to come
from one part may indicate a lack
of electrical connection between
the parts. Applying another connection to such parts should rectify
the problem.
If the object has some type of “inert”
plating such as chrome, as long as
it is soundly attached, it should not
generally be affected. However, if
the plating is not sound it may be
removed. Be sure to test a small part
of the piece first, leaving most of the
piece out of solution.
Interestingly, it was noticed how,
even with the power supply turned
off a small voltage was present
across the cell. This is because the
materials are acting as a galvanic
cell.
The process is quite tolerant (except
if the wrong electrical polarity is
used!) and there will be no harm
from leaving it running for too
long a time. Good metal will not be
adversely affected, however due to
safety considerations the process
should not be left unattended.
Do not turn off the power and leave
the item under restoration in the
electrolyte solution for an extended
length of time as it will start to rust
again. Whilst a current is flowing the
object will not rust (as long as there
is sacrificial anode still present).
• To give maximum coverage it is
best to suspend the articles in the
solution.
• Multiple parts can be done at once
with multiple parallel electrical
connections.
• If you have a really large object to
clean, be creative with your choice
of container, eg, kids’ inflatable
swimming pools (but don’t repurpose for use by kids after the job!),
or dig a hole in the ground and line
with plastic etc.
After the process has finished
The process may be regarded as
complete at the point that no more
rust can be brushed from the object
and the current generally drops to a
much lower level than at its peak and
also remains steady.
After the process is complete, remove the item (turn the power supply
off first) and brush it rigorously with
a plastic or brass brush under running
water.
Use rubber gloves and safety eyewear. It should then be immediately
sprayed or soaked in methylated spirits (warning – flammable) to remove
residual moisture. Methylated spirits
should then be wiped off so that none
remains and then the item should be
put near a source of heat such as a
blow heater or hair dryer to thoroughly
dry it.
After thorough drying the item can
then be treated as required. It could be
sprayed with a moisture displacing oil
such as WD40 and regularly recoated,
for example, or primed and painted or
just left the way it is although it will
again develop a surface layer of rust.
There is no single answer as to the
best treatment as it will vary widely
according to conditions.
SC
Similarly, this “shifter” (which wouldn’t shift – it was rusted closed!) is now bright, shiny . . . and completely usable!
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 33
Courtesy
LED Lights
Delay For Cars
Most modern cars have a courtesy light delay but older vehicles
do not. This new circuit is specifically designed to suit LED lamps
but will also work with conventional filament lamps. It keeps the
interior lights of your car lit for a preset time after you shut the car
doors. The lights will also turn off if the exterior lights or ignition
are switched on during the time-out period.
I
F YOU BUILD this courtesy light delay unit, you will be able to upgrade
your vehicle to LED interior lighting
(see SILICON CHIP, December 2013).
LEDs give much improved lighting
compared to the yellow of incandescent lamps and the bulb diffusers will
not discolour with age.
We previously published a Courtesy
Lights Delay unit in June 2004 and this
has proved surprisingly popular. And
while that project is still fine for 12V
filament bulbs, it won’t work with LED
lighting unless you have at least one
filament bulb connected; not the best
compromise.
Just why our previous Courtesy
Light Delay from 2004 doesn’t work
with LEDs can be understood by look-
Main Features
• Adjustable delay (1-133s)
• Works with both 12V LED lamps
and incandescent/halogen filament lamps
• Low standby current drain
• Works with positive and negative
door switch configurations
• Interior lamps go off when exterior
lights or ignition are switched on
34 Silicon Chip
ing at Fig.1 which shows the earlier
design concept. It’s based on a Mosfet
(Q1), two capacitors (C1 & C2) and a
1MΩ discharge resistor. When the door
switch is closed, the interior lamp(s)
light and the capacitors are discharged.
The instant the door switch opens, the
two capacitors charge via the filaments
in the interior lighting.
Due to the different values of the
two series-connected capacitors, the
47µF capacitor (C2) will charge to a
voltage that’s about 10 times higher
than the voltage across the 470µF
capacitor (C1). So with a 12V supply
and taking into account the 0.7V drop
across diode D1, the 47µF capacitor
will have about 10.2V across it and
the 470µF capacitor about 1.02V. The
10.2V across C2 becomes the gate voltage for the Mosfet which then drives
the lamps. After a short time, the gate
voltage discharges via the 1MΩ resistor
and the lamps go off.
As shown in Fig.1, a few refinements
were also included. These include
adding a short time delay to prevent
Mosfet Q1 from switching on instantly
when the door switch opens. This is
to allow time for capacitors C1 & C2
to charge sufficiently before the Mosfet switches on and shunts the door
switch. This delay is achieved using
transistor Q2, which is momentarily
switched on at power-up (ie, when
the door switch opens) due to base
drive through the 100nF capacitor and
10kΩ resistor.
When Q2 switches on, it momentarily shunts Q1’s gate to ground. This
prevents Q1 from conducting until the
100nF capacitor charges. The duration
is only 1ms and any tendency for the
lamp to briefly flicker off as the door
switch opens is virtually unnoticeable.
The full circuit published in June
2004 also included additional circuitry to switch off the Mosfet (and thus
turn the interior lamps off) if the tail
lights were activated (ie, if the parking
lights or headlights were switched on).
As stated, this circuit doesn’t work
with LED lighting. That’s because
the circuit relies on current flowing
through the lamp filaments, just after they are switched off, to charge
capacitors C1 & C2. Typically, a 5W
lamp filament will have a resistance
of about 29Ω when it is hot and so the
47µF capacitor takes much less than
1ms to charge. However, interior lighting often uses more than one lamp and
so the charging resistance is usually
much lower than 29Ω.
By contrast, typical 12V LED lamps
incorporate two or three white LEDs
siliconchip.com.au
+ DOOR
SWITCH
100nF
C1
470 µF
10k
D1
1N4004
A
100k
K
B
C2
47 µF
470Ω
1M
22k
D
Q1
G
S
C
Q2
E
– DOOR
SWITCH
By JOHN CLARKE
Fig.1: the basic design concept of our 2004 Courtesy Light Delay.
It relied on current flowing through the lamp filaments to charge
capacitors C1 & C2 immediately after the door switch opened.
Other Uses
This PCB module is not just confined
to vehicle use. Its circuit can also be
used for timed lighting, such as in
a hallway, provided you use 12V
LEDs run from a 12V DC supply. A
pushbutton momentary switch would
be used to switch the lights on and
they would then turn off automatically
at the end of the preset period.
This would also be ideal for a stairwell with one or several pushbutton
start switches (eg, one on each floor).
With a 12V supply, up to 36W (3A)
of lighting can be controlled and these
could be powered from a 3A 12V
power brick or similar (or use a 2A
plugpack for up to 24W of lighting).
Note that the pushbutton switch
needs to be rated for the total current
drawn by the LED lighting.
connected in series with a currentlimiting resistor. The voltage drop
across each LED is typically 3.5V for
a white LED and so the total voltage
drop is around 7V with two in series
or about 10.5V with three in series.
So there is not much left of the 12V
supply to charge the capacitors shown
in Fig.1.
When twin-LED lamps are used in
this circuit, the resulting gate voltage
will be around 2.9V when using a
standard diode for D1 and 3.13V when
using a Schottky diode. We do not get
the expected 3.8V because of the voltage drop across the current-limiting
resistor in the LED lamp.
Now 3.13V is too low to fully switch
on most Mosfets, including typical
logic level types that can conduct (at
least partially) with a 3V gate-to-source
siliconchip.com.au
+12V
+12V
+
+
DOOR
SWITCH
–
λ
LAMP
+
LED
LAMP
λ
+
LAMP
–
DOOR
SWITCH
–
λ
LED
LAMP
λ
–
(a)
(b)
Fig.2: the door switch can either be on the chassis side of the interior
lamp (a) or on the +12V side (b). Both the June 2004 circuit and the
new circuit described here work with either configuration.
voltage but switch off below 2.5V. This
means that LED lamps will not be correctly switched on by the circuit of
Fig.1. Even if we substitute a Mosfet
with a very low on-threshold voltage,
it would be difficult to get a consistent
delay period due to the low capacitor
voltages compared to this threshold.
It’s unfortunate that this circuit
doesn’t work with LED lighting because it has several desirable features.
First, there’s no need to connect it
directly to the vehicle’s 12V supply;
you just connect across a door switch
(in a vehicle with incandescent interior lamps) and it works. In addition,
the circuit will operate regardless as
to whether the door switch is on the
negative side of the lamp (Fig.2a) or
the positive side (Fig.2b). Provided
it’s connected with the correct polarity across the door switch, the circuit
works in exactly the same manner
for both ‘high side’ and ‘low side’
switching.
So how do we design a circuit to operate with LEDs? In this case, we need
to connect our new circuit directly to
the 12V supply as well as to a door
switch. And if we want the interior
lamps to switch off when the parking
lights or ignition are turned on, then
these too need to be monitored by the
circuit.
LED version
Our new Courtesy LED Lights Delay
circuit is shown in Fig.3. Unlike the
June 2004 circuit, it also monitors the
ignition as well as the exterior lights.
Monitoring the parking lights or tail
lights is only useful for night-time
driving, since you are unlikely to use
the lights during the day. By monitoring the ignition line, the courtesy
lamps will immediately go out if the
car is started rather than having to wait
for the delay period to expire.
As with our previous circuit, the
Courtesy LED Lights Delay operates
with the door switch in either configuration (ie, high-side or low-side).
Again, it’s only necessary to wire the
circuit to a door switch with the correct polarity. It’s not necessary to know
how the door switch is connected in
the vehicle; you just have to identify
its positive and negative leads.
October 2014 35
C
E
1 µF
1 µF
1k
K
B
D5
Q3
BC337
C
E
A
7
2
GP5
GP0
Vss
8
IC1
PIC12F675
–I/P
COURTESY LED LIGHTS DELAY
CON1
7
LIGHTS
6
LIGHTS
–
BR1
W04
1k
IGNITION
20 1 4
~
~
B
10k
5
4
0V
SC
4
4.7k
2
1
+
E
C
Q2
BC337
A
5
6
OPTO1: 4N25
VR1
100k
TIME
OUT
100nF
30V
1W
λ
10k
1nF
6
4
AN1/GP1
MCLR/GP3
1
Vdd
GP4
GP2
5
3
100nF
+5V
10 µF
GND
K
ZD1
Fig.3: the circuit uses PIC microcontroller IC1 to set the delay period. It also monitors the door switches, exterior lights and ignition. When a door switch is
opened, IC1’s GP4 output drives Mosfet Q1 (and thus the lamps) via transformer T1 and bridge rectifier D1-D4 for the delay period, as set by VR1. If the ignition
or exterior lights are switched on, GP5 is pulled low (either by Q2 or OPTO1) and this immediately puts the micro to sleep and turns the interior lamps off.
S
D
G
IN
10k
OUT
GND
LM2936
D1
D3
9T
1k
100nF
T1
A
24T
K
K
A
D2
K
A
K
A
K
A
D4
1 µF
A
B
1M
G
K
BC 33 7
S
D
D
STP60NF06
Q1
STP60–
NF06
2
+~~–
W04
SWITCH –
SWITCH +
CON1
1
D5, D6: 1N4004
D1–D4: 1N4148
OUT
IN
REG1 LM2936-5.0
K
D6
A
+12V
3
100Ω
36 Silicon Chip
The other connections to the circuit
are to +12V, chassis (0V), ignition and
the switched supply for the vehicle’s
exterior lights. The lights connection
can be regarded as optional; in many
cases, it will be sufficient to simply
monitor the ignition line to automatically turn the interior lamps off before
the delay period has ended (ie, when
the car is started).
The lights input connects across the
parking lights or tail lights (but not the
stop lights) and can be connected with
either polarity.
If the courtesy lights use a low-side
switching arrangement, Mosfet Q1’s
source terminal will be connected to
ground via SWITCH-. But this won’t
be the case with high-side switching.
You might expect that this could be
solved by driving Q1 with an IR2125
(or similar) Mosfet driver which could
produce a suitable gate drive above the
Mosfet’s source voltage, whether that
rises to the 12V supply (for a high-side
connected Mosfet) or 0V (for a low-side
connected Mosfet).
However, in the high-side config
uration, this scheme relies on a lowimpedance source load such as a light
bulb to charge the boost capacitor during the Mosfet’s off-time. This capacitor is subsequently used to generate a
voltage above the 12V supply when the
Mosfet switches on, so that it remains
in conduction.
Once again, using LEDs for the load
will mean that the capacitor will only
charge to 12V minus the voltage drop
of the LEDs. Ultimately, we would still
be restricted to only a couple of volts
for the Mosfet gate supply, so it won’t
work for the same reasons outlined
earlier. Another problem is that the
IR2125’s quiescent current is rather
high, at up to 1.2mA.
To get around this problem, our
circuit is based on a PIC12F675-I/P
microcontroller (IC1) and this drives
Mosfet (Q1) via transformer T1. IC1
produces a 1MHz square-wave to drive
the transformer and it provides a timing function to switch off this signal
after a set period (the delay). This
delay period can be adjusted using
trimpot VR1.
In operation, microcontroller IC1
detects when a door switch is opened
to start the delay period. It also monitors when the ignition or lights are
switched on to cancel the delay period.
Because the circuit is always connected to the vehicle’s 12V battery,
siliconchip.com.au
Specifications
Delay period: adjustable from 1-133 seconds
Dim down period: 1s (can be extended by changing 1µF gate capacitor on Q1)
Quiescent current: 17µA maximum, 9µA typical, 7.6µA measured (sleep mode,
lamp off)
Current when running: 36mA plus LED lamp current
it’s vital that microcontroller IC1 has
a low quiescent supply current. As a
result, IC1 is normally in ‘sleep’ mode
and draws negligible current (up to
2µA maximum). In fact, most of the
quiescent current is drawn by 3-terminal regulator REG1, as described later.
IC1’s GP2 input indirectly monitors the door switch which is wired
across the Mosfet. As shown, Q1’s
drain connects to the positive side of
the switch, while its source connects
to the negative terminal.
GP2 is normally held high via an
internal pull-up resistor. When the
door switch is in the ground side (see
Fig.2a), a closed switch pulls GP2 low
via a 1kΩ resistor and diode D5. At
the same time, transistor Q3 will be
off since Q1’s source is at ground and
so Q3’s base is held at 0V.
Alternatively, if the door switch is
connected in the positive side of the
supply as in Fig.2b, a closed switch
drives Q3’s base via a 10kΩ resistor.
As a result, Q3 turns on and pulls GP2
low. In this case, diode D5 is reverse
biased as Q1’s drain is connected to
the positive supply.
So, for either connection of the door
switch, IC1’s GP2 input is high when
the switch is open and goes low when
the switch closes. IC1 is configured
to generate an interrupt on a positive
edge at input GP2 and when the door
switch subsequently opens again, this
interrupt wakes IC1 from its sleep
mode. The microcontroller’s firmware
then starts an internal oscillator and
this produces a 1MHz clock output at
pin 3. This then drives transformer T1
via a 100nF capacitor.
Diodes D1-D4 rectify the voltage
from T1’s secondary and the resulting DC is filtered by a 1µF capacitor.
This in turn switches on Mosfet Q1 to
drive the interior lights, just as if a door
switch was closed. Note that D1-D4 are
1N4148s since a standard bridge rectifier would not work at 1MHz.
The end result is that Q1’s gate is
charged sufficiently above its source
to ensure it switches on, regardless of
siliconchip.com.au
whether the source voltage is actually
0V or 12V. This configuration is known
as a ‘floating gate supply’.
At the same time as Q1 is switched
on, IC1’s GP0 output is taken low (to
0V) and this connects a 5V supply
across trimpot VR1 (100kΩ). The setting at VR1’s wiper is then read via
IC1’s AN1 input. The GP0 output is
then taken high to stop the current
flowing through VR1 and this is done
to minimise the current drain, particularly during sleep mode.
IC1 goes to sleep again at the end of
the time-out period, as set by VR1. This
stops the 1MHz drive to transformer
T1 and Mosfet Q1 then quickly dims
the interior lights over a nominal one
second period as its 1µF gate capacitor
discharges via a parallel 1MΩ resistor.
Basically, the Mosfet’s internal impedances rises in response to decreasing
gate voltage, thereby dimming the
lights until they are ultimately completely off.
Interrupting the delay
IC1 monitors the ignition and taillights circuits via its GP5 input at
pin 2. If either the ignition or lights
are switched on during the time-out
period, the PIC immediately goes to
sleep and the interior lights go out.
In greater detail, GP5 is normally
held high via an internal pull-up resistor. If the ignition is switched on (eg,
when the car is started), it drives the
base of Q2 via a 10kΩ resistor. Q2 thus
turns on and pulls GP5 (pin 2) of IC1
low to put the micro to sleep.
Alternatively, if the external lights
are switched on, the resulting 12V DC
supply is fed through bridge rectifier
BR1 and drives the LED in optocoupler
OPTO1. This in turn switches on
OPTO1’s output transistor, again pulling GP5 (pin 2) of IC1 low and putting
the micro to sleep.
BR1 and optocoupler OPTO1 ensure that the lights circuit will work
regardless of how they are switched in
the vehicle. It doesn’t matter whether
the lights are ground connected and
Parts List
1 double-sided PCB, code
05109141, 71 x 47mm
1 UB5 jiffy box, 83 x 54 x 31mm
1 panel-mount cable gland for
6.5mm diameter cable
1 ferrite toroid ring core, L8 material,
18mm OD, 10mm ID, 6mm high
(Jaycar LO-1230)
1 8-pin DIL IC socket
1 3-way PCB-mount screw terminal
block (5.08mm spacing) (CON1)
2 2-way PCB-mount screw terminal
blocks (5.08mm spacing) (CON1)
1 M3 x 6mm tapped Nylon spacer
1 M3 x 12mm machine screw
1 M3 nut
2 100mm cable ties
1 700mm length of 0.8mm enamelled
copper wire
1 100kΩ miniature horizontal trimpot
(VR1)
Semiconductors
1 PIC12F675-I/P microcontroller
programmed with 0510914A.hex
(IC1)
1 4N25 or 4N28 optocoupler
(OPTO1)
1 LM2936-5.0 low dropout 5V regulator (REG1)
1 STP60NF06 60V N-channel Mosfet or similar (Q1)
2 BC337 NPN transistors (Q2,Q3)
1 W04 400V 1.2A bridge rectifier
(BR1)
4 1N4148 diodes (D1-D4)
2 1N4004 1A diodes (D5,D6)
1 30V 1W zener diode (ZD1)
Capacitors
1 10µF 16V electrolytic
1 1µF 16V electrolytic
2 1µF monolithic multi-layer ceramic
3 100nF MKT (code 100n or 104)
1 1nF MKT (code 1n or 102)
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 1MΩ
3 1kΩ
2 10kΩ
1 100Ω
1 4.7kΩ
Miscellaneous
Automotive wire, crimp connectors,
quick splice connectors
switched to positive or connected to
positive and switched to ground.
Power supply
Power for the PIC microcontroller is
derived from the vehicle’s 12V supply
October 2014 37
D5
4148
4148
4004
1nF
100nF
IC1
PIC12F675
9T
100nF
1k
1k
Q2
10k
100k
T1
24T
BC337
VR1
~
BC337
BR1
1 µF
Q3
C 2014
30V
4004
ZD1
~
–
~
–
4N28
4.7k
W04
OPTO1
1
+
TIMEOUT
4148
4148
10k
1k
100Ω
D6
~
LIGHTS
LIGHTS
100nF
REG1
14190150
IGN.
IGNITION
Q1
10k
0V
+
-ST H GIL N GI V 0 V 2 1 + H CTI WS
+12V
1 µF
+
SWITCH +12V 0V
SWITCH –
10 µF D3 D1 D2 D4 1 µF
1M
+
SWITCH +
CON1
Fig.4: follow this diagram and the photo at left to build the Courtesy LED Lights
Delay. The connection to the exterior lights circuit is optional.
LEADS BENT
DOWN BY 90°
M3 NUT
Q1
M3 x 6mm
NYLON
SPACER
M3 x 15mm SCREW
PCB
Fig.5: Mosfet Q1 is mounted horizontally, with its tab secured to an
M3 x 6mm Nylon spacer.
Be sure to feed the M3 x 15mm screw
that secures Q1’s tab to the spacer up
through the bottom of the PCB.
via an LM2936 5V automotive regulator (REG1). This regulator can handle a
reversed supply input and has voltage
transient clamping. Diode D6, zener
diode ZD1 and the 100Ω resistor are
included to add extra protection. The
overall quiescent current of the circuit
is very low at around 9µA typical and
is mainly due to the minimum current
drawn by REG1.
Software
Not much is required in the way of
software for IC1. As stated, it includes
a rising edge interrupt handler that
wakes the PIC from sleep whenever a
door switch is opened from its closed
position. The PIC’s internal oscillator is
then automatically started and it generates the 1MHz clock signal at pin 3.
The delay counter is set from 1-133s,
depending on the 8-bit ADC reading
from AN1 and this period is timed using the overflow period of the internal
16-bit timer (timer 1), which occurs
every 524ms.
When the delay counter reaches
zero, the PIC is placed back into sleep
mode so that it draws minimal power
and the 1MHz clock signal ceases.
During the delay period, the GP5 input
is monitored and if this goes low, the
processor is immediately placed in
sleep mode and the LED lights quickly
dim to off.
make sure that the diodes and zener
diode go in with the correct polarity.
The zener diode is a 30V type and will
probably be marked as a 1N4751.
OPTO1, the 4N25 optocoupler, is
installed next, along with an 8-pin
DIL socket for IC1. Be sure to orientate
these parts as shown on the overlay
(ie, pin 1 at top left). Transistors Q2 &
Q3, regulator REG1 and bridge rectifier BR1 can now go in. Check that the
LM2950-5.0 device goes in the REG1
position and check that BR1 is correctly orientated and sits flush against
the PCB before soldering its leads.
The capacitors are next on the list.
Watch the orientation of the electrolytics and make sure that their tops are
no more than 12.5mm above the PCB,
otherwise they will later foul the lid of
the case. The parts list shows the codes
used for the 100nF and 1nF capacitors.
Connector CON1 is made up using
one 3-way and two 2-way screw terminal blocks. These should be dovetailed
together to form a 7-way block which
is then mounted on the PCB with the
wire entry holes facing towards the
adjacent edge. Make sure that this
7-way connector sits flush against the
PCB before soldering the pins.
Mosfet Q1 is mounted horizontally
on the PCB with its metal tab secured
to an M3 x 6mm Nylon spacer. To do
this, first bend the Mosfet’s leads down
through 90° about 1mm from its body,
Construction
The Courtesy LED Lights Delay is
built on a double-sided PCB coded
05109141 and measuring 71 x 47mm.
This clips neatly into the side channels of a UB5 plastic case and there is
sufficient room to install a cable gland
at the terminal block end.
Fig.4 shows the parts layout on the
PCB. Install the resistors first, followed
by diodes D1-D6 and zener diode ZD1.
Check each resistor with a multimeter
before soldering it in position and
Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
No.
1
2
1
3
1
38 Silicon Chip
Value
1MΩ
10kΩ
4.7kΩ
1kΩ
100Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
brown black green brown
brown black orange brown
yellow violet red brown
brown black red brown
brown black brown brown
5-Band Code (1%)
brown black black yellow brown
brown black black red brown
yellow violet black brown brown
brown black black brown brown
brown black black black brown
siliconchip.com.au
then fit the Mosfet in position and slide
the Nylon spacer into position under
its tab. The assembly is then secured
to the PCB using a M3 x 12mm screw
and nut – see Fig.5.
Note that this screw must be inserted from the underside of the PCB,
so that the nut goes on top of Q1’s tab.
That’s because the screw head is small
enough not to foul adjacent PCB tracks,
whereas the larger nut would run the
risk of shorting out an adjacent 1µF
capacitor. Do the screw up firmly to
secure the assembly, then solder the
Mosfet’s leads to the PCB.
Winding T1
The PCB assembly can now be
completed by winding and installing transformer T1. This transformer
consists of two windings on a ferrite
ring core, as shown in Fig.4. The first
winding consists of nine turns of the
0.8mm enamelled copper wire, while
the second consists of 24 turns of
0.8mm enamelled copper wire. They
are wound on opposite sections of the
core and it doesn’t matter in which
direction they are wound.
Once the windings are in place,
position the toroid on the PCB. The
9-turn winding goes through pads at
the lower righthand side of the PCB,
while the 24-turn winding goes to a pad
just to the right of Q3 and to a pad at
top right. Push the toroid all the way
down onto the PCB, the secure it in
position using a couple of cable ties.
These pass through the centre hole of
the toroid and through adjacent holes
on either side.
Note that the enamel coating will
need to be scraped off the wires before
soldering them to the PCB.
Testing
Before installing the PIC micro, connect a 12V supply to CON1 and check
that there is about 5V (4.85-5.15V)
between pins 1 and 4 of IC1’s socket.
If this voltage is correct, disconnect the
power and install IC1 with its pin 1 to
the top left. If the voltage is incorrect,
check the orientation of D6, the value
of the series 100Ω resistor and that
REG1 is an LM2936-5.0.
If you have a spare 12V LED lamp,
this can be used to test the circuit
before installing it in the vehicle. Do
not use a white LED on its own. It
must be a LED lamp with a limiting
resistor to keep the current to a safe
level for the LEDs.
siliconchip.com.au
Assuming you have a spare LED
lamp, connect it between the switch
minus terminal (pin 2 of CON1) and 0V
(pin 4 of CON1). Note that the polarity is important here – the anode or
positive side of the LED lamp must go
to the switch minus terminal.
Now reapply power – the LED lamp
should light for a second or so, then
quickly dim to off. If that checks out,
momentarily bridge the switch terminals on CON1 (pins 1 & 2). The LED
lamp should now light for the length of
time set by trimpot VR1 (note: timing
begins when the door switch opens;
ie, when the door is closed).
Assuming it works as expected, VR1
can now be adjusted to set the required
delay. This ranges from 1-133s but
note that the circuit’s response to the
trimpot setting is non-linear. The fully
anticlockwise to mid-position setting
has the range of 1-33s, while the next
half of the travel is divided into two
equal sections. The first section has a
range from 33-66s, while the remaining clockwise section sets the delay
from 66-133s.
Having set the delay period, you
can test that the ignition input works.
That’s done by first triggering the delay
period, then connecting the ignition
input (pin 5 of CON1) to +12V using a wire link. When you do this,
the lamp should extinguish after one
second or so.
Note that you will need to set a reasonably long delay time for this test,
to give yourself time to connect the
ignition input to the +12V terminal.
Similarly, you can check that the
lights inputs work by triggering the
delay and connecting either pin 6 or
pin 7 of CON1 to +12V and the other
pin to ground. Again, the LED lamp
should turn off after a second or so.
If you wish, you can increase this
1s dim-down period by increasing the
1µF electrolytic capacitor value at the
Q1 gate. It will be around 10s with a
10µF capacitor. Note that this dimming
period is additional to the time-out
or delay period. So if the time-out is
set at 15s, the overall LED ‘on-period’
will be 15s plus the dimming period.
For 1s dimming, the total time-out
will be 16s.
Final assembly
If it all works as expected, drill a
12.5mm hole in the end of the UB5 box
for the cable gland. This hole should be
positioned 13mm down from the top
0.0006%
DISTORTION!
Perfect
match for
our new
Majestic
speakers!
It’s yours with the 200W
Ultra
Ultra LD
LD Amplifier
Mk3 Amplifier
from
from SILICON CHIP
It’s easily the best class A-B amplifier
design we’ve ever published – and we
believe it’s the best ever published
ANYWHERE! Outstanding per formance,
easy to build and get going . . .
If you want the ultimate in high-power
amplifiers, you want the Ultra LD!
Want to know more? Go to:
siliconchip.com.au/Project/Ultra-LD+Mk.3
PCBs & special components available from PartShop
LOOKING
FOR A
PCB?
PCBs for most recent (>2010)
SILICON CHIP projects are
available from the
SILICON CHIP PartShop
– see the PartShop pages
in this issue or log onto
siliconchip.com.au/PCBs
You’ll also find some of
the hard-to-get components
to build your SILICON CHIP
project, back issues,
software, panels, binders,
books, DVDs and much more!
Please note: the SILICON CHIP PartShop
does not sell kits; for these, please
refer to kit supplier’s adverts in this issue.
October 2014 39
This is the view inside the completed Courtesy LED Light Delay. It’s best to
make the external wiring connections to CON1 with the PCB out of the case.
The wires are then pushed back out through the cable clamp as the PCB is
clipped into position.
of the box and centred horizontally.
Drill a small pilot hole to begin with,
then carefully enlarge it to size using
a tapered reamer and mount the cable
gland in position.
The assembled PCB is now simply
clipped into the UB5 box with CON1
adjacent to the cable gland. This gland
clamps the external wiring cable to
prevent the connecting wires from
being pulled out of CON1.
Installation
To connect the unit, you will need to
access one of the door switches, +12V
power, the ignition line and either the
tail light or parking light connections.
Alternatively, you may wish to just use
the ignition input and not bother with
the lights input.
Note that some door switches will
have two wires while others have only
a single wire connection. In the latter
case, one contact is connected directly
to chassis at the switch mounting
position.
It’s important to get the door switch
connections to the unit the right way
around. The positive door switch connection must go to the switch positive
of the Courtesy LED Light Delay. You
can quickly determine which is the
positive door switch connection by
using a multimeter to measure the
voltage across the door switch when
it is pushed open.
Note that if there’s only a single
wire running to the switch, this will
be the positive (assuming the chassis
connection is negative).
40 Silicon Chip
For the +12V supply rail, you will
need to find a source of +12V that remains on when the ignition is off. This
+12V supply rail must be protected by
a fuse in the vehicle’s fusebox and is
best derived at the fusebox itself. The
0V lead can be run to an eyelet connector that’s screwed to the chassis.
The lights terminals on the Courtesy
LED Lights Delay are connected across
one of the tail lights or parking lights.
You can access this wiring either directly at the lights socket wiring, at
the lights switch or in the fusebox. It
doesn’t matter which way around you
connect them, since the bridge rectifier
automatically caters for both polarities.
Once you have found the relevant
wiring points, it’s a good idea to disconnect the vehicle’s battery before
running the wiring, to guard against
any inadvertent short circuits. Note
that all wiring should be run using
proper automotive cable and connectors.
Once the wiring is complete, reconnect the battery and check that the
courtesy lights remain on after the door
is closed. Now turn the ignition (or the
exterior lights) on and the courtesy
lights should quickly dim to off (over
1s or so).
Finally, the unit can be mounted
in any convenient location under the
dashboard. It’s up to you how you secure it, since a suitable position will
vary from vehicle to vehicle.
Existing delay circuit
What if your vehicle already has a
courtesy lights delay? This may work
fine if you substitute LED interior
lamps for your car’s original incandescent lamps but there’s always a
possibility that it may not. In that case,
you may wish to use the SILICON CHIP
Courtesy LED Lights Delay instead.
One problem here is that the door
switches will probably be connected
to the existing delay circuit rather than
directly to the interior lamps. Bypassing this delay circuit will therefore
involve disconnecting all the door
switches and wiring them directly to
the interior lamps instead.
That’s too complicated (and time
consuming) to be practical in most
cases but there is a way around this
– keep the original delay circuit and
simply add the SILICON CHIP Courtesy
LED Lights Delay unit to the existing
installation. That’s done by connecting
the SILICON CHIP delay unit in parallel
with the existing unit across one of the
door switches.
There’s just one wrinkle to watch
out for here – the original delay circuit
may pull one side of the door switch
to +5V rather than +12V. This should
be checked using a multimeter and if it
does go to +5V, the 1kΩ pull-down resistor connected to Q3’s base will have
to be increased to 10kΩ (otherwise the
transistor won’t turn on).
Note that, depending on the circuit
used, the original delay period may
be added to the delay introduced by
the SILICON CHIP unit. That won’t be
a problem, however, since the Courtesy LED Lights Delay period can be
adjusted down to as low as 1s.
Note also that connecting the Courtesy LED Lights Delay in parallel with
an existing delay circuit may not work
in all cases. It will very much depend
on the vehicle and the circuit used.
Troubleshooting
If the courtesy lights are always on,
the door switch terminals have probably been connected to CON1 (at pins
1 & 2) with reverse polarity. If that
happens, the courtesy lights turn on
via the intrinsic reverse diode inside
Mosfet Q1 and simply swapping the
leads to the door switch will fix the
problem.
Finally, if the interior lights switch
off immediately after the door is closed
(and the connections are correct), check
that there is no voltage applied to either
the lights terminals or the ignition terSC
minal on CON1 (pin 5, 6 & 7).
siliconchip.com.au
MH-826
Tape Measure
EF-5S - Engineers File Set
Second Cut
3 Piece
Sheet Metal Step Drill Set
EDBD-13
Drill Sharpener
• 8 Metre / 315"/ 26.25ft
• 25mm width
• Belt clip on side METRIC/IMPERIAL
• 200mm hardened and tempered files
• Second cut: flat, 1/2 round, round,
square, triangular
• Includes carry case
• HSS M2 Bright Finish
• 4-12 x 1mm
• 6-20 x 2mm
• 6-30 x 2mm
• 3-13mm or 1/8"-1/2"
• Diamond wheel
• Split point
• 80W, 240V motor
8.80
$
$
6.60
31.90
77.00
$
25
$
69
99.00
89
$
$
$
$
(M750)
(F100)
(D1071)
(D070)
HANDY WORKSHOP
Tap and Die Set - Alloy Steel
Tips & Techniques Book
Chapter 01: Setting Up Your Workshop
Chapter 02: Tools and Techniques
Chapter 03: Measuring and Marking
Chapter 04: Fasteners and Workshop Supplies
Chapter 05: Drilling
Chapter 06: Grinding, Polishing and Cutting
Chapter 07: Working with Metal
Chapter 08: Welding
Chapter 09: Machining
Chapter 10: Woodworking Machinery
Re-Threading Tap
& Die Kit
• Metric (M3-M12)
• Includes button die holder
wrench, tap wrench, screw
pitch gauge, screwdriver
324
COLOUR
PAGES
• Metric (M6-M12)
• UNC & UNF (1/4"-5/8)
• Fine & coarse threads
53.90
$
$
49
$
89
(T012)
(T020)
V Step by Step Information and Illustrations
Detailed Explanations
Range of Activities and More
39.00
33
$
WCH-6D + WRC-5D - Workshop Series
Tool Chest & Roller Cabinet Package
APW-14
Auto Parts Washer
• Ball bearing slides
• Protective drawer liners
• Key lockable
WCH-6D (T690)
• 6 drawer tool chest
• 600 x 260 x 340mm
WRC-5D (T695)
• 5 drawer roller cabinet
• 616 x 330 x 762mm
• Wall or bench mount
• 114L/hr, 240V pump
• 545 x 650 x 630mm
(L345)
198.00
$
BS-4A
Metal Cutting Band Saw
$
• 150 x 100mm cap.
• 3 blade speeds
• 1/2hp, 240V motor
(A369)
179
363.00
$
349
(B002)
• 250 x 500mm
turning capacity
• 26mm bore,
12 spindle speeds
• Quick action gearbox
• 1hp, 240V motor
1,749
$
(L149)
259
ONLY $
$
ST-250G
Lathe Stand
$
297.00
1,529.00
Plastic Buckets
4 x (110 x 105 x 50mm) ......... (A430)
4 x (140 x 105 x 75mm) ......... (A432)
6 x (220 x 140 x 125mm) ....... (A434)
275.00
(M121)
$
$
249
249
549
ONLY $
(M135A)
(L150)
TO:
GAIN ACCESS OS
629.20
PACKAGE PRICE
$
$
ITE
SEP SOL MS
AR D
ATE
LY
Bench (1200 x 750 x 900mm) (A415)
Backing Panel........................ (A416)
4 x Single Prong Hook .......... (A440)
4 x Double Prong Hook......... (A442)
1 x Triple Prong Hook ........... (A444)
1 x Spanner Holder ............... (A446)
1 x Screw Driver Holder ........ (A448)
MDS-H
Mill Drill Stand
1,449
$
(K004)
IWB-12 - Industrial Work Bench, Backing Panel
& Storage Accessories Package
• 3MT spindle, 12 speeds
• (X) 540mm, (Y) 190mm,
(Z) 410mm
• 820 x 240mm work table
• 2hp, 240V motor
• Includes drill chuck,
Tungsten tip face
cutter & tilting vice
AL-250G
Bench Lathe
1,815.00
PACKAGE PRICE
HM-32
Mill Drill - Belt Drive
Valued at
$
.00
11
$
14L TANK
MITRE VICE 45º
$
ITE
SEP SOL MS
AR D
ATE
LY
286.00
$
(K042)
+
OM
√ ONLINE PR
OFFERS
√ EXCLUSIVE
ur ORDERs
√ TRACK yo
LLECT
√ CLICK & CO
arranty
W
s
es
rl
pe
√ Pa
RS
TE
ET
SL
W
√ NE
RSS
HEER
CH
UC
VOU
LEASES
DISCOUNT VO
√ LATEST RE
NS
IO
IT
ET
√ COMP
$70 FREE
PROMO CODE
IGNUP
com.au/S
machineryhouse.
Note: Discount vouchers are valid for online purchases only
CHIPS
Use promo code ONLINE OR INSTORE!
To receive these special offers
Valid until 24-10-14
Specifications & Prices are subject to change without notification. All prices include GST and valid until 24-10-14
NSW
QLD
VIC
WA
(02) 9890 9111
(07) 3274 4222
(03) 9212 4422
(08) 9373 9999
1/2 Windsor Rd,
Northmead
625 Boundary Rd,
Coopers Plains
1 Fowler Rd,
Dandenong
41-43 Abernethy Rd,
Belmont
www.machineryhouse.com.au
10_SC_250914
$
99.00
$
32 PIECES
SERVICEMAN'S LOG
Sometimes you just have to give it a go
In this game, it’s important to try to stay upto-date with technology but we cannot know
everything about everything. Sometimes, when
there’s nothing to lose, we just have to bite the
bullet and give it a go, even though we might
be learning on the job.
P
EOPLE SAY that a change is as
good as a holiday, though this usually seems to be more an attempt at
consolation than a fair trade. Forget the
change; I’d much rather the holiday!
That said, change is a big part of
life and some people cope better than
others. Getting older is one change we
all have to deal with and while some
welcome the prospect of slowing down
and aging gracefully, others baulk at
the idea and try everything they can
to keep the wrinkles at bay.
Of course, some of the most obvious
changes we’ve seen are in the field of
technology. In our collective lifetimes,
we’ve gone from horses and carts to
sending rovers to roam the surface of
Mars. It’s hard to believe that there
are still some groups of people living
in the remotest areas of the planet
42 Silicon Chip
who don’t have access to electricity,
let alone radio, TV or mobile phones.
Then again, perhaps it’s not so hard
to believe when you consider that
it was only 100 or so years ago that
the machine age was really getting
into gear (pun intended!), with rapid
advances in automation, communications and transport. With necessity
being the mother of invention, many
of these technological improvements
were developed during times of global
unrest and put to use with devastating
effect during the two world wars.
Technology really can be a doubleedged sword.
Back in the modern world, you’d
Dave Thompson*
think servicemen would embrace
change and relish the challenges of
keeping up to date. However, while
some nearing retirement might still be
excited at the prospect of new technical advances, others simply give up
learning or can’t be bothered keeping
up with current trends.
For my part, I’d like to think that
most servicemen find learning new
skills and gathering knowledge stimulating and a reason to get out of bed
in the morning. But keeping up can
be tough; I was recently speaking with
a car mechanic and I wouldn’t fancy
being in that trade. The difference
between cars today and cars of even
20 years ago is vast.
Gone are the days when backyard
mechanics with just a socket set and
two screw-drivers (one flat and one
Phillips) could change their own
points or tune their engine with a
strobe light and dwell meter borrowed from a mate. Nowadays, cars
are almost totally reliant on complex
electronics to keep everything running properly and if you don’t have
the gear to ‘talk’ to the car’s computer
then good luck trying to do any work
on it. Saturday afternoon tinkering
siliconchip.com.au
Items Covered This Month
• No-name tablet repair
• B&D CAD4 garage door controller
• Faulty solar panel inverter
• Burnt-out washing machine
saves dishwasher
• HP LaserJet 1320N
• Motor start capacitor failure
*Dave Thompson runs PC Anytime
in Christchurch, NZ.
Website: www.pcanytime.co.nz
Email: dave<at>pcanytime.co.nz
is now almost a thing of the past; it’s
something our dads used to do but our
kids likely never will.
In our business, any serviceman
who doesn’t move with the times
will soon be left behind. For example,
towards the end of 2012, Microsoft
released Windows 8, the latest in their
line of Windows operating systems.
It’s different enough from previous
versions of Windows to alienate even
some diehard Microsoft fans and many
users have avoided it for that reason
and delayed upgrading.
As a computer serviceman, I simply
had to learn Windows 8 because that’s
my job. After all, I’m expected to know
more about it than the person bringing
in a computer to be fixed.
I’m also expected to know the quirks
and the methodology behind repairing
it when it goes wrong. In the same
way, I expect my mechanic to be able
to fix that new car I just bought or an
appliance technician to be up to speed
with the latest bubble-wash technology when my washing machine goes
wrong. But here’s the rub; I have to
trust that these people have kept up.
I certainly don’t want them charging
me top-dollar to learn on the job or to
make things up as they go along.
In my case, it means that the person
who brings me their latest Androidbased tablet or shiny new Apple product expects me to know everything
about it. As a result, I try my best to
ensure that I know enough to at least
keep out of trouble. After all, I need
to be able to effectively repair these
products in order to make a living.
At the same time, it’s completely
unrealistic to expect anyone to know
everything about everything. What’s
siliconchip.com.au
more, as a responsible serviceman, I
need to know my limits. If someone
wants me to work on something I know
little or nothing about I’ll tell them
straight that I’m not the best guy for
this job. And where possible, I’ll point
them in the direction of someone who
can do the work.
But that’s me and I know that there
are people out there prepared to fudge
their way through without knowing
what they are doing, just to make a few
bucks. That’s not only doing a great
disservice to their client but a dodgy
(or inadequate) repair can also reflect
badly on the trade, giving the rest of
us a bad name.
Sometimes though, there’s no other
option but to ‘give it a go’ if the gear is
to be fixed. Of course, that’s only done
with the full agreement of the client. I
also make it clear that I will be ‘learning on the job’ and will be doing the
work at a cut rate, if not for nothing.
No name tablet
That’s exactly the situation I was
confronted with recently when a client
called about a tablet that had stopped
working. It did nothing when the
power switch was pressed, so the first
thing I assumed was that the charging
socket was faulty and that the battery
wasn’t charging. My theory was that
the battery was probably dead flat and
unable to power the tablet up.
The big problem was that this was a
no-name tablet, one of thousands now
flooding the market on this side of the
world and sold by the van-load from
online auction sites. And with many
running tweaked (read modified) versions of Google’s Android operating
system, repairing them can be a royal
pain in the rear end. This isn’t just
because parts are nigh on impossible
to get but because if the OS gets corrupted, finding and downloading the
custom version of the Android system
used can be almost impossible.
At one stage, I looked into selling
no-name phones and tablets and
while they do look shiny and alluring and have the right gadget appeal,
the reality is that the build quality is
often questionable. This makes them
overly prone to failure and trying to
obtain back-up service and support
from the overseas vendor is about as
easy as pulling your own teeth. Some
of these devices might last a year (the
standard factory warranty) but many
don’t. And when I tell clients that
their device is non-repairable or that
the repair will be expensive, most just
shrug their shoulders and go out and
buy another one to replace it.
To me, this is 21st century consumerism at its worst; built-in obsolescence and a throw-away society
equals mountains of dead electronic
devices and massive pollution wherever it ends up. That’s usually some
‘recycling depot’ placed deliberately
out of sight somewhere in deepest Asia
where crude foundries smelt whatever
precious metals can be separated from
the carcasses of our dead hardware
and the plastics are burnt off into the
atmosphere and end up as acid rain.
There really has to be a better way.
OK, time to get off my hobby-horse;
this particular tablet was dead and
when I talked to the client, I immediately told him that I’d never fixed this
type of unit before. I also told him that
provided I had his blessing I’d take
the back off, check out the charging
system and if it was repairable, fix it
for him. I’d also do this for a reduced
fee because I’d be learning on the job
and that was something he shouldn’t
have to pay full rates for.
I also warned him that if the problem was something deeper inside
the tablet, such as a corrupted OS or
faulty hardware, then it could prove
non-repairable. In that case, he’d still
be liable for the cost of my labour to
determine this fact. He was OK with
all that because, as he put it, he “had
nothing to lose” by me having a crack
at it.
As soon as he’d gone, I popped the
back off the tablet, always a fraught
October 2014 43
Serviceman’s Log – continued
A simple fault in one component
was enough to bring a garage door
controller to it knees, as G. I. of Castle Hill, NSW recently discovered.
Here’s what happened . . .
My friend Jan likes her creature
comforts so you can imagine her
frustration when her automatic garage door controller suddenly failed.
This unit is a now-discontinued B&D
CAD4 model controlling a one-piece
tilt-a-door and had probably been
installed during the late 1990s.
The unit had actually being showing a minor fault symptom for some
time in that it would very occasionally
fail to respond to both the remote control and the hard-wired button on the
garage wall. However, it would always come good after several presses
and so this was regarded as little
more than a minor inconvenience.
Because it occurred so infrequently, the problem wasn’t considered
worth pursuing at the time. But now
the unit had stopped completely,
although relay “chatter” could occasionally be heard when the button
was pressed. There were no sounds
from the motor or drive mechanism
though.
Curious as to what the problem
might be, I volunteered to take a
look at it. Because it had been a
sudden failure, I reasoned that the
fault probably lay in the control box.
The drive mechanism hadn’t shown
any signs of trouble up until that
point and Jan had already removed
the bottom cover from the unit and
inspected the Nylon drive-gear assembly, as well as the rest of the
mechanism including the trolley and
the chain drive.
These parts were all OK, so the
likely suspects were a fault on the
control PCB, a faulty motor-start
capacitor or a faulty drive motor.
Troubleshooting it in-situ wasn’t
practical, so Jan decided to take the
control box down. That way, I could
take it home and troubleshoot it on
the workbench.
Getting the unit down was basically just a matter of disconnecting
the chain, undoing the bolts that secure the trolley to the top of the unit
and then unbolting the unit from its
ceiling brackets. The unit was subsequently given to me the following
weekend and I took it home and set
it up on the workbench.
The B&D CAD4 (Control-A-Door)
is a well-made unit and despite its
age (and the work it had done), this
one appeared to be in excellent condition. The bottom cover had been
left off, so I placed the unit upside
down on the bench and took a good
look inside.
The control PCB sits vertically at
the rear of the unit, behind a plastic
panel which is in turn attached to a
metal chassis. Immediately behind
this is the Nylon gear-drive assembly,
while an open/close limit-switch
mechanism is attached to a metal
bracket immediately above this assembly. The 230VAC motor is at the
front of the unit, with its associated
start capacitor adjacent to one side.
The wiring and gear mechanism
all appeared to be OK, so I carefully
straddled the unit across an open
cardboard box and wired a pushbutton switch to the up/down contacts on the rear panel. I then plugged
the unit into the mains, checked that
the chain-drive sprocket was in the
clear and pressed the button.
The result? – nothing; absolutely
nothing. Pressing the up/down button several more times gave the same
result, so it was time to take a look
at the control PCB.
First, I unplugged the unit from
the mains (important since mains
voltages are present on some PCB
tracks) and removed the rear panel
and PCB assembly from the chassis by undoing several self-tapping
screws. This then allowed me to
undo several more screws at the back
of the PCB, so that the board could
be detached from the panel to reveal
the component side.
I spotted the likely culprit almost
procedure due to the fact they are typically clipped on using plastic retaining
clips and these are easily broken. The
first time the back comes off, it certainly sounds like they are breaking as
they let go but with the right spudger
(prying tool), I can usually get things
apart without any damage.
A trick for young players here is that
many tablets have a couple of screws
holding the back on, either conveniently hidden away among the various
ports and sockets or hidden under thin
plastic covers that need to be removed
(I use the sharp tip of a craft knife for
this task). Indeed, I’ve had several
tablets brought in for repair over the
years with cracks in the rear covers. In
each case, some amateur repairer had
tried to force the cover off, not realising
that screws were holding it in place.
With the back off, it was an easyenough task to check out the charging circuit. Most tablets use either a
micro-USB connector or a standard
2.1mm DC connector, both of which
regularly give up through too much
tension being applied to the charging
plug and/or cable. Fortunately, both
sockets offer ready access to their PCB
connections and by using a multimeter
and some nice, sharp probes, you can
quickly determine whether or not the
charging circuit is still intact.
In this case, the socket was a DC type
and with the power supply plugged
into it, I could track and measure 5V
all the way to the circuit board.
Another quick and dirty test of
charger operation is to measure the
voltage across the battery. Plugging
and unplugging the power supply
should see some variation in the battery voltage and given that the battery
usually connects to the PCB using
heavy gauge red and black wires (either soldered directly or via a slim-line
Molex-style connector), the battery
connections are usually easy to locate
and access.
The actual voltage figure you get
doesn’t really matter and depends
on the state of charge of the battery.
However, when the power is plugged
in, there should be a small gain in
overall voltage and a corresponding
drop when the power is removed. If
so, that indicates that the charging
circuit is working.
The battery these days is typically a
lithium-polymer (LiPo) type. If it has
failed, then you’ll get somewhere in
the region of 4-5V across its terminals
B&D CAD4 Garage Door Controller
44 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Limit
Terminal
Metal
Cross-arm
Limit
Terminal
There are only two electrolytics on the control board and
they’re easy to replace. C25 (330μF 35V) was the culprit in
this case and its replacement unit is shown arrowed.
The view inside the unit. When the motor runs, a central
worm gear drives a metal cross-arm in one direction or
the other, until it contacts one of the limit terminals.
straight away. There are only two
electrolytic capacitors on the control
board and one of them, a 330µF 35V
unit (C25) adjacent to one of the
relays, had a very slight bulge at the
top. This capacitor appeared to be
across a relay coil and if it was indeed
faulty, it was possible that the relay
wasn’t being activated.
But was it going to be that easy? I
whipped the capacitor out and soldered a new 470µF 50V unit in its
place. While I was at it, I changed the
other (smaller) electrolytic capacitor
for good measure, even though it appeared to be OK. I then reassembled
the unit, set it up with the exposed
chain-drive sprocket clear of any
obstructions and reconnected the
power.
It was time for the smoke test. I
pressed the open/close button and
the motor immediately started and
continued running until one of the
limit switches closed. I then pressed
the button again and the motor ran
in the opposite direction until the
other limit switch closed.
So yes, it was that easy and the
replacement part cost less than $1.00.
All that remains now is to reinstall the unit and there’s a set
procedure to be followed to ensure
that the door operates reliably and
safely. The CAD4 installation manual
is on the B&D website and clearly
describes the adjustment procedure.
Basically, the unit has to be installed so that the limit switches
operate correctly at either end of
the door travel. It’s also necessary to
tweak the force adjustment controls,
so that the door easily stops and
reverses if an obstruction is encountered in the downwards direction
(or if it encounters a 40mm-high
obstruction on the garage floor).
Similarly, it should stop if an obstruction interferes with the door’s
upwards travel.
None of the adjustments has been
interfered with on the repaired unit
so it should simply be a matter of
re-installing it to match the way it
was, with only minor tweaking necessary afterwards. As for that faulty
330µF capacitor, it measured just a
few nanofarads and had a very high
ESR. It’s a wonder that the unit kept
working for as long as it did!
when the charger is connected but it
won’t retain any charge. Instead, the
battery voltage will fall to zero (or
below 3.7V) when the power supply/
charger is removed.
If the battery has been allowed to
sit without being charged for months
on end, chances are it will not be in
any fit state to be charged. And that’s
regardless of how much current you
try to pump into it or how long you
do it for. In fact, doing this can be extremely dangerous with LiPo batteries
and, despite the temptation, you just
shouldn’t do it.
Those of us used to working with
lead-acid and NiCd batteries have, on
occasions, given them some serious
‘beans’ for a minute or two in order
to ‘shock’ them into accepting charge.
In some cases, this does work, though
the I’d wager that the lifespan of the
battery was usually shortened by this
procedure.
If you do this with a LiPo battery
though, you are courting disaster.
Don’t belive me? – there are enough
examples of exploding batteries on the
internet to provide a suitable deterrent
to those who think their experience
will somehow be different because
their case is ‘special’ or they “know
what they are doing”.
Of course, if you want to see flaming battery gel splattered all over your
workshop, then by all means carry on.
On the other hand, if the battery measures 3V or below at full charge with no
load, it’s far better that you simply trust
me when I tell you that it’s ruined and
beyond repair, no matter what some
‘expert’ on the internet claims.
In this case, I was getting just under 5V at the charging socket and the
logic board, so the charging circuit
was intact. The battery appeared to
be taking a charge and holding it and
that was a bother because it meant that
something else was wrong and given
the symptoms, it was possible the operating system had become corrupted.
Now this isn’t necessarily as bad as
it sounds; Android has several ‘modes’
you can use to try to repair the system
or recover from a corrupted installation. You put Android into these
modes by pressing a combination of
the power, volume and other keys
and once there you can perform tasks
like installing updates, refreshing the
system or even testing out individual
components.
Obviously, you can break things
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 45
Serviceman’s Log – continued
Washing Machine Saves Dishwasher
What’s better than just having a
smoke alarm? Having a smoke alarm
AND two cats, according to J. C. of
Moonbi, NSW, especially if your
washing machine starts smoking.
Here’s his story . . .
In September 2012, I wrote about
an Ariston KS2050A dishwasher that
had overflowed into its drip tray and
damaged the motor windings in the
process. Fortunately, I was able to
repair the machine but it has had another couple of mishaps since then.
The first problem was that the
main power switch failed but that
was easy to diagnose and fix. And the
second? . . . well, one day after the
dishwasher had finished its cycle, it
still had litres of water remaining in
the bottom. Clearly, the drain water
pump wasn’t pumping too well or
the drain pipe had become clogged.
On inspection, I discovered that
there was a leak inside the pump
itself and this had allowed water to
fill the cavity where the motor’s rotor
spins. This slowed it down considerably, so it no longer pumped the
water out. We certainly don’t seem
to have much luck with appliances
but this time, the dishwasher was
saved by the almost simultaneous
demise of a different appliance – our
washing machine!
Previously, our washing machine
(an Ariston AVXL129) had developed a problem whereby it would
regularly stop working with its indicator LEDs flashing randomly at a
fast rate. I reasoned that the problem
would be in the main control board
but was advised that a new one was
over $500 so I decided to see if I could
badly by playing around with these
modes but they can be incredibly
handy when used correctly. After some
experimentation, I found that by holding both volume buttons down and
plugging in the charging lead, I could
enter ‘upload mode’, which allows a
suitable ROM file to be copied from
a computer or an SD-card and then
installed onto the system.
All I needed now was that package
and I’d be away but as I said earlier,
46 Silicon Chip
fix the problem myself.
The first step was to check the
low-voltage power supply. I began
by connecting a pair of wires across
the supply rails and brought these
out of the washing machine to make
checking easier, especially when the
machine stopped working. However,
not having a circuit and being unfamiliar with the circuitry, I wasn’t
sure whether or not this low-voltage
supply floated at mains potential.
To be on the safe side, I assumed
that it did and so I fully insulated
the wires and terminated them in a
mains terminal block. This would
allow me to safely insert the multimeter probes into this block to measure the low-voltage supply without
fear of electrocution.
That measurement immediately
revealed the fault. The supply was
normally 5V DC but would intermittently drop to hover at less than half
this. And that’s when the machine
stopped running and the LED lights
flashed erratically.
Subsequent close examination of
the PCB revealed that a TNY264P
off-line switcher was the controller
for the supply. I then checked the
board with a magnifying glass and
discovered that a surface-mount
bypass capacitor for this device was
only soldered on one side. It left the
bypass pin (BP) open, resulting in
the likelihood of erratic operation.
This joint was resoldered and the
machine then performed flawlessly
for several months. And then one
night, the washing machine caught
fire. This fire started in the main
drive motor and had nothing to do
finding the custom ROMs created for
these no-name tablets can be difficult.
But then a stroke of luck; the manufacturer of the tablet had stored a copy of
this file on the internal SD card and
when update mode was entered, this
file showed up as an available update.
So, after agreeing to the warnings that
installing it would wipe any previously-installed versions, I selected it and
let Android do its work.
After about five minutes of watch-
with the earlier electronics repair.
Instead, the main washing drum had
developed a pinhole and this had allowed water to drip onto the motor,
creating an electrical leakage path.
Our two cats sleep in the laundry
and it was their loud yowls that
woke us up. Understandably, they
were desperate to get out by the time
we reached them, as the smoke had
almost reached ground level. The
smoke alarm in the hallway just
outside the laundry didn’t sound
until we opened the laundry door so
if it hadn’t been for the cats waking
us, this story may well have had a
different ending.
We immediately disconnected
the power and put the fire out with
a fire extinguisher. We then dragged
the machine outside. This wasn’t
an easy task since the machine was
quite hot after the fire and being full
of wet towels and water, was decidedly heavy.
The next day, I checked the damage and it was obvious that it was a
write-off. Very few parts were salv
ageable but one part I did salvage
was the drain water pump.
Now, apart from the colour of the
impeller and a few other cosmetic
differences, this pump was identical to the one required for the dishwasher. What’s more, a drain water
pump for a washing machine does
the same job as that in a dishwasher
and both units were from the same
manufacturer, so I decided to give it
a try. It proved to be ideal and the
dishwasher now runs completely
through its cycle, fully draining out
the water when required to do so.
So, in the interests of safety, it is
recommended that you get a cat or
a smoke alarm for your laundry. We
have two cats and a smoke alarm to
be doubly sure a fire is reported!
ing the Android “man at work” and
a slowly advancing progress bar, the
tablet restarted and lo and behold,
away it went.
A subsequent visit to some of the
excellent forums on the web confirmed
my suspicions that some manufacturers include a copy of their custom
ROM with the device just in case
disaster strikes. You can check this
out by using the file manager app to
peruse your internal storage media
siliconchip.com.au
for a likely-looking file. This could
be named anything but as a general
rule, these files usually need to be
named “update.zip” to work. On the
other hand, when searching and downloading from the web, they might be
called something more descriptive,
with a file name including the version
of Android and the model number of
the device.
The real trick might be finding how
to enter the different modes and here
Google can help. If you can’t find any
information about it, try pushing and
holding different combinations of the
volume, home and any other buttons
while pushing the power button – you
can usually trigger upload/download
or recovery modes this way.
This is the view
inside the CMS
2000 inverter
with the cover
removed. The
switchmode
power supply is
the sub-board in
the top righthand corner.
Faulty solar panel inverter
Solar panel inverters typically cost
$2000 or more but how many are discarded because of a minor fault? D. P.
of Faulconbridge NSW recently saved
himself $2000 by spending just 44
cents to replace one faulty component.
Here’s what happened . . .
We have a 3kW grid-connected solar
system, consisting of two strings of
nine solar panels, each string feeding a
CMS 2000 (2kW) inverter. A few weeks
ago, I noticed that one of the inverters
was slow to start up in the morning. It
was often at least 10am before it ‘woke
up’ and on some days it didn’t wake up
at all. The other inverter would typically ‘wake up’ at around 7am.
A search of the Internet drew a blank,
so this didn’t appear to be a common
problem with these inverters. The
only possible clue was that the input
voltage at which the inverter starts up
is under software control. Apparently,
this voltage is set to a default value by
the firmware but can be adjusted via
the inverter’s serial port – if you have
the right software AND you have the
password for the inverter.
Anyway, all this was academic,
because the CMS 2000 comes with a
5-year warranty. All I needed to do was
to make a warranty claim and get the
inverter repaired or replaced, right?
Wrong!
On checking my paperwork, I found
that the inverters were one month out
of warranty! I called the company
which had installed the system, explained the problem and asked them
if they would stretch a point and honour the warranty anyway. “No” was
the stern reply, “if we do it for you
siliconchip.com.au
we will have to do it for everyone. In
any case, those inverters are no longer
made. We would have to replace both
of your CMS 2000s with a single 3kW
inverter. We can supply one for about
$2000 including the wiring changes
that would have to be made to your
board”.
My reaction to this was rather immoderate! Apart from the high cost
and the company’s inflexible attitude,
it seemed outrageous to be throwing
away one perfectly good inverter and
another that possibly only needed a
software tweak.
After some thought, I decided to take
the inverter to the company’s premises
and see if I could convince them to at
least have a look at it and determine
whether it was fixable or not. As it
turned out, my sudden appearance on
their doorstep produced a welcome
change in attitude. To my surprise (and
to their credit), they told me that fixing
it may just be a simple matter of reflashing the EEPROM and they readily
agreed to get one of their technicians to
do it while I waited. What’s more, when
I expressed an interest in observing the
process, they gave me permission to go
into the workshop with him.
The technician was a nice guy and
seemed ready to share his knowledge.
First, he connected a specialised
power supply (a fake solar panel) to
the inverter. This provides a source
of approximately 300V DC which, he
explained, simulates a typical string of
solar panels. No AC mains connection
was made to the inverter, however.
The technician explained that all the
voltages needed for the various circuits
in this inverter are derived from the DC
input, so that was all that was need to
install the firmware.
No sign of life
We immediately struck problems.
The technician expected the inverter to
start up under these conditions within
a minute or so but there was no sign of
life. I explained that this inverter was
normally slow to start and told him
that I thought it could be a software
problem. He said that this was unlikely
and opened up the case.
First, he checked all the Mosfets.
These monsters were all OK fortunately, so he then did some voltage
measurements. During these tests, he
pointed out a small sub-board containing a switchmode power supply. This
board takes the DC input from the
solar panels via two of the Mosfets and
generates the various voltages used in
the inverter. It should start running as
soon as there is 100V or more from the
solar panels, well before the inverter
proper starts up, but there was no
output from it.
“Well, I’m afraid that’s it,” he said,
“the inverter’s kaput! We don’t repair
these things at a component level any
more and as far as I know, there is noone who does.”
At that stage, I thanked the technician for his trouble and told him I
thought I would have a go at fixing
it myself. It seemed to me that this
switchmode supply could not be all
that different from the sort of thing
found in computers or a thousand
other devices these days – they accept
a high-voltage DC input and produce
October 2014 47
Serviceman’s Log – continued
The switchmode power supply board
with its new capacitor (C01) in place.
several low-voltage outputs. The main
difference here was the source of highvoltage DC. Besides, I had a good one
for comparison so what could possibly
go wrong?
When I got back home, I spent some
time thinking about the inverter’s
wake-up behaviour. Its slow wake-up
was almost certainly due to a fault on
the switchmode board and probably
had nothing to do with the solar panel
voltage or any software settings. Some
other factor was causing it to wake up
late. Could it be temperature? Was it
starting up when the ambient temperature rose to a certain level?
A blast of hot air
I whipped the cover off and, with the
aid of Mrs P’s hair-dryer, gave the power
supply board a blast of hot air. Almost
instantly the power supply sprang into
life and the inverter began to go through
its start-up sequence. I also noted that
a low-level, high-pitched screeching
noise which was coming from the
switchmode board when it was in the
fault condition immediately stopped
when it came to life.
Placing a scope probe near the inverter transformer revealed a noisy,
chaotic waveform when in the fault
condition. However, this turned into
a clean switching waveform once the
supply began operating normally. So it
looked like the supply was squegging
when in the fault condition.
Using a paper cone with a small
opening at the apex, I then tried directing a more localised stream of hot air
onto individual components on the
board. This approach quickly paid off
because I soon identified an electrolytic capacitor, marked as C01 on the
board, that seemed extremely heat
sensitive. When checked with an ESR
meter, it measured close to its marked
capacitance of 220µF but its ESR was
quite high at around 21Ω.
Replacing it restored the inverter to
normal operation. Subsequent testing
of the faulty capacitor then revealed
that while its ESR was 21Ω when
cold, this dropped to about 3Ω when
it was heated moderately. Even at this
level, it was maybe 10 times higher
than it should have been and given
that switchmode power supplies are
notoriously sensitive to capacitors
with excessive ESR, I was surprised
that the supply operated at all with
this capacitor in circuit.
Replacing a 44-cent capacitor is certainly a much better deal than forking
out $2000 for a new inverter! It makes
me wonder just how many “dead” inverters that actually had minor faults
are now clogging up landfills, having
cost people serious money to replace
them.
Finally, a few words of caution to
anyone contemplating working on one
of these inverters:
(1) The output of a typical solar panel
string is potentially lethal (several
hundred volts DC), even when not in
full sun. This voltage is present on
several components in the inverter
(even when the grid is not connected)
and is potentially lethal;
(2) With the grid connected and the
inverter operating, lethal AC and DC
voltages are present on various components in the inverter and it’s all too easy
to come into contact with these parts if
you aren’t careful. In fact, I would not
recommend operating the inverter with
Servicing Stories Wanted
Do you have any good servicing stories that you would like to share in The Serviceman column? If so, why not send those stories in to us?
We pay for all contributions published but please note that your material must
be original. Send your contribution by email to: editor<at>siliconchip.com.au
Please be sure to include your full name and address details.
48 Silicon Chip
the cover off with the grid connected,
if at all avoidable; and
(3) There are several large capacitors
in the inverter which remain charged
at lethal voltages for some time after
the inverter has been shut down. The
inverter should be left for at least 30
minutes after shut-down for these capacitors to discharge before doing any
work on it and then only after you’ve
checked these voltages with a DMM.
Motor start capacitor failure
B. R., of Beverley, WA recently encountered an unusual problem with an
evaporative air-conditioner but there
was a simple explanation. Here’s his
story . . .
We rent out the house next door to
our property and, earlier in the year,
our tenant called us one very hot afternoon to say that the evaporative airconditioning wasn’t working. I went
over to check it out and on entering
the house, I could hear the blower fan
running on maximum. However, with
the air-conditioning not working, the
house was very hot inside, it being
over 40°C outside.
I got my ladder and climbed onto
the roof where I removed one of the
wood fibre panels from the unit. This
revealed that the water pump was
working, as the water was pouring out
over the pads.
A remote power switch is mounted
inside the cooling head to aid servicing
so I turned it off and had a look around.
There were no obvious problems that I
could see and when I turned the fan on,
it started and went to full power with
no problems. So everything appeared
to be working but the unit wasn’t cooling the house.
After poking around for awhile, it
dawned on me that the fan was running in reverse and sucking hot air into
the house through the gaps around the
doors and windows. But why was it
running in reverse? Well, the hot air
rising from below and passing through
the ducts was causing the fan to slowly
rotate in reverse without any power
applied. When power was applied,
the motor started in that direction and
that meant one thing – a faulty motor
start capacitor.
Fortunately, I had a spare motor start
capacitor in a junked unit. This was
duly fitted and the motor now started
in the correct direction. Full cooling
to the house was then restored, much
SC
to the relief of our tenant.
siliconchip.com.au
OCTOBER
Techfest
THIS MONTH AT
JAYCAR ELECTRONICS
Ideal Gift Idea!
3D PRINTER KIT - BRING YOUR 3D CREATIONS TO LIFE!
Supplied as a DIY kit, once assembled you can turn
3D digital images into real life plastic objects. A very
fast, reliable and precise 3D printer that won't break
the bank.
NEW!
Can print objects with maximum
dimensions of 200 x 200 x
200mm, in either ABS or PLA
plastics (available separately).
On li n e & in st or e
10MHz/4000 Count Handheld Scope Meter
Smartly designed to meet the needs of on-site
testing and diagnosis. Combines all functions of a
4,000 count True RMS CAT III digital multimeter
and a 10MHz oscilloscope. One-keypress
switches between DMM and DSO. Includes USB
interface and PC logging software.
$1,299
This is an advanced level constructional kit, average
build time is 3 - 4 days. For more information on
assembly and the tools required please visit our
website. Extensive online community support is also
available at: www.k8200.eu
TL-4020
ACCESSORIES TO SUIT:
3D Printer Controller Module
3D Printer LED Light
3mm PLA 3D Printer Black Filament (1kg)
3mm ABS 3D Printer Black Filament (1kg)
399
$
• 128 x 128 graphic LCD display
• Autoranging, AC/DC
voltage (1000V),
current (20A)
• 50MSa/s sample rate
• Size: 186(L) x 86(W)
HB-6361
x 32(D)mm
QM-1577
* Valid with purchase of QM-1577
FREE*
CASE
DEAL INCLUDES: TL-4020,TL-4022,TL-4024,TL-4062 & TL-4072
• IP67 rated camera
$
• 685mm flexible gooseneck
• Up to 50m line-of-sight
range
iPhone® not included
QC-3351
149
NEW KIT
3.2" LCD Touchscreen
Display Kit
Add an interactive
touchscreen display
to your existing
Arduino projects.
Draw lines, shapes,
text, display images,
play sound and log
data to microSD card.
Includes LCD display, 4D
Arduino Adaptor Shield, 5 way
interface cable and USB
programming adaptor with
pre-loaded software.
Mini-D 2 x 10W Class-D
Amplifier Kit
119
$
• Operating voltage: 4.5 - 5.5VDC
• Screen display area: 64.8 x 48.6mm
• Screen resolution: 240 x 320 pixels
• 65K True to life colours
XC-4280
50X Spotting Scope with Smartphone Bracket
Solar Rechargeable LED Floodlight
• 10W cool white LED
• Light size: 175(H) x
145(W) x 53(D)mm
SL-2808
siliconchip.com.au
$
159
To order call 1800 022 888
219
4995
$
Kit includes double sided, solder-masked and screen-printed
PCB, and ALL SMD components pre-soldered to the PCB.
NEW STORE OPENING SOON
Heavy Duty Infrared Door Beam
Detects when a person or object crosses a
boundary or entrance way. Features a
weatherproof (IP66) casing with an anti-fog
sensor window making it suitable
for use outdoors and in dusty
or damp environments.
High powered 720
lumens for 4WD use.
Spot or flood beam
available. Waterproof
IP67 alloy housing
and stainless steel
mounting hardware.
Spot SL-3939 $89.95
Flood SL-3938 $89.95
NEW!
Ph: (08) 9444 9250
2" LED Vehicle Work Lights
• Voltage: 9-60VDC
• Sold as a pair
• Powered from 8 - 25VDC
• No heatsink required!
• PCB: 85 x 46mm
KC-5530
83-87 Frobisher St
(Cnr of Frobisher St
& Collingwood St)
WA 6017
NEW!
The 3W solar panel comes with a bracket allowing
you to bolt it onto a surface to catch as much
sunlight as possible. LED light automatically turns
on when darkness
falls, and activates
when the PIR detects
motion. 3m cable
included.
Ref: Silicon Chip Magazine September 2014
Can deliver more than 10W per channel or 30W
mono. Features on-board
volume control, low-power
shutdown mode and
over-temperature/current
protection. Compact
design and highly efficient.
Osborne Park
Portable field spotting scope with Smartphone bracket. Great for many other
outdoor activities. View, capture and share your magnified images or video
via your Smartphone. Lightweight tripod and carry bag included.
$
http://bit.ly/TL-4020
VALUED AT $1,570.85 SAVE $171.85!
Inspect the inaccessible areas with this 1.8" colour
CMOS camera. Uses your Smartphone as the
screen. Power supply, bracket, hook and metal
adaptor included.
Bracket compatible with iPhone4s/5® and
Samsung Galaxy S3/S4®
$149.00
$34.95
$44.95
$42.95
3D BUNDLE DEAL $1,399
Wi-Fi Inspection Camera for Smartphones
• Magnification: 12x, 16x, 50x
• K25mm eyepiece
GG-2134
TL-4022
TL-4024
TL-4062
TL-4072
Filament
not included
89
$
95
ea
• Up to 15m range
• Adjustable vertical beam angle
• Input voltage: 12 to 250V AC or DC
• Size: 122(H) x 62(D) x 61(W)mm
LA-5179
Accessories to suit:
Extension Buzzer
LA-5188 $34.95
Counter Module
LA-5197 $34.95
99
$
October 2014 49
www.jaycar.com.au
Workbench TECH
High Temperature
Non-Contact
Thermometer
Handheld Oscilloscope & Function Generator
10MHz Rechargeable
Pocket Scope
Complete portable oscilloscope with
backlit LCD! Aside from standard
scope features, it has nifty tools for
measurement of RMS speaker
power, display hold function, and
memory storage for 2 signals.
Housed in a durable rubber surround.
• 40MSa/s sample rate
• CRO probe and USB charge cable
supplied
• Size: 114(H) x 74(W) x 29(D)mm
QC-1914 WAS $249
1MHz Rechargeable
Function Generator
• Backlit LCD
• Sweep modes: Linear/logarithmic,
single/bidirectional
• Size: 114(H) x 74(W) x 29(D)mm
SAVE $30
QT-2304 WAS $199
See website for full specifications
219
$
Pro Gas Soldering Tool Kit
A sturdy, portable, self-igniting butane powered gas
soldering iron tool kit. Produces a 1300˚C adjustable
flame for low end brazing, tin/plastic melting, automotive
repair work, welding and heat shrinking. Supplied with 3
interchangeable metal tips, plastic carry case, cleaning
sponge and deflector.
• 80-100 min
operating time
• Torch size: 236(L) x 37(D)mm
TS-1113
$
6995
2995
$
44
TH-1603 $3.95
NA-1020 $5.95
Repair Tool Kit
for iPhone®
FREE*
• Tank Capacity: 2500ml
(Max 2100ml, Min 600ml)
• 5 selectable time settings
• Weight: 2.5kg
NEW!
• Size: 290(W) x
223(D) x 185(H)mm
$
YH-5412
149
$
1995
• 3mm thick, hard wearing face over dense
sponge rubber base
• Mat folds out to approx.
$
95
600 x 600mm
TH-1776
14 95
50 Silicon Chip
To order call 1800 022 888
*Valid with
purchase of
TS-1574
Features a generous 2.5L 304-grade stainless steel bowl,
controllable heating element and digital controls. Stylish
cabinet design and very well built.
Features reverse and forward modes, LED
light to illuminate hard to see spots,
and 3 adjustable handle
configurations. Includes mains
charger, carry pouch, Philips,
Flat, Torx and Hex bits.
49
299
Digital 2.5L 170W Ultrasonic Cleaner
• 3x and 12x magnifying lenses
• Size: 320(H) x 95(Dia.)mm
QM-3544
Ideal for anyone who manufactures, repairs
or services sensitive electronic equipment.
This tool kit allows you
to disassemble and
re-assemble your
phone for replacing
cracked screens,
dead batteries,
scratched back
panels and more. See
website for contents.
$
VALUED AT $17.95 (NS-3094)
Anti-Static Field Service Mat
$
• Suitable for lead-free solder
• Celsius and Fahrenheit display
• Microprocessor controlled
• Size: 225(L) x 215(W) x155(H)mm
TS-1574
LEAD-FREE SOLDER
49
• 4.8V rated
• 270mm long
TD-2497
189
$
Complete solder/
desolder station for
production and service
use. Soldering/rework
functions can be
operated
independently
of each other.
Rechargeable Cordless Electric Screwdriver
Selection of popular slotted,
Phillips, Star and TRI bits
packed neatly inside a
handy storage case. See
website for contents.
TD-2114
2
Handy soldering iron with flame
or flameless heat blower
function, suitable for general
heating, drying,
melting, cutting,
$
95
soldering, heat
shrinking etc.
Sixty LEDs provide bright illumination
and perfectly even light. Precision
lens for clear, strain-free viewing.
Heavy base for secure tabletop
mounting. Ideal
for hobbies,
$
95
model-making
or jewellery etc.
2995
• Temperature range: -50 to
+1000˚C (-58 to +1832˚F)
• Built-in laser pointer
• Automatic data hold
• Dual display with backlit LCD
• Moulded carry case included
QM-7226
60W ESD Safe Solder / Rework
Station
Desktop LED
Magnifying Lamp
$
22 Piece Long Bit
Screwdriver Set
• Suits iPhone® 3G,
3GS, 4, 4s, 5
TD-2115
Mini Gas Soldering
Tool Set
Spare 1mm Conical Tip
Butane gas required
10X LED Magnifier with Scale
• All metal construction
• Built-in metric and imperial scale
• Uses 2 x AA batteries (included)
• 26mm eyepiece, 180mm long
QM-3539
179
$
SAVE $20
• Adjustable temperature control
• Flame temp: Up to 1300˚C
• Power range: 25W to 70W
TH-1606
Spare tips and butane gas to suit:
3mm Flat Tip
TS-1116 $4.95
4mm Chisel Tip
TS-1117 $4.95
Blower Tip
TS-1118 $12.95
Butane gas
NA-1020 $5.95
Superbly built handheld
magnifier with 3 LED
illuminating lights.
Provides 10 dioptre
magnification with
built-in scale so you can take
measurements of an object.
This professional grade
infrared thermometer features
30:1 distance-to-target ratio to
measure high temperatures
safely from greater distance.
A bench top generator in a portable
size! Produces sine, square, and
triangle waveform signals with
output frequency adjustment from
1Hz to 1MHz with maximum
amplitude of 8Vpp.
Sheet Metal Bender
This unit sits in the
jaws of your
bench vice
(100mm+ recommended).
It retains itself in the vice with
strong recessed magnets.
Folds sheets up to 125 wide.
Bends steel strips up to 4mm
thick and 25mm wide.
TH-1763
$
4995
Self-Powered LED Panel Meters
Simple and easy to install self-powered
meters with voltage or current display.
The voltmeter has a simple 2-wire
connection, and the current meter has
4-wire connection with an included
current shunt.
• Auto zero calibration
• Easy to read red LED display
• Cut-out size 42 x 23mm
LED Voltmeter 8 - 30V DC
LED Ammeter 0 - 50A DC
QP-5586 $24.95
QP-5588 $39.95
$
FROM
2495
Note: When connecting the ammeter QP-5588 it is essential that the wiring
instructions provided with the product are followed, or the meter may be destroyed.
siliconchip.com.au
www.jaycar.com.au
Savings off original RRP. Limited stock on sale items
AUTO TECH
CANBus Compatible Festoon
LED Globes
12V LED Vehicle Lights
A range of 150 lumens
ultra-bright white LED
replacement "festoon"
globes for car interior lights.
Fully compatible with modern
"CANBus" systems. 12VDC.
• 6 x 5730SMD LEDs
• 120˚ wide beam
NEW!
31mm ZD-0750 $12.95
36mm ZD-0752 $12.95
42mm ZD-0754 $12.95
$
4.5" LED Vehicle Work Lights
Super bright running
lamps produce
enough light to run
during the day time
or used as a spotlight
fixture. The two piece
set produces 120
lumens, improving
visibility of vehicles on and off the road.
• 9 White LEDs
• Waterproof, long life and
easily installed
• Size: 88(Dia.)mm
SL-3445
1295ea
$
Extremely bright 1450 lumens
spot or flood beam work lights.
Features waterproof IP68 rated
alloy housing and stainless steel
mounting hardware. 12/24V.
• Beam distance (spot/flood):
230m/125m
• Input current: 2.1A (12V),
1.1A (24V)
• Sold as a pair
3995
Spotlights
Floodlights
• Range up to 50m
• Infrared LEDs for reversing after dark
QM-3852
DEAL! 16GB MICROSD CARD
VALUED AT $26.95 (XC-4989)
In-Car FM Transmitter
to suit iPhone 5®
Smartphone Holder with
FM Transmitter
• Built-in microphone
• USB output: 5V/800mA
• Size: 100(L) x 30(W) x 12(D)mm
AR-3127
• Dash mounted universal holder
• Supports MP3/WMA/WAV formats
• USB output: 5V/2.1A
AR-3128
iPhone not
included
®
iPhone®
not
included
12V Power Accessories
Cigarette Lighter Socket
to 8mm Eye Terminal
• 400mm long leads with 8mm eye terminals
• Rated to 15A max
PT-4451
DEAL
Buy AR-3128 & XC-4992
3995
$
for $72.90
Save $15
1995
1295
$
Speedo Corrector Module
This smart module alters the
speedometer signal up or
down from 0% to 99% of
the original signal.
Extremely useful when
you modify your gearbox,
diff ratio or change to a
large circumference tyre.
12VDC.
Simple tuning tool to help in vehicle
modification or monitor the
behaviour of the engine control
module. 10 LEDs show fuel mixture
levels - rich, lean or normal. 12VDC.
• Size: 81(L) x 51(W) x 22(H)mm
Exhaust/Gas/Oxygen
Sensor Module AA-0374 $24.95
NEW!
2495ea
$
SIGN UP NOW & BE REWARDED
Earn a point for every dollar spent at any Jaycar Company
store* & be rewarded with a $25 Rewards Cash Card once you
reach 500 points!
*Conditions apply.
See website for T&Cs
siliconchip.com.au
• Automatic input setup selection
• Size: 63(L) x 46(W) x 25(H)mm
AA-0376
To order call 1800 022 888
Register online today by visiting
• Surface mount or flush
mount (22mm cutout)
• One-knob volume and track control
• Bluetooth 4.0
AR-3129
• 4 x 12VDC socket outputs
(max 10A)
• 1 x 5VDC 1A USB port
• Mounting hardware included
PS-2019
$
Auto Tuning Display
Modules
4995
$
4 Way Power Splitter with USB
• 300mm long lead with
dustproof cover
PP-2098
1295
*Valid with purchase of QV-3844
Take phone calls
and stream
music from
any Bluetooth®
enabled device over
your car/marine radio.
12VDC.
Cigarette Lighter Plug to
Merit Socket Adaptor
$
229
$
Bluetooth Receiver
with Microphone
Charge and play music through the FM
radio in your car simultaneously. Connect
your Smartphone or load your songs onto
a microSD card (sold separately,
32GB XC-4992 $47.95). 12/24VDC.
A convenient way to playback
music from your iPhone®5
Smartphone through the car's
sound system. Includes
Lightning charging connector.
REGISTER
ONLINE
TODAY!
99ea
FREE*
199
$
Spare camera QM-3854 $84.95
Battery Voltage/Airflow Meter/Oxygen
Sensor Module
AA-0375 $24.95
$
Includes HD 720p front facing camera and 480p rear
camera. Features GPS to store position or route details
and 95˚ wide-angle view lens. 12VDC.
• 2.7" LCD screen
• G-Sensor to detect sudden vehicle movement
• Automatic recording upon ignition start
QV-3844
Quick and easy to install. Screen
can be suction mounted to
your windscreen and is
directly powered from the
cigarette lighter socket.
2995
NEW!
Dual Dash Cam with GPS
2.4GHz Digital Wireless
Reversing Camera
$
SL-3934 $99
SL-3936 $99
12V Thermoelectric Cooler &
Warmer
Cools to 18-20˚C below ambient temperature, and
heats up to 65˚C. Great for camping trips and work
sites. Low noise, fully insulated and thermoelectric.
Lightweight and portable.
NEW!
$
3995
• 12VDC powered
• 14L capacity
• CFC Free
• Size: 490(L) x 270(W)
x 305(H)mm
GH-1373
$
99
www.jaycar.com.au/rewards
October 2014 51
www.jaycar.com.au
3
POWER TECH
8A Heavy Duty Battery Charger
High Power 4 Stage Wall Mount Battery Chargers
Suitable for both 6 and 12 volt car, boat, motorcycle
and lawnmower batteries up to 6 amps. Switchable
between trickle or heavy duty charge rates.
Tough mains powered high power battery chargers designed to
quickly recharge 12V lead-acid batteries. Smart 4-stage
charging to ensure battery life is maintained by monitoring
and charging the batteries safely, resulting in a charger
that is safe to leave connected indefinitely.
Over-charging and ouput short-circuit protected.
• 4-stage LED charge indicators
• Overload and reverse polarity protection
• Complies with Australian Electrical Safety Regulations
MB-3522
• Bulk/Absorption: 14.2VDC / 14.6VDC / 14.8VDC
• Float charging: 13.2VDC / 13.5VDC / 13.8VDC
• Efficiency: Up to 88%
5995
$
15A
40A
High Power Pure Sine Wave Inverters
Suitable for a variety of mobile and permanent power installations. Provides
standard protection (overload, high temperature, over/under input voltage and
output short circuit) as well as host of additional features to improved
performance and reliability under adverse conditions. Range from 180 to 2000W.
• USB port
• 12VDC input, 230VAC output
1100W
1500W
2000W
MI-5706 WAS $649 NOW $549 SAVE $100
MI-5708 WAS $899 NOW $799 SAVE $100
MI-5710 WAS $1149 NOW $999 SAVE $150
See online for
Modified Sine
Wave Inverters
FROM $
549
MI-5710
Allows two batteries to be charged from your
engine alternator at the same time. The isolator
automatically engages and disengages
depending on the charge condition of the start
battery. Supplied as full kit with wiring hardware.
See website for full contents.
139
$
Semi-flexible Solar Panels
These 12V flexible solar panels offer performance
at anaffordable price. No heavy rigid frame makes
them light and portable. Both units have a fully
sealed terminal box with approx 1.2m of power
cable with PVC outer sheath.
MS-6170
6995
$
Digital DC Power Meter to suit 50mV External Shunt
• Current Range: 0-200A depending on shunt
MS-6172 $74.95
USB Data Adaptor
Enhance data collection of the digital
DC power meter by connecting to
your PC with this USB data adaptor.
$
7995
SAVE
$30
MS-6174
DEAL 2
MS-6172 + MS-6174
FOR $124.90
Plug in any mains appliance rated up
to 10A and use the remote to turn
each one on or off individually, or
control all of them together. One of the
outlets also has a LED night light that
is operated with the remote.
9995
• 10A 2400W rated
MS-6142
A true On-Line UPS featuring 2 power
sources (battery and mains) to ensure
instantaneous transfer time in
the event of a power failure.
This UPS has a 2U rack height,
and can be mounted in standard
19" rack set up or used in a
tower configuration.
4495
$
Spare Mains Outlet/Light
Spare Mains Outlet/Light with Remote
1000VA On-Line Pure Sine Wave UPS
MS-6143 $17.95
MS-6145 $24.95
Regulated Variable
Laboratory Power Supplies
499
$
DEAL! Save $49
Buy MP-5212 &
HB-5454 for $519
2U Fixed Rack Shelf valued at $69
52 Silicon Chip
This digital power meter displays both the continuous and peak voltage,
current, and power. Cumulative amp hours and watt hours consumed are also
stored allowing you to monitor the system over time. Suitable for DC operation
from 5 to 60V. An ideal addition to low voltage DC circuits on boats, caravans,
or solar systems.
Wireless 3 Outlet Mains Controller Kit
Note: Limited stock. Not available online.
4
699
$
Digital DC Power Meters
• Size: 45(L) x 35(W)
x 18(H)mm
DEAL 1
MS-6174
MS-6170 + MS-6174
FOR $119.90
FROM
• 1000VA/700W rated / 6 x IEC power outputs
• 32 mins backup time at high load
• Size: 440(W) x 350(D)
x 56(H)mm
MP-5212
Designed to perform in harsh tropical conditions! With
a superior high rate discharge performance and
higher cycle service life, this battery is perfect for a
wide array of applications including remote solar
systems, 4WD, caravan, RV, motorhome, and marine.
12VDC. See our website for full specs.
Digital DC Power Meter
with Internal Shunt
• Current Range: 0-20A
MS-6170 (Shown)
Also available:
Standalone Unit Without Wiring Hardware
MB-3685 $79.95
$
150Ah Sleek AGM Deep Cycle Battery
• Size: 41(L) x 45(W) x 23(D)mm
• Voltage rating: 12VDC (max 15VDC)
• Cut in/off voltage: 13.7/12.8 VDC
MB-3686
189
SAVE UP TO $40
NOTE: Not stocked in all stores but can be ordered.
Call your nearest store for details
140A Dual Battery Isolator Kit
100W
• Short circuit current: 5.69A
• Weight: 2.8kg
ZM-9116 $399
FROM $
• Small footprint to suit installations in tight areas
• Weight: 52kg
• Size: 123(W) x 556(D) x 296(H)mm
SB-1822
SAVE UP TO $150
20W
• Short circuit current: 1.24A
• Weight: 0.78kg
ZM-9112 $99.95
MB-3710 WAS $219 NOW $189 SAVE $30
MB-3715 WAS $399 NOW $359 SAVE $40
To order call 1800 022 888
This precision, automatic transfer type
power supply provides stable voltage and
current with regulated output voltage.
Features coarse and fine voltage controls.
Ideal for scientific research, education,
electronics and electrical equipment repair.
• Output voltage: 0 - 32VDC (Each)
• Output current: 0 - 3 Amps (Each)
Single Output
Dual Output
MP-3086 $199
MP-3087 $349 (shown)
FROM
199
$
siliconchip.com.au
www.jaycar.com.au
Savings off original RRP. Limited stock on sale items
COMMS TECH
Wi-Fi Multi Card & USB Reader
Share and transfer files
from memory cards/USB
storage devices
wirelessly between
computers, Tablets and
Smartphones using a
secure Wi-Fi hotspot.
• Up to 20m Wi-Fi range,
maximum 8 simultaneous
users
• Rechargeable, USB charge
cable included
• 105(L) x 65(H) x 11(D)mm
YN-8426
NEW!
$
5995
Wireless AC750 Dual
Band Router
Powerful 802.11ac router with Wi-Fi
speeds of up to 750Mbps. Stream HD
movies over Wi-Fi, transfer large files
quicker using the 5GHz band or the
option of 2.4GHz for general internet
browsing. Features 4 x 10/100
ethernet ports, WPA/WPA2,
firewall protection and QoS
for critical operations.
• 8 x RJ-45 ports
• Size: 137(L) x 76(W) x 25(H)mm
$
9995
$
FROM
Wire up an RS-485/422
device to the 4 socket
terminal block to give your
hardware USB connectivity.
Surge protected. Suitable for
industrial, military,
marine, science and
custom built applications.
• Supports 850, 1900, and 2100MHz
• Terminated with FME
connector
FROM
2495
5dBi, 300mm long with
2m Cable AR-3310 $49.95
7dBi, 960mm long with
3m Cable AR-3312 $69.95
• 610mm USB A Male to
Male cable included
• Size: 55(L) x 42(W) x
24(H)mm
XC-4132
49
$
95
1U Sliding Rack Shelf
6U Cabinets
• Size: 530(W) x 360(H) x 450(D)mm
• Key lockable
Flat Packed HB-5170
$
Was $159 Now $129 Save $30
FROM
Assembled HB-5171
Was $189 Now $149 Save $40 SAVE UP TO $40
129
2W UHF Transceiver with CTCSS
A standalone 80-channel transceiver with auto
power-saving 500mW mode. Features CTCSS
function, dual watch, Vox, auto squelch function
and low battery display. Includes a Li-ion
rechargeable battery and AC adaptor.
6995
• Max 20kg load
• Size: 483(W) x 52(H) x 350(D)mm
HB-5450
Also available:
1U Fixed Rack Shelf HB-5452 $49
A robust floating 80-channel
transceiver featuring CTCSS
function, Hi/Lo power output, auto
squelch function and low battery
display. Includes a Li-ion
rechargeable battery, AC adaptor
and charging cradle.
• Fully submersible, IP67 rated
• Range up to 10km line-of-sight
• Backlit LCD
DC-1074
FREE*
CAR CHARGER
119
VALUED AT $17.95 (DC-1035)
99
$
See online for our wide range of highest quality swing
frame cabinets, blank panels, cable management
accessories & punch-down tools!
3W UHF Floating
Transceiver with CTCSS
$
*Valid with purchase of DC-1049
$
7995
1U 24-Port Patch Panels
Ideal for mounting computer keyboards
or other equipment that
needs to be accessed easily.
Ball bearing runners for
smooth operation.
Ideal for studios, PA, sound
reinforcement, IT, or phone
systems installations. Features
1.8mm solid steel powder coated
cabinets with clear tempered
glass doors.
8995
$
RS-485/422 to USB Converter
Using 3G/4G wireless Internet in certain areas
may require the help of an antenna to boost the
signal for a reliable flow of data. Both antennas
features a very strong magnetic base so you
can fix it to the roof of your car or any other
steel surface.
19” Rack Mount Solutions
$
• 802.11b/g/n standards
• LAN port 10/100
(featuring PoE)
• Wireless data rate up to 150Mbps
YN-8330
NEW!
3G/4G Antennas
10/100Mbps Switch YN-8077 $24.95
10/100/1000Mbps Gigabit Switch YN-8078 $59.95
• Range up to 10km
line-of-sight
• Backlit LCD
DC-1049
With a wireless power of 600mW
this unit has excellent point-to-point
range with the built-in 9dBi
directional antenna. Ideal for long
range or building-to-building
wireless network.
• Functions as a router, access
point, range extender, Wi-Fi
bridge or WISP
YN-8329
8 Port N-Way Ethernet Switches
Enhance network
performance and
efficiency. Mains
powered or via USB
port. Supports autonegotiation and cable length
detection. Power supply and
USB power adaptor included.
High Power Wireless
Outdoor Router/Range
Extender
Sleek attractive looking rack mount 24
port patch panel with a hard metal
exterior. Numbered ports
and a labelling area for
$
95
each port.
49
• Includes instruction
stickers on the back
Suits Cat5e
Suits Cat6
YN-8046 $49.95
YN-8048 $69.95
3W VHF Floating
Transceiver
Essential for boating. Covers all
international VHF marine channels so
you can call for help when needed or
communicate with other boats.
Includes a Li-ion rechargeable
battery pack, AC adaptor,
charging cradle and belt clip.
• Fully submersible, IP67 rated
• Switchable output power
• One touch emergency CH16
• Backlit LCD
DC-1093
$
99
High Quality Cables for Your Next Project
15A DC Power Cable
RG59 / 16G Power Cable
• AWG: 16, single core
• Ideal for automotive and
marine applications
• Sold in handy pack
10m reel
Red
WH-3054 $12.95
Black WH-3055 $12.95
Green WH-3056 $12.95
siliconchip.com.au
• AWG: 24
• Ideal for CCTV and
surveillance applications
• Black
WB-2017
$
1295
/roll
To order call 1800 022 888
1
$
40
/m
50Ohm RG58U Cable
• AWG: 23, single core
• Suits up to 500MHz
• Ideal for CB, marine
and two-way radio
WB-2010
Both the WB-2017 & WB-2010 are also
sold in 100m rolls in-store or online
$
145/m
October 2014 53
www.jaycar.com.au
5
SECURIT Y TECH
Low Cost Home Automation
Don't spend tens of thousands of dollars to create a smart home. With our new
low cost range of Wireless Home Automation, you can create a fully automated
system and only spend a few hundred dollars.
Simple and easy to use, all sensors, controllers and swicth modules are
operating wirelessly on 433MHz frequency at a max range of 100m (line of sight).
Home Automation Main Controller
A powerful controller with built-in 16 wireless alarm zones and 16 wireless
home automation control. Easily interfaces with a wide range of wireless
security devices such as a PIR motion detectors (LA-5157), magnetic reed
switches (LA-5158), light sensors (LA-5598)
and remote key fobs (LA-5155) to protect
your home and property.
• Timer schedule programming
• Group programming
• Matrix (Scenes) programming
• 100 Alarm event memory
• 12VDC
• 240VAC power adaptor included
LA-5592
Accessories to suit:
Key FOB Remote
PIR to suit
Wireless reed switch to suit
• Voltage input: 12VDC
• Wireless Range: 100m line of sight
• Wireless Frequency: 433MHz
• Size: 340(L) x 200(W) x 75(D)mm
LA-5579
119
$
Peephole Viewer with
Image Capture
• Requires 2 x AA batteries
• Peephole tube diameter: 12mm
$
• Peephole tube length: 33 to 45mm
• Viewer size: 158(H) x 87(W)
x 32(D)mm
QC-3735 & QC-3737
QC-3735
FOR $249
225
BUY BOTH
QC-3834 $99
QC-3836 $119 (shown)
Also available:
PIR Motion Sensor
Vibration Knocking Sensor
Biometric Finger Scan Safe
Provides secure storage using a finger print scan for fast
and simple access in as little as 2 seconds! Features a
built-in flash memory and ideal for storing money,
passports etc. Mounting hardware included.
$
79
SAVE $20
4 Channel Remote Control Relay Kit
Control up to 4 different devices with a single controller
and key fob remote. Each of the 4 channels can be
independently configured to momentary or latching
mode via DIP switch. Ideal for access control
applications.
• Range up to 30m (300m+ max line of sight)
• 2 key fobs included
LR-8824
Spare Wired Transmitter LR-8819 $39.95
Spare Remote
LR-8829 $24.95
$
To order call 1800 022 888
99
NEW!
7995
$
8 Channel Network DVR
Displays video from the other side of
your door on a clear 3" LCD screen.
MicroSD card required for image
capture (sold separately XC-4992)
triggered by adding either the knock or
PIR sensors (sold separately).
99
• M-JPEG video compression
• Up to VGA 640x480 <at>30fps
6
• Up to 150m2 size of operation
• Voltage input: 12VDC
• Wireless Range: 100m line of sight
• Wireless Frequency: 433MHz
LA-5597
109
FROM
3995
$
Mount on the roof to directly control your household appliances. Will learn
your appliances infrared remote command and repeat them
when matched with a home automation input device.
$
$
NEW!
Wireless Infrared Controller
NEW!
Day/Night Wi-Fi IP Cameras
54 Silicon Chip
39
• Adjustable light setting
• Voltage Input: 12VDC
• Wireless Range: 100m line of sight
• Wireless Frequency: 433MHz
LA-5598
NEW!
LA-5155 $19.95
LA-5157 $49.95
LA-5158 $39.95
• 1m alloy security cable
• Requires 4 x AA Alkaline batteries
• Size: 273(L) x 190(W) x 51(H)mm
HB-5457 WAS $99
• Voltage input: 240VAC
NEW!
• Wireless Range: 100m line of sight
• Wireless Frequency: 433MHz
$
95
LA-5594
Also available:
12VDC Switch Controller Module
LA-5595 $59.95
240VAC Mains Light Dimmer Module LA-5596 $39.95
*Note: A licensed electrician is highly recommended to
hard wire this device into 240V mains wiring.
Interfaces with the home Automation System to
turn an output device on or off.
Works as an audible and visual deterrent, the siren produces a
wailing 94dB of output and a powerful strobe when alarm is
activated. Supplied with 240VAC mains power adaptor.
Pan/Tilt Model
Outdoor Model
Designed to be hard wired to your GPO, wall switches
or other mains device, it enable you to remotely
activate any mains appliances.
Wireless Light Sensor Module
Wireless Bell Box
Features Wi-Fi and
wired connectivity,
easy setup and
configuration
options, and motion
alarm detection.
Remote viewing
and control via
web browser or
Smartphone App.
240VAC Mains Switch Controller Module
SAVE $20.95
QC-3736 $84.95
QC-3737 $44.95
Value for money DVR with 500GB HDD. Records up to
full 960H or D1 resolution at 25 frames per second on
each channel. Recording can be triggered manually, by
timer, alarm input, or motion. Just add cameras to record
and view.
• H.264 video compression
• Remote viewing via Smartphone App
QV-3037
$
499
Camera to suit QC-8634 $149
Wireless FM Intercom
Perfect for communicating around your home or office.
Built-in monitor function. Mains powered and
transmits through house electrical wiring.
• 2 channels
• Sold as a pair
AI-5500
7495
$
GPS/GSM Tracking Device
Locate and track the whereabouts of your vehicle in real
time via the Internet on a computer or Smartphone. It works
by sending the vehicle's GPS coordinates via the GSM
network (Sim card not included) to the free online tracking
service, which shows the location on Google Maps.
• Built-in GSM & GPS antenna
• Features remote engine
immobilisation, SOS/panic alerts,
over speed or area detection alerts
• Very low 1 to 2mA standby current
• Size: 68(L) x 48(W) x 20(D)mm
LA-9011
149
$
siliconchip.com.au
www.jaycar.com.au
Savings off original RRP. Limited stock on sale items
HOME TECH
3G SDI & HDMI Converters
4 Input HDMI Switcher
with Audio Return
Allows HDMI equipped TVs and
PC monitors to playback
uncompressed 2.970Gbps
digital footage from
cameras supporting this
format. Provides an alternative
way to transmit HDMI over long distances.
• Size: 80(L) x 43(W) x 23(H)mm
3G SDI to HDMI Converter
AC-1727 $99.95
HDMI to 3G SDI Converter
AC-1729 $99.95
Switch between four HDMI sources to one HDMI
equipped display. Features ARC to allow audio
siginals to be returned
from the TV display to
sound system.
NEW!
9995ea
$
119
HDMI Audio Extractor
Extracts the audio from HDMI
and outputs to a 3.5mm
socket or S/PDIF, allowing
you to connect audio to a
better sounding system.
Comes with a 3.5mm to
RCA audio cable.
• Supports video up to 4K x 2K,
audio up to 5.1CH digital
• HDMI 1.4 compliant, HDCP
support
• Size: 61(L) x 54(H) x 20(H)mm
AC-1741
NEW!
$
79
95
Composite AV Cat5 Balun
with IR Receiver
Transmit crystal-clear
audio and video
signals over long
distances via
economical Cat 5
cable. You can also use it
for extending the range of your
remote control. The signals can
be transmitted up to 300 metres
on UTP.
• Inputs: 4 x HDMI
• Outputs:HDMI, TOSLINK, 3.5mm stereo
• Supported resolution: Up to 4k x 2k / 3D TV
support / 1080p / 1080i / 720p / 720i
• Digital Audio Support
NEW!
• Dolby TrueHD
• DTS-HD Master Audio 7.1CH
$
• Size: 191(L) x 83(W) x 25(H)mm
AC-1709
Also available:
4 x 2 HDMI Switcher/Splitter with UHD 4k
Support AC-1714 $119
VGA & R/L Audio to HDMI
Scaler Converter
89
$
Convert digital audio sources
that use Dolby Digital AC3
Pro logic, DTS, PCM or other
formats into 2.0 channel
analogue audio output. A
convenient turnkey solution for
audio connectivity differences.
HDMI Converter Leads
DVI-D Plug to
HDMI Plug
$
2495
Mini DVI Plug to
HDMI Socket
• 300mm long
WQ-7423
2495
$
Interchangeable 3.5mm and
TOSLINK Fibre Optic Lead
99
$
• 2m long
WQ-7299
1495
$
Also available:
Standard mini-TOSLINK to 3.5mm
Lead, 1m long WQ-7298 $9.95
Control multiple DMX devices, such as lights,
dimmers, fog machines or laser shows with
preprogrammed scenes such as fade,
pan, strobe, colour etc. Rackmountable and mains powered.
• Control up to 12 devices
• 16 channels per device
$
• 9V plugpack included
• Size: 482(W) x 133(H) x 70(D)mm
SL-3429
Also available:
5 Channel DMX Controller SL-3423 $89.95
5 Channel 94 LED Par Light SL-3424 $99
149
349
SAVE $50
DEAL
Buy SL-3429 or SL-3423 &
Get 20% OFF SL-3424
Ultra Slim LED/LCD Wall Mounts
Ultra thin wall brackets to mount your LED/LCD TVs for optimal viewing experience.
Heavy duty steel construction. Mounting hardware and instructions included.
LCD Monitor Wall Brackets
Get your TV into the best viewing position. Both models compatible
with VESA mounting.
Single Arm
• Max weight: 5kg
• Swivel: 120˚ left & right
• Tilt angle: 20˚ up and down
CW-2814 $39.95
Ramp not included
siliconchip.com.au
189
19" Rack Mount DMX Controller
This stage lighting kit features 4 extremely thin LED
PAR lights with a stand extendable up to 1.8m, 3
modes of operation (DMX, Master/Slave and sound
activation), RGB colour mixing and advanced LED
technology. Each unit features 145 bright red, green
and blue LEDs PAR CAN. Includes a light and
stand carry bag plus a foot controller.
$
• Up to 1080p resolution
• IR repeater function
$
• Power supplies included
AC-1680
Also available:
Extra Receiver to Suit AC-1701 $79
Wall Plate TCP/IP Cat5e HDMI Extender
AC-1659 $129
A convenient multi-purpose lead featuring a
spring loaded dual connector which
allows you to flip between 3.5mm optical
plug and toslink optical.
• Inputs: 1 x TOSLINK/SPDIF, 1
x Coaxial
• Outputs: 2 x RCA (L/R), 1 x 3.5mm AUX
• Size: 72(L) x 55(W) x 20(H)mm
AC-1658
Multi-coloured LED
Party/Stage Lighting Kit
Double Arm
• Max weight: 22kg
• Swivel: 160˚ left & right
• Tilt angle: 5˚ up, 20˚ down
CW-2813 $69.95
99
AC3/DTS Digital to Analogue
Audio Converter
• Size: 64(W) x 73(D) x 29(H)mm
QC-3681
Spare IR Receiver AR-1819 $19.95
• DMX Channel: 13
• Mains powered
• Light carry bag:
700(L) x 390(W) x 200(H)mm
SL-3467 WAS $399
$
Utilises the TCP/IP protocol to extend a HDMI
source up to 100m away
over a common Cat5e/6
cable. Ideal for setting
up multiple displays
over long distances.
• 1.5m long
WQ-7407
Accepts both VGA and left/right
audio inputs for use with the
latest digital HD TV.
• HDMI resolution fixed to
1280x720p
• Size: 88(L) x 68(W) x 25(H)mm
AC-1617
TCP/IP Cat5e HDMI Extender
with IR Repeater
• Load capacity up to 25kg
• VESA standard compliant
Tilting Models:
• 15˚ of tilt
• 19mm mounting profile
CW-2836
CW-2852
For 23" - 55" TV CW-2836 $39.95
For 40" - 65" TV CW-2838 $49.95
$
FROM
3995
To order call 1800 022 888
CW-2813
Pan/Tilt/Swivel Model:
• 15˚ tilt/180˚ swivel
• 32mm mounting profile
• 642mm max extension
FROM
3995
$
For 32" - 55" TV CW-2852 $119
October 2014 55
www.jaycar.com.au
7
ARDUINO TECH
EtherMega with Ethernet
USBDroid with onboard
Android/USB Host
Just like an Arduino "Eleven"
but with a microSD slot,
USB port and built-in
charger. Specially
designed to be
compatible with
the Android Open
Accessory
Development Kit enabling
you to build your own
Android peripherals to
connect your phone to
$
whatever you like.
XC-4222
• 10/100base-T Ethernet
• 54 digital I/O lines
• 16 analogue inputs
XC-4256
6995
Also available:
4 Channel POE Injector
Mega Prototyping Shield
119
$
XC-4254 $26.95
XC-4257 $17.95
Large Dot Matrix
LED Display Panels
2495
$
Can shown
for comparison
This large, bright 512
LED matrix panel has
onboard controller
circuitry designed to
make it easy to use
straight from your
board.
• 32 x 16 high brightness
blue LEDs (512 LEDs total)
on a 10mm pitch
• Viewable over 12 metres away
• Compatible with Windows, Mac, and Linux
• Supplied with a USB cable and ISP
programming cable
XC-4237
FROM
3995
$
Red LED Display XC-4250 $39.95 (shown)
Blue LED Display XC-4251 $89.95
Security Sensor Shield
Allows up to 4 security
sensors to be
simultaneously connected to
an Arduino with full End-OfLine (EOL) support. Detects
a variety of events including
sensor triggered, housing
opened, cable cut and
short-circuited.
• Status LEDs on each
channel
• No surface mount
assembly required
XC-4217
A self-contained board with
onboard stepper motor drivers,
servo interface, microSD card
slot, and 20x4 character
LCD. Perfect for building
robots or other mechatronics
projects: just connect the
stepper motors and go!
Popular Arduino Displays
ICSP Programmer
Program new
applications into a
wide range of
microcontrollers
using this ICSP
programmer with
a USB interface.
Compatible with a wide
range of microcontrollers,
including all Arduino
boards.
StepDuino with
Onboard Stepper Motor
Features ATmega2560 MCU, onboard
Ethernet, a USB-serial converter, a microSD
card slot, Power-Over-Ethernet support
(use XC-4254, sold separately), and
an onboard switchmode
voltage regulator so it can
run up to 28VDC without
overheating.
Relay Driver Modules
27
Available in 2 models:
4 Channel Shield XC-4278 $13.95
8 Channel Shield XC-4276 $34.95
149
RGB LED 4x4x4 Cube Kit
This stunning 3D-matrix of 64
RGB LEDs incorporates an
onboard Arduino-compatible
controller. Create mesmerising
light shows or build your own
"ambient device" that gently
notifies you of new email or
instant messages. Some
assembly required.
• Individually addressable
8mm RGB LEDs
• 106mm x 130mm x 106mm
(assembled)
XC-4274
$
8995
Charge Li-Po cells from any USB source, USB
plugpack, laptop or PC.
• 3.7V output for a single Li-Po cell
• Micro-USB jack
• Size: 27(W) x 16(H) x 10(D)mm
XC-4243
• Drives relay coils of 5VDC to
24VDC
• Individual LED status display on
every output channel
95
$
USB Li-Po Charger
Easily drives relays and isolates
your microcontroller from the relay
coils using FETs, includes backEMF protection, and works with a
wide range of relays.
$
• 2 x 4-wire stepper motor
controllers
• 1 x servo interface
• Serial communications header
• Compatible with the Arduino IDE
• Size: 113(W) x 74(H) x 25(D)mm
XC-4249
FROM
1395
$
$
1295
YOUR LOCAL JAYCAR STORE - Free Call Orders: 1800 022 888
AUSTRALIAN CAPITAL TERRITORY
Belconnen
Fyshwick
Ph (02) 6253 5700
Ph (02) 6239 1801
NEW SOUTH WALES
Penrith
Port Macquarie
Rydalmere
Smithfield
Sydney City
Taren Point
Tuggerah
Tweed Heads
Wagga Wagga
Warners Bay
Wollongong
NEW
Ph (02) 4721 8337
Ph (02) 6581 4476
Ph (02) 8832 3120
Ph (02) 9604 7411
Ph (02) 9267 1614
Ph (02) 9531 7033
Ph (02) 4353 5016
Ph (07) 5524 6566
Ph (02) 6931 9333
Ph (02) 4954 8100
Ph (02) 4226 7089
Mackay
Maroochydore
Mermaid Beach
Nth Rockhampton
Townsville
Strathpine
Underwood
Woolloongabba
Ph (07) 4953 0611
Ph (07) 5479 3511
Ph (07) 5526 6722
Ph (07) 4926 4155
Ph (07) 4772 5022
Ph (07) 3889 6910
Ph (07) 3841 4888
Ph (07) 3393 0777
Albury
Ph (02) 6021 6788
Alexandria
Ph (02) 9699 4699
Bankstown
Ph (02) 9709 2822
Blacktown
Ph (02) 9678 9669
Bondi Junction
Ph (02) 9369 3899
SOUTH AUSTRALIA
Brookvale
Ph (02) 9905 4130
Adelaide
Ph (08) 8231 7355
Campbelltown
Ph (02) 4625 0775
Clovelly Park
Ph (08) 8276 6901
NORTHERN TERRITORY
Castle Hill
Ph (02) 9634 4470
Elizabeth
Ph (08) 8255 6999
Darwin
Ph (08) 8948 4043
Coffs Harbour
Ph (02) 6651 5238
Gepps Cross
Ph (08) 8262 3200
Croydon
Ph (02) 9799 0402
Modbury
Ph (08) 8265 7611
QUEENSLAND
NEW Ph (02) 6881 8778
Dubbo
Aspley
Ph (07) 3863 0099
Reynella
Ph (08) 8387 3847
Erina
Ph (02) 4365 3433
Browns Plains
Ph (07) 3800 0877
TASMANIA
Fairy Meadow
NEW Ph (02) 4225 0969
Caboolture
Ph (07) 5432 3152
WE ARE
Hobart
Ph (03) 6272 9955
MOVING!
Gore Hill
Ph (02) 9439 4799
Cairns
Ph (07) 4041 6747
Launceston
Ph (03) 6334 2777
Hornsby
Ph (02) 9476 6221
Caloundra
Ph (07) 5491 1000
VICTORIA
Liverpool
Ph (02) 9821 3100
Capalaba
Ph (07) 3245 2014
Cheltenham
Ph (03) 9585 5011
Maitland
Ph (02) 4934 4911
Ipswich
Ph (07) 3282 5800
Newcastle
Ph (02) 4968 4722
Labrador
Ph (07) 5537 4295
Coburg
Ph (03) 9384 1811
Arrival dates of new products in this flyer were confirmed at the
HEAD OFFICE
ONLINE ORDERS
time of print but delays sometimes occur. Please ring your local
320 Victoria Road, Rydalmere NSW 2116
Website: www.jaycar.com.au
store to check stock details. Savings off Original RRP.
Prices valid from 24th September 2014 to 23rd October 2014.
Ph: (02) 8832 3100 Fax: (02) 8832 3169
Ferntree Gully
Frankston
Geelong
Hallam
Kew East
Melbourne City
Mornington
Ringwood
Roxburgh Park
Shepparton
Springvale
Sunshine
Thomastown
Werribee
Ph (03) 9758 5500
Ph (03) 9781 4100
Ph (03) 5221 5800
Ph (03) 9796 4577
Ph (03) 9859 6188
Ph (03) 9663 2030
Ph (03) 5976 1311
Ph (03) 9870 9053
Ph (03) 8339 2042
Ph (03) 5822 4037
Ph (03) 9547 1022
Ph (03) 9310 8066
Ph (03) 9465 3333
Ph (03) 9741 8951
WESTERN AUSTRALIA
Joondalup
Maddington
Mandurah
Midland
Northbridge
Osborne Park
Rockingham
OPENING
SOON!
Ph (08) 9301 0916
Ph (08) 9493 4300
Ph (08) 9586 3827
Ph (08) 9250 8200
Ph (08) 9328 8252
Ph (08) 9444 9250
Ph (08) 9592 8000
Email: techstore<at>jaycar.com.au
Occasionally
there are C
discontinued
items advertised on a special / lower price in this promotional flyer that has limited to nil stock in
56 Silicon
hip
certain stores, including Jaycar Authorised Stockist. These stores may not have stock of these items and can not order or transfer stock.
siliconchip.com.au
$UB$CRIBING
MAKE$
$EN$E...
because it saves you dollars!
If you regularly purchase SILICON CHIP over the counter from your newsagent, you can $ave more than 10% by
having it delivered to your mailbox. Simply take out a subscription – and instead of paying $9.95 per issue, you’ll
pay just $8.75 per issue (12 month subscription) – and we pay the postage!
How can we do this?
It’s all about economics. Printing enough copies to send out to newsagents, in the hope that they’ll sell, is very
wasteful (and costly!). When readers take out subscriptions, we know exactly how many copies we need to print
to satisfy that demand. That saves us money – so we pass the savings onto our subscribers. It really is that simple!
You REAP THE BENEFIT!
But wait, there’s more! Subscribers also automatically qualify for a 10% discount on any purchases made from
the SILICON CHIP online shop: books, printed circuit boards, specialised components, binders – anything except
subscriptions!
So why not take out a subscription?
You can choose from 6 months, 12 months or 24 months – and the longer you go, the bigger the savings.
You can choose the print edition, the online edition or both!
Most people still prefer a magazine they can hold in their hands. That’s a fact. But in this digital age, many
people like to be able to read SILICON CHIP online from wherever they are – anywhere in the world. That’s also
a fact. NOW YOU CAN – either or both. The on-line edition is exactly the same as the printed edition – even
the adverts are included. So you don’t miss out on anything with the on-line edition (flyers and catalogs
excepted).
OK, so how do you go about it?
It’s simple: you can order your subscription online, 24 hours a day (siliconchip.com.au/shop and follow the
prompts); you can send us an email with your subscription request and credit card details (silicon<at>siliconchip.
com.au), you can fax us the same information (02) 9939 2648 (international 612 9939 2648) or you can
phone us, Monday-Friday, 9am-4.30pm, on (02) 9939 3295 (international 612 9939 3295).
Don’t
put it off any longer: $TART $AVING TODAY with a SILICON CHIPOctober
subscription!
siliconchip.com.au
2014 57
Digital effects processor
for guitars & musical
instruments
By NICHOLAS VINEN
This deceptively simple unit provides 10 different musical
instrument effects, including echo, reverb, tremolo, fuzz,
compression, flanging and phasing. Each effect is adjustable
and can be defeated with a foot pedal switch. It’s designed for
use with electric guitars but will work with other instruments
and vocals too.
W
ANT TO SPICE up your guitar
performances? Build this Digital
Effects Processor into a guitar amplifier
and you will get many different effects
to play with, without needing to lug
around and wire up many different
effects pedals. It can apply the majority of common effects to a line-level
signal and you can adjust them to suit
your needs.
We can’t promise that this will
replace all your effects units but it
certainly gives a lot of different options
which suit a variety of instruments,
58 Silicon Chip
performers and musical styles. The
idea is to build it into a guitar amplifier
by connecting it between the preamplifier and amplifier sections. It can
be powered directly from an amplifier supply rail, assuming a suitable
DC voltage is available, or the supply
rail can be derived, creating one very
convenient package!
But it is not just intended for use
with guitars. It is suitable for use with
a large variety of other musical instruments, whether they are keyboards or
instruments with pickups. And they
can be used to enhance vocals as well.
Basically, if you want to add some
pizazz to your performance, this Digital Effects Processor is a great way to
do it.
Digital effects
The available effects are shown in
Table 1. For each effect, there are two
parameters which can be set using potentiometers VR3 and VR4. Those parameters are also listed in the table and
described in the list of effects below.
Note that when one of the enabled
siliconchip.com.au
effects causes a reduction in signal
level (eg, echo or reverb), the level for
all effects is reduced, as well as the
level when no effect is selected, in
order to prevent noticeable changes in
signal when switching between them.
The available effects are as follows:
• Echo: delays and attenuates the
incoming signal, then mixes it back in
for the output. VR3 adjusts the delay
between (nearly) 0ms and 1200ms with
an exponential curve, to make it less
sensitive at the shorter end, which is
more useful. VR4 adjusts the amount of
attenuation; at higher settings, the echo
is louder. Note that as the echo becomes
louder, the original signal must become
quieter to prevent overload.
• Reverb: the same as echo, except
that many extra short echoes are added
to simulate reflections from multiple
hard surfaces in close proximity.
• Tremolo: the output volume is
modulated by a sinusoidal waveform.
VR3 adjusts the amount of modulation
(ie, ‘depth’) while VR4 changes the
frequency.
• Vibrato: the output frequency is
modulated by a sinusoidal waveform.
VR3 adjusts the amount of modulation
(ie, ‘depth’) while VR4 changes the
frequency. Note that this is performed
by slightly speeding up and slowing
down the audio signal although the
change in delay that this causes should
be imperceptible.
• Overdrive: this provides adjustable
clipping for the signal. VR3 adjusts the
gain applied to the signal and once the
amplitude is high enough, it clips. VR4
adjusts how progressively the clipping
occurs; at minimum setting it is hard,
resulting in a square wave while at
higher settings for VR4, the clipping
is more progressive and the waveform
becomes rounded.
• Fuzz: the same as overdrive except
that the gain is applied asymmetrically,
in order to inject extra distortion into
the signal.
• Compression: the gain is slowly
increased until the output reaches 90%
of maximum. If the output exceeds this
90% level, the gain is decreased. VR3
sets the rate of increase while VR4
sets the rate of decrease. The scale for
VR4 is different for VR3 as the rate of
decrease is normally much higher.
• Noise gate: similar to but not quite
the opposite of compression. When the
input signal is below the threshold,
there is no output. When the input
goes above the threshold, it is sent to
siliconchip.com.au
Features & Specifications
• 10 effects to choose from: Echo, Reverb, Tremolo, Vibrato, Overdrive, Fuzz,
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Compression, Noise Gate, Flanger and Phaser
Each effect has two adjustable parameters
Maximum echo/reverb delay: 1.2 seconds
Four-position switch selects between three effects and no effect with seamless
transitions
Optional defeat switch (eg, foot pedal)
Low noise and distortion: THD+N typically <0.02%, signal-to-noise ratio >76dB
Two power supply options: 3.5-6V DC or 7.5-12V DC; current drain 60-80mA
Optimal input signal range: 0.5-2V RMS
Line output signal: typically 1V RMS
Input impedance: 4-6kΩ
Optional headphone output
Optional microphone preamplifier
the output. VR3 adjusts the threshold
while VR4 adjusts the hysteresis, to
prevent the output from fluctuating on
and off with a signal near the threshold.
• Flanger: this mixes the input signal with a version of the signal that
has slight vibrato applied, causing a
distinctive ‘comb filter’ Doppler effect.
• Phaser: similar to flanger but mixes
the signal with a version that has a
modulated phase shift, causing a ‘rippling’ effect which makes the sound
seem artificial.
Modes
The effects are selected using a 4position rotary switch (a slide switch
could also be used). The second position selects no effect and the other
three positions can each select one of
the 10 effects listed above. We’ve made
the second position the ‘off’ position
to make it easy to switch between two
commonly used effects and none.
A pushbutton is used to change
which effect is selected by each switch
position and is also used when adjusting the two knobs, so that different
settings can be used for each effect and
they don’t have to be reset each time
a different effect is used.
The same effect can be used with
different settings for each switch position. If you don’t need three effects, the
switch can be limited to fewer positions. There is also a simple fall-back
mode available; if the pushbutton is
permanently shorted out (say, on the
PCB) then the three effects selected
by the rotary switch are always echo,
reverb and tremolo and VR3 & VR4
can be adjusted at any time.
A defeat switch (eg, a foot switch)
can be added and this has the same
effect as switching the rotary switch
to the ‘off’ position as long as it is held
down. Or you can wire it the other way
around, so that effects are only applied
when the switch is held down.
Options
This Digital Effects Processor uses
Table 1: Effects Controls
#
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
Effect
Echo
Reverb
Tremolo
Vibrato
Overdrive
Fuzz
Compression
Noise Gate
Flanger
Phaser
VR3
Echo Delay
Reverb Delay
Amplitude
Amplitude
Gain
Gain
Attack
Threshold
Amplitude
Amplitude
VR4
Echo Fall-Off
Reverb Fall-Off
Rate
Rate
Softness
Softness
Decay
Hysteresis
Rate
Rate
October 2014 59
4.7Ω
2x
100nF
2x
100 µF
1000 µF
MMC
14
8
20
1 µF MMC
19
1k
18
17
1nF
HPVdd AVdd
LLINEIN
2x
100 µF
10k
27
1
DBVdd DCVdd
21
MODE
9
LHPOUT
RLINEIN
LOUT
MICIN
12
10
RHPOUT
IC3
WM8731
13
25
XTI/MCLK
ROUT
CODEC
VR6
5k
26
7
6
1 µF
TO PIN 62, IC1
Rmic
MMC
2
1
OPTIONAL
MIC INPUT
2x
100nF
FB1
MMC
INPUT
CON1
+3.3V
3
MIC
680Ω
BIAS
CON9
2
X1
12MHz
MICBIAS
ADCLRC
DACDAT
ADCDAT
SCLK
BCLK
SDIN
CSB
CLKOUT
VMID HPGND AGND DGND
16
47k
220pF
33pF
33pF
5
DACLRC
XTO
15
11
4
24
23
22
28
100nF
22 µF
MMC
L1 100 µH
+3.3V
NO
100nF
S4
19
39
40
50
51
42
55
54
48
53
52
21
49
NC
DEFEAT SWITCH
DELAY
AUX4
(PIN 1, CON5)
POT1
VR3
10k
AUX1
DEPTH
VR4
10k
11
33
34
36
37
POT2
35
100nF
60
61
62
63
64
1
2
3
TO OPTIONAL
MIC INPUT
FB2
ANALOG
GND
DIGITAL
GND
56
26
10
AVdd
Vdd
CLKI/RC12
CLKO/RC15
SCK1/RD2
RPD3/RD3
RD8
RD7
RD6
RC14
PMRD/RD5
PMWR/RD4
AN8/RB8
AN24/RD1
VBUSON
USBID
VBUS
D–
D+
VUSB3V3
PMD0/RE0
PMD1/RE1
PMD2/RE2
PMD3/RE3
PMD4/RE4
PMD5/RE5
PMD6/RE6
PMD7/RE7
Vcap
10 µF
AVss
20
Vdd
57
38
Vdd
Vdd
MCLR
RF1
PGED2
PGEC2
RD0
RC13
RF0/RPF0
RD9/RPD9
RB4
RB3
RB2
RB1
IC1
PIC3 2 MX470- RB9/PMA7
PIC32MX470F512H RB10/PMA13
RB11/PMA12
RB12/PMA11
RB13/PMA10
RB14/PMA1
RB15/PMA0
RD11/PMA14
RD10/PMA15
RF5/PMA8
RF4/PMA9
RB0/PMA6
RG9/PMA2
RG8/PMA3
RG7/PMA4
RG6/PMA5
Vss
Vss
Vss
9
25
7
59
18
17
46
47
58
43
12
13
14
15
22
23
24
27
28
29
30
45
44
32
31
16
8
6
5
4
41
D2 1N4004
7.5 – 12V
DC INPUT
POWER
K
V+
D1 1N4004
A
K
REG1 LM317
3.3Ω
IN
S1
CON3
LED1
OUT
ADJ
10k
POWER
A
A
K
120Ω
A
1000 µF
λ
+3.3V
D3
1N4004
200Ω
100 µF
100 µF
K
SC
20 1 4
DIGITAL EFFECTS PROCESSOR
60 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
+3.3V
HEADPHONES
220 µF 10V
1
47k
2
3
220 µF 10V
CON8
47k
+3.3V
TO IC1
PIN 11
VR7
OPTIONAL STEREO HEADPHONE OUTPUT
OUTPUT
100Ω
1 µF MMC
CON2
47k
+3.3V
4x
100nF
10k
ICSP
SKT
1
2
3
PGED
4
PGEC
5
CON7
S2
CHANGE
EFFECT
1
AUX4
2
SDO
NOT MOUNTED ON PCB
3
SCK
4
V+
D4 & D5
1N4148
5
+5V
6
+3.3V
7
EFF. 3
PGED 8
EFFECT 2
AUX1
S3
MODE
OFF
PGEC 9
10
EFFECT 1
CON5
EXPANSION SOCKET
LED1
1N4004
A
K
A
K
LM317T
1N4148
A
K
siliconchip.com.au
OUT
ADJ
OUT
IN
Fig.1: the basic Digital Effects
Processor circuit. The incoming audio
analog signal at CON1 is digitised by
CODEC IC2 and then fed to IC1 where
it is processed and then sent back
across the same digital audio bus to
IC2. A DAC in IC3 then converts it
back into an analog signal which is
fed to the output (CON2).
the same hardware as the Stereo Echo
& Reverb Unit (February 2014) and the
Dual Channel Audio Delay (November
2013). However, we have removed a
number of components which aren’t
needed. For example, most musical
instruments are not stereo so components are only fitted for one channel
(and indeed, the software only supports one channel).
As with those earlier designs, it is
possible to add extra components to
provide a microphone input or stereo
headphone output. The processed
mono signal is sent simultaneously
to both headphone output channels.
The headphone output could be
useful for monitoring purposes. It’s up
to you whether you want to install the
few extra components required which
are shown in the circuit diagram at
upper-right and on the overlay diagram, labelled in green.
The microphone input is less useful as its signal-to-noise ratio is only
average. For a musical performance,
you would be better off using an external microphone preamplifier such
as our High-Performance Microphone
Preamplifier from the September 2010
issue, which can run from the same DC
voltage source as the Digital Effects
Processor unit.
Software
In adding these new effects to the
software, we have made some other
changes at the same time. By making
it process only a mono signal, this doubles the maximum echo to 1.2 seconds
without needing an external RAM
chip. This is more than long enough for
instrumental work and so we haven’t
even bothered to provide the option
of extra RAM in the software.
We’ve also gone to some effort to
make changes between effects and
changes in effect settings ‘seamless’ so
that clicks and pops are not generated
during a performance, even if settings
such as echo delay are adjusted live.
Circuit description
The circuit diagram of the Digital
Effects Processor is shown in Fig.1. As
stated earlier, this is a simplified version of the circuit for the Stereo Echo &
Reverberation Unit from the February
2014 issue, with unnecessary components removed. That’s why there are
so many unconnected pins on IC1;
those originally used for interfacing
with the unused SRAM chip and USB
socket are not connected to anything.
A line level signal, from a guitar
preamp, mic preamp etc, is fed into
CON1 (connector tip). RF signals that
may have been picked up are rejected
by a low-pass filter comprising a 1kΩ
series resistor and 1nF capacitor to
ground, while 5kΩ trimpot VR6 is used
to reduce the level to no more than
1V RMS, the limit of what the CODEC
can handle.
The signal is then AC-coupled to
the right channel input of the CODEC
(IC3) via a 1µF DC-blocking capacitor.
A half-supply (~1.65V) DC bias for this
input is provided by the IC itself
Alternatively, a microphone signal
can be applied to a 3.5mm jack socket
connected to pin header CON9 and
this is coupled to IC3’s microphone
input pin (pin 18) via a 1µF capacitor
and optional series resistor (Rmic)
which reduces the amount of gain if
fitted; otherwise it is linked out. IC3
can supply a bias current for electret
microphones, and this is fed via a 680Ω
series resistor. The associated 220pF
capacitor provides some RF filtering
for the microphone signal.
The microphone input is selected
when the RE2 input of IC1 (pin 62)
is pulled low. This is wired to the
microphone socket so that the sleeve
of the mono jack plug shorts it to
ground when it is inserted. When this
line is open-circuit, the line input is
the active input. If the microphone
input is not needed, the components
in the pink box at left do not need to
be installed.
CODEC operation
Whichever signal is selected, it is
digitised by IC3 with a sampling rate of
around 40kHz and the resulting PCM
digital audio signal is transmitted to
PIC32 microcontroller IC1 via an I2S
bus. This appears at pins 3, 5 & 6 of IC3
which are the serial bit clock, sample
clock and serial data line respectively.
These connect to the audio CODEC
compatible SPI peripheral in IC1.
IC1 reads the digital audio data from
the CODEC, processes it to add the seOctober 2014 61
Fig.2: follow this layout diagram to build
the PCB and complete the wiring. The parts
labelled in blue & green are for the optional
microphone and headphone features.
VR7
HEADPHONE
VOLUME
S
HEADPHONE
OUTPUT
T
R
LED1
POWER
OUTPUT
100Ω
100 µF
1nF
10k
3.3Ω
1nF
CON7
ICSP
+
10 µF
100nF
4
1000 µF
100 µF
EFFECT 1
2
1
D4
A
5
6
S3
1k
CON1
+
48
120Ω
200Ω
OFF
EFFECT 2 3
100 µF
1
PIC32MX470F
1
D2
4004
48
IC1
D3
4004
10k
100nF
100nF
100nF
100nF
D1
41
1 µF
33pF
+
22 µF
5
L1
100nF
100nF
100 µH
100nF
+
1000 µF
CON2
100nF
100 µF
+
X1
10k
220 µF
FB2
33pF
1 µF
+
100 µF
+
4.7Ω
100nF
220 µF
47k
47k
47k
R
PHONES
CON8
100 µF+
REG1
LM317
+
+
+
GND
1 µF
FB1
L
POWER
01110131
Stereo Audio Delay/
DSP Board 24bit/96kHz
41
DEPTH
S1
4004
DELAY
K A
S2
DEFEAT
IC3
WM8731L
MIC
CON9
VR4
0Ω
47k
+
220pF
680Ω
CON5
VR3
S2
CHANGE EFFECT
7
8
12
11
D5
10
9
CON3 DC
7.5 –12V
INPUT
VR6
5k
T
R
R
S
T
S
MICROPHONE
INPUT
lected effect (depending on the mode)
and also stores it within its 128KB
RAM, for the echo and reverb effects.
Processed audio data is sent back over
the same I2S bus, this time to pin 4 of
IC3 but timed using the same clock
lines. The CODEC then converts this
digital stream back to analog audio data
which it transmits from its line out (pin
13) and headphone out (pins 9 & 10).
These signals are all AC-coupled
to the respective output connectors,
to remove the 1.65V DC bias, via a
1µF capacitor for the line output and
220µF capacitors for the headphone
outputs. The reason the headphone
output needs much larger capacitors is
that the headphones will have a much
lower impedance than the line input
of other equipment; 8-600Ω for headphones compared to several kilohms
for a line input.
The line output also includes a 100Ω
series resistor, both to prevent cable
capacitance from causing instability in
62 Silicon Chip
TO FOOT
SWITCH
the output drivers of IC3 and to protect
IC3 against a shorted output.
IC3 also contains a digital volume
control which adjusts the headphone
amplifier output. If VR7 is fitted to
the board, IC1 detects this and sends
commands to IC3 so set the headphone
volume depending on the voltage at
VR7’s wiper. If VR7 is not fitted, the
headphone outputs are disabled and
in that case, the other components in
the pink box may be omitted.
Controls & power supply
Pots VR3 and VR4 are used to change
the effect parameters. These form voltage dividers across the 3.3V supply
rail and the wiper voltage is read by
IC1 using its internal analog-to-digital
converter (ADC).
The power supply is quite simple.
D1 provides reverse polarity protection
while REG1 drops the incoming 7.512V rail to a regulated 3.3V, as required
by IC1 & IC3. LED1 indicates when
power is applied. IC1 and IC3 have
100nF bypass capacitors for each pair
of supply pins, plus a 10µF capacitor
for IC1’s internal core regulator (on
pin 56, Vcap).
CODEC IC3 also has 100µF bypass
capacitors for each supply pin to
ensure a low supply impedance and
thus good performance. Its analog and
digital grounds are separated by ferrite
bead FB2 to minimise digital noise
coupled into the analog ground, where
it could otherwise reach signal paths.
A 4.7Ω series resistor also provides
audio-frequency low-pass filtering
for the analog supply, in conjunction
with the 1200µF of capacitance on the
analog supply rail (ie, 1000µF plus 2
x 100µF).
5V operation
As with the Echo & Reverb unit,
you can change some components to
operate the unit from a 5V supply such
as is available from a USB port. This
siliconchip.com.au
right-handed, it’s easiest to start with
the top pad on the right side or if lefthanded, with the top pad on the left
side. Avoid getting any solder on the
adjacent pad.
Now, pick up the part with a finetipped pair of angled tweezers and
while heating this pad, gently slide the
IC into place. Check the part’s alignment under a magnifying lamp. All the
pins must be centred fairly accurately
over their respective pads.
If they aren’t, don’t panic, it’s just a
matter of re-melting the solder on that
one joint and carefully nudging the
IC in the required direction, then reinspecting it. It may take a few attempts
to get it correct. Care and patience are
a virtue here, the goal being to eventually get it properly aligned without
spreading solder onto any more pins
or pads and without heating the PCB
or IC enough to damage them.
Once the part is in place, solder the
diagonally opposite pin, then re-check
the alignment under magnification as it
may have moved slightly. If it has, you
can reheat this second pad and gently
twist the IC back into alignment. Once
you’re happy, proceed to solder the
remaining pins without worrying too
much about bridging them (it’s hard to
avoid). Remember to refresh that first
pin you soldered.
Now spread a thin layer of flux
paste along all the pins and gently
press down on them with solder wick
and a hot iron to suck up the excess
solder. If done correctly, this will leave
you with neatly soldered pins and no
solder bridges. Go over all the pins
once with the solder wick, then check
under a magnifier for any remaining
bridges. If there are any, add a dab of
flux paste and go back over them with
the solder wick.
With all the joints looking good, you
can install the other SMD IC using the
same procedure. Note that a hot-air
This photo shows the completed PCB with the
rotary Mode switch (S3) and the Change Effect
switch (S2) wired to CON5.
arrangement is shown in Fig.3. Basically, REG1 and its associated components are deleted and an LM3940
low-dropout 3.3V linear regulator is
substituted. This is necessary because
the LM317 used for higher voltage supplies drops too much voltage and can’t
operate from 5V. Also D1 is replaced
with a 1N5819 Schottky diode which
has a much lower forward voltage.
Construction
Fig.2 shows the parts layout on
the PCB (code 01110131). If building
the 5V-powered version, refer also to
Fig.4 for the necessary changes to fit
the different regulator and Schottky
diode (D1).
Start by fitting SMDs IC1 and IC3
(IC2 is left out). In each case, place
the IC alongside its pads, right-side up
and identify pin 1 (there should be a
depression in one corner but magnification may be required to spot it). A
pin 1 dot is also shown on the overlay
diagram and PCB.
Apply a very small amount of solder
to one of the corner pads. If you are
Table 1: Resistor Colour Codes
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
o
siliconchip.com.au
No.
1
5
1
1
1
1
1
1
Value
47kΩ
10kΩ
1kΩ
200Ω
120Ω
100Ω
4.7Ω
3.3Ω
4-Band Code (1%)
yellow violet orange brown
brown black orange brown
brown black red brown
red black brown brown
brown red brown brown
brown black brown brown
yellow violet gold brown
orange orange gold brown
5-Band Code (1%)
yellow violet black red brown
brown black black red brown
brown black black brown brown
red black black black brown
brown red black black brown
brown black black black brown
yellow violet black silver brown
orange orange black silver brown
October 2014 63
4-6V
DC INPUT
POWER
V+
D1 1N5819
A
REG3 LM3940IT-3.3
3.3Ω
K
IN
S1
CON3
GND
10k
POWER
LED1
+3.3V
OUT
A
470 µF
100 µF
λ
LED1
K
K
SC
20 1 4
A
Through-hole parts
K
A
1N5819
DIGITAL EFFECTS PROCESSOR
5V POWER SUPPLY OPTION
LM3940
GND
IN
GND
OUT
Fig.3: the unit can be powered from a 4-6V DC supply by replacing REG1
with an LM3940IT-3.3 low-dropout regulator and changing D1 to a 1N5819.
gun/toaster oven and solder paste can
also be used for these ICs.
Once you’ve checked that the ICs
are all soldered properly, follow with
the SMD ceramic capacitors, using a
similar procedure; ie, add solder to one
pad, heat and slide the part into place,
then solder the other pad and refresh
the initial joint. Don’t get the 10µF
capacitor mixed up with the others.
especially if solder has taken to the
other pad too.
So take it slowly and be careful not
to short any of the adjacent IC pins
when soldering the pads; the capacitors have been placed quite close for
performance reasons. A fine soldering
iron tip will make this easier.
You do need to be careful to wait
about 10 seconds after soldering one
side of a capacitor before applying
solder to the other side though. The
capacitors are so small that the solder
joint can remain molten for quite some
time. If you try to solder the opposite
pad too early, the capacitor will move
out of alignment and it’s frustrating to
re-align capacitors when this happens,
Proceed now with the low-profile
components such as resistors and
diodes – remember to slip a ferrite
bead over the 4.7Ω resistor lead before
soldering it in place. It’s best to check
each resistor value with a DMM before
fitting it, as the colour bands can be
difficult to read. The diodes are all the
same type and all have their cathode
bands facing to the top or right edge
of the board.
For FB2, slip another bead over a
resistor lead off-cut and then solder it
to the board. You can also mount axial
inductor L1 at this point. Then fit REG1
or REG3 (depending on supply voltage); bend its leads down about 6mm
from its body, feed them through the
holes, screw its tab to the PCB tightly
Parts List
1 double-sided PCB, coded
01110131, 148 x 80mm
1 12MHz HC-49 crystal (X1)
1 100µH axial RF inductor (L1)
2 10kΩ 9mm horizontal potentiometer (VR3,VR4)
1 5kΩ mini horizontal trimpot (VR6)
2 6.35mm PCB-mount stereo switched jack sockets
(CON1,CON2) (Jaycar PS0195,
Altronics P0099 or P0073)
1 10-way pin header, 2.54mm pitch
(CON5)
1 5-way pin header, 2.54mm pitch
(CON7) (optional)
1 PCB-mount SPDT right-angle toggle switch (S1) (Altronics S1320)
1 chassis-mount NO momentary
pushbutton switch (S2)
1 4-position rotary or slide switch
(S3)
1 3-way pin header, 2.54mm pitch
(for S4)
1 foot switch with cable (S4, optional)
1 DC plugpack, 7.5-12V, 100mA+
1 PCB-mount switched DC socket
to suit plugpack
2 4mm ferrite suppression beads
64 Silicon Chip
9 M3 x 6mm machine screws
1 M3 nut
4 tapped spacers
1 metal case (optional)
Light duty hook-up wire/ribbon cable
Resistors (0.25W, 1%)
1 47kΩ
1 120Ω
5 10kΩ
1 100Ω
1 1kΩ
1 4.7Ω 0.5W 5%
1 200Ω
1 3.3Ω 0.5W 5%
Semiconductors
1 PIC32MX470F512H-I/PT 32-bit
microcontroller programmed with
0120914A.hex (IC1) (available
from SILICON CHIP Online Shop)
1 WM8731SEDS 24-bit 96kHz
stereo CODEC (IC3) (element14
1776264)
3 1N4004 diodes (D1-D3)
2 1N4148 diodes (D4,D5)
1 LM317T adjustable regulator
(REG1) (refer to text for parts
required for 5V DC operation)
1 3mm blue LED (LED1)
Extra parts for headphone output
Capacitors
2 1000µF 25V electrolytic
6 100µF 16V electrolytic
1 22µF 16V electrolytic
1 10µF 6.3V 0805 SMD ceramic
1 1µF 50V monolithic ceramic
11 100nF 6.3V 0805 SMD ceramic
1 1nF MKT
2 33pF ceramic disc
1 panel-mount stereo jack socket
1 10kΩ linear potentiometer, panel
mount (VR7)
1 small knob to suit
2 220µF 10V electrolytic capacitors
2 47kΩ 0.25W resistors
1 3-way pin header
1 100mm length 2-core shielded
cable or 3-strand ribbon cable
1 100mm length 3-strand ribbon
cable
Extra parts for microphone input
1 3.5mm panel-mount stereo
jack socket
1 1µF multi-layer ceramic
capacitor
1 220pF ceramic capacitor
1 47kΩ 0.25W resistor
1 680Ω 0.25W resistor
1 2-way pin header
1 length shielded cable
1 length light-duty hookup wire
siliconchip.com.au
5819
10k
3.3Ω
1
100nF
10k
100nF
100nF
1 µF
10k
IC3
WM8731L
47k
100nF
0Ω
47k
47k
47k
+
GND
680Ω
and then solder and trim the leads.
Horizontal trimpot VR6 can go in
LED1
next, followed by the ceramic capaciPOWER
K A
S1
tors (disc and monolithic multilayer)
VR3
VR4
and then pin headers CON5 and CON7,
POWER
DEFEAT
DELAY 2
plus the one for S4. You willDELAY
also1
01110131
have to fit CON8/CON9 if you are usStereo Audio Delay/
220pF
ing those optional features.
Note that
+
DSP Board 24bit/96kHz
1 µF
D1
CON7 is not required if you have a
MIC
100 µF+
FB1
100
µ
F
pre-programmed microcontroller.
33pF
+
100 µH
4.7Ω
X1
+
Now solder the DC socket
in
place,
220 µF
L1
L
FB2
100nF
followed by VR3 and VR4. Note that
100nF
100nF
33pF
100 µF
+
+
100nF
you could mount all these components
1
+
IC1
off-board (eg, chassis mount
them) and
R
CON7
+
PIC32MX470F
PHONES
ICSP
µF 1000 µF
run them back to the pads via220
flying
100nF
22 µF
leads, if that suits your application.
1 µF 100 µF
1nF
1nF
10 µF
Link
Link
This would be the way to fit the unit
100nF
into a guitar amplifier, for example.
1k
470 µF
REG3
CON2the
CON1
CON3 DC
You can then fit crystal X1 and
LM3940IT-3.3
4-6V
electrolytic capacitors, of which there
OUTPUT
INPUT
+
are three different values (four, if using
VR6
5k
the headphone outputs). As usual, the
100 µF
longer lead is positive and this should
ALTERNATIVE SUPPLY ARRANGEMENT FOR 4-6V DC
go in the hole marked with the ‘+’
symbol on the overlay, ie, towards the Fig.4: follow this PCB parts layout diagram to install the parts for the 5V power
top edge of the board.
supply option. Note that D1 must be changed to a 1N5819 Schottky type.
Next, fit power switch S1 and the
power LED. The latter should have programming the chip. Use the firm- of amplifier. You should hear clear,
its lead bent at right angles 4mm from ware for the Digital Effects Processor undistorted audio with no effects. You
the base of the lens and then soldered which is named “0120914A.hex”.
can then try out the effects to check
so that the centre of the lens (and thus
If you don’t have a PICkit3, you that they operate as expected.
this short lead section) is 6.5mm above will need to power the unit from a
the top surface of the PCB. This aligns DC plugpack for testing. In this case, Using effects
the centre LED with the centre of the connect a voltmeter across the 3.3Ω
Initially, the effect for switch posiswitch. When bending the leads, pay resistor next to D1. Small alligator clip tion #1 is echo, position #3 is reverb
attention to the “A” and “K” mark- leads (or other test probe clips) are and position #4 is tremolo, so you
ings on the PCB as the longer (anode) very useful for this purpose as you can can easily try these out. To adjust the
lead of LED1 must be soldered to the switch the unit on while watching the parameters, hold down S2 and then roanode pad.
meter reading and switch it off quickly tate VR3 and/or VR4. Once you release
S1 and the power LED could also be should the voltage across this resistor S2, turning VR3 and VR4 will have no
chassis-mounted if you wish.
rise too high.
effect, so you can’t accidentally change
The PCB assembly can now be comExpect a reading in the range of the settings.
pleted by soldering jack sockets CON1 0.2-0.3V, depending on the exact
To assign a different effect to one
and CON2 in place. You will also need resistor value and how you have con- of these switch positions, select that
to wire up a rotary or slide switch (S3) figured the unit. Much less than 0.2V position and then give S2 a brief press
and a momentary pushbutton switch indicates that there is an open circuit without turning either VR3 or VR4.
(S2) to a pin header socket, as shown somewhere while much more than The unit will switch to the next effect
in Fig.2.
0.3V indicates a likely short circuit. and will emit a series of ‘pips’ from
If using the foot (defeat) switch, If the reading is outside the expected the audio output; one pip for effect #1
headphone or microphone options, range, switch off immediately and (echo), two for effect #2 (reverb) and
wire them up too. We’ve shown the check for faults.
so on. If you press S2 when effect #10
foot switch connected via a 3.5mm
The most likely faults would be pins (phaser) is selected, it will switch back
phono socket but you could use a on the SMD chips bridged to an adja- to #1 (echo).
6.35mm socket or some other connec- cent pin or not properly soldered to the
The settings are remembered even
tor instead.
PCB pad, followed by incorrect device when power is removed; they’re stored
orientation (primarily ICs, diodes and in flash memory. If you press S2 in
Checking it out
electrolytic capacitors) or poor/bridged order to adjust VR3/VR4 and then
If you used a blank PIC32 chip, through-hole solder joints.
decide against it, hold S2 down for
program it now. The circuit can be
Assuming all is OK, connect S3, set a short period before releasing it to
powered from a PICkit3 at 3.3V. In fact it to position 2 (no effect) and feed a prevent an undesired change in the
the whole unit will operate normally signal into the input; if it’s a stereo selected effect. Any press longer than
from this supply so you can test the plug, the left channel will be shorted about half a second will not cause the
SC
audio signal path immediately after out. Connect the output to some sort selected effect to change.
100Ω
+
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 65
Passive
Direct
Injection
(DI) Box
Add this vital piece of equipment to
your musician’s or roadie’s toolbox
Hum and noise plaguing your performance?
A DI box that converts unbalanced signals
from a musical instrument into a balanced
output signal is the answer. This Passive
DI Box performs as well as a powered unit
in many applications and doesn’t require
batteries.
By JOHN CLARKE
D
IRECT INJECTION BOXES are
used to connect musical instruments into a sound system, whether
they are electric, electronic or fitted
with a microphone. Many such instruments have a 6.35mm (1/4-inch) ‘jack’
output socket whereas a PA system or
mixing board will typically have XLR
inputs. The term ‘Direct Injection’ (DI)
refers to a physical (wired) connection,
rather than using a microphone to pick
up the instrument’s sound output.
A cable with different connectors on
the ends won’t do the job; a DI Box is
required to convert the signal from the
musical instrument so that it’s suitable
to feed to a sound system. Specifically,
66 Silicon Chip
the unbalanced signal from the instrument must be converted to a balanced
signal for the sound system, to avoid an
inordinate amount of hum injection.
Commercial passive DI boxes can be
heavy and bulky and many units have
extruded finned aluminium heatsinkstyle cases. This SILICON CHIP DI Box is
compact, looks and sound good, and
requires no external power or batteries.
Balanced signals
A DI box is usually connected to a
musical instrument via a relatively
short lead. That’s because an unbalanced input is not as good at rejecting
hum pick-up as the balanced output on
Main Features
• Suitable for use with powered
instruments
• No battery or power supply
required
• Compact size and rugged
construction
• Balanced XLR output
• 6.35mm jack socket for mono
input
• 3.5mm jack socket for stereo
input (mixed to mono)
• 20Hz-20kHz frequency response
• Ground lift switch
Note: not suitable for direct connection to high-impedance stringed
instrument pick-ups.
the DI box. A balanced output lead can
be quite long and is typically run to a
remote sound system (eg, an amplifier
or mixer).
A balanced cable has good hum
rejection because it has two signal conductors, one with the original signal
and the other with an inverted version
of the same signal. These conductors
are normally twisted together and any
hum pick-up (or other interference)
should be coupled into both conductors almost equally. At the far end,
the signals from the two conductors
are subtracted, which reinforces the
original signal but cancels out any
extraneous signals which may have
siliconchip.com.au
been picked up along the way.
Converting between unbalanced and
balanced signals can be done using either electronic circuitry in an Active DI
Box or by using a transformer in a Passive DI Box. Active DI boxes have the
advantage that their input impedance
can be very high (over 1MΩ), making
them suitable for the pick-ups used
in guitars, violins and other stringed
instruments. Their disadvantage is that
if powered from a battery, the battery
ultimately goes flat, causing distortion
in the sound. And they often stop working at the most crucial time – right in
the middle of a session!
This Passive DI Box does not need
power and can be relied on to perform
faultlessly with no maintenance. It
does not have such a high input impedance but it is suitable for many
instruments that have a low output
impedance. This includes electronic
keyboards, computer audio outputs
and A/V system sound outputs. In
the case of stringed instruments, it
is increasingly common for these to
include an in-built preamplifier for
the pick-up and this can easily drive
a Passive DI Box.
Another feature of a DI Box is that
it provides impedance matching and
has a reasonably high input impedance
that’s suitable for powered instrument
signals. The output impedance of the
DI box is much lower, at 600Ω or less,
and this is better for driving balanced
leads. A lower output impedance
further reduces the effects of hum and
noise pick-up.
Hum loops
As with any sound system, the way
that the cable shielding is grounded
can have a huge impact on the amount
of hum induced in the leads and in the
sound output.
Unbalanced leads need to have the
shield earthed to minimise the hum
pick-up. That normally means that
in a DI Box, the shield of the unbalanced lead will be connected to the
shield of the balanced lead which is
ultimately grounded at the mixer (or
sound system, etc).
However, some unbalanced leads
are already grounded at the signal
source and so this connection will produce an earth loop due to circulating
currents in the shield wire, thus injecting hum. As a result, many DI Boxes
include a ‘ground lift’ switch. This is
used to disconnect the two shields
siliconchip.com.au
MONO IN
RING
TIP
CON1
6.35mm STEREO
JACK SOCKET
T1
YELLOW
SLEEVE
RED
10k
600Ω
BLK
2
3
GREEN
BLUE
STEREO IN
RING
SC
20 1 4
SHELL
2x 2.2k
TIP
CON2
3.5mm STEREO
JACK SOCKET
1
XLR MALE
CONNECTOR
(PIN VIEW)
CON3
GROUND LIFT
S1
CHASSIS
SLEEVE
PASSIVE DIRECT INJECTION (DI) BOX
Fig.1: the circuit uses just two input jack sockets (one for mono signals and
one for stereo), a 10kΩ:600Ω transformer, an XLR output connector and a
rocker switch to provide ground lift. No power supply is required.
when they are separately earthed.
DI Boxes can carry very low signal
levels and in use, are often surrounded
by many other leads. Some of these
nearby leads will likely carry mains
power. Thus, a DI Box must be well
shielded from 50Hz fields. It must also
be robust as it will typically be on the
floor and is liable to be trodden on,
kicked or tripped over.
Connectors
Our Passive DI (Direct Injection) Box
is built into a metal diecast case with
both 6.35mm and 3.5mm jack sockets
at one end and a male XLR connector
at the other. The input impedance
is 10kΩ for the 6.35mm jack socket
and about 3kΩ for each input of the
3.5mm socket. This is sufficiently
high for virtually all powered instruments. That includes keyboards and
stringed instruments such as guitars
that have an internal preamplifier. It is
not suitable for high impedance pickups unless these are connected via a
preamplifier or effects box.
The 3.5mm jack socket can be used
to connect a computer, MP3 player or
other stereo source. The Passive DI
Box mixes the incoming stereo signal
into mono.
Performance
The performance of the SILICON
CHIP Passive DI Box is impressive. It
easily outperformed one commercially
available unit we compared it against,
both in terms of audio sound quality
and frequency response. While the
frequency response of the commercial
unit was very restricted in the bass region (-3dB at 250Hz, -6dB at 125Hz and
more than -12dB at 60Hz!), our unit
could pass signals well below 20Hz
without any appreciable attenuation.
In addition, the unit does not add
any noticeable noise to the signal. Our
tests for signal-to-noise ratio do not
do the unit justice as the tests results
are below the noise floor of our Audio
Precision measuring equipment. The
distortion is very low and is typically
below 0.02% for a 1V signal above
100Hz. It has even lower distortion
with lower signal levels.
The exceptional sound quality from
the Passive DI Box is due to use of a
high-quality audio transformer from
Altronics. It incorporates a Mu metal
shield for extra low noise and hum.
Several musicians who tested our
Passive DI Box remarked that it has
better quality sound than many commercial units.
Circuit details
Fig.1 shows the complete circuit,
which is based around the Altronics
M-0705 transformer with a 10kΩ primary and 600Ω secondary. 6.35mm
stereo jack socket CON1 is used for
mono input signals while 3.5mm jack
socket CON2 is used for stereo signals.
The tip (left) and ring (right) signals
from the latter are mixed by a pair of
2.2kΩ resistors and fed to T1’s primary.
Since CON1 is for mono signals, only
its tip contact is connected and this
also goes to T1’s primary winding.
October 2014 67
Yellow
2.2k
CON3
Red
2
1231
4 1 909
0 1141
32
3
C 2014
1
S1
2.2k
T1
Blue
CON1
Chassis
Green
SHIELD
(VIEW FROM ABOVE)
DI BOX
CABLE TIE
HEATSHRINK
SLEEVES
SOLDER LUG ATTACHED
TO SIDE OF BOX USING
10mm M4 SCREW WITH
NUT & LOCKWASHER
SIDE OF BOX
S1
(VIEW FROM BELOW)
S
T
Fig.2: install the parts on the PCB
and complete the wiring as shown in
this diagram and the accompanying
photograph.
231 09 141
CON2
R
(T1 ABOVE)
The other end of the primary
winding connects to the input signal
ground, ie, the two connector sleeves.
The balanced output signal appears
across the 600Ω secondary of T1, so
pins 2 & 3 of XLR plug CON3 are connected directly across this winding.
The centre tap of the secondary winding isn’t used so the output ‘floats’.
Pin 1 of the XLR connector is the
ground pin and this is connected to
the DI Box case and the shell of the
plug housing. Even though the XLR
socket is a plastic connector, there is a
metal contact that connects to provide
shielding for the XLR plug when it is
inserted into this socket.
The input and output grounds are
joined only by switch S1. Opening
this switch provides the ground lift.
Normally S1 is left closed unless there
is a hum loop.
neatly into a 111 x 60 x 30mm diecast
aluminium box (with a little coaxing).
Fig.2 shows the parts layout on
the PCB and the external wiring. The
3.5mm jack socket is installed on
the underside of the PCB while the
6.35mm jack socket, two resistors,
transformer T1 and the XLR plug all
mount on the top side. Solder the
3.5mm jack socket first because when
the 6.35mm jack socket is installed, the
3.5mm socket pins will be inaccessible. Both sockets should be pushed as
far down onto the PCB as they will go.
Construction
The SILICON CHIP Passive Direct
Injection Box is assembled onto a
double-sided PCB coded 23111141
and measuring 105 x 24mm. This fits
TOP EDGE OF CASE (WITHOUT LID)
TOP EDGE OF CASE (WITHOUT LID)
A
6.5mm
DIAM.
10.5mm
DIAM.
10
CL
CL
22mm
DIAM.
10
HOLES A: 3mm DIAM.
HOLE B: 4mm DIAM.
12.5
A
10
CL
24.5
TOP EDGE OF CASE (WITHOUT LID)
13
10
B
CL
19.5
30
50
ALL DIMENSIONS IN MILLIMETRES
Fig.3: this diagram can be copied and used the three sections cut out and used as drilling templates for the metal
case. It can also be downloaded (in PDF format) from the SILICON CHIP website and printed out.
68 Silicon Chip
siliconchip.com.au
Specifications
Input signal handling: 2V RMS
Input impedance: ~3kΩ (stereo source), 10kΩ (mono source)
Output impedance: 600Ω
Output level: typically 250mV RMS (balanced) for a 1V RMS mono input
Frequency response: ±0.5dB, 20Hz-20kHz
Signal-to-noise ratio: -98dB unweighted (22Hz-22kHz); -101dB A-weighted,
both with respect to 1V RMS input
Total harmonic distortion: <0.02%, 100Hz-20kHz (0.1% <at> 30Hz), 1V RMS
input
Phase shift between input & output: 7° at 20Hz, 3° at 100Hz, ~0° above 1kHz
Dimensions: 115 x 65 x 33mm Mass: 175g
Parts List: Passive DI Box
With the sockets fitted, follow with
the 2.2kΩ resistors. The transformer
is then secured to the PCB using M3
x 6mm screws and star washers. The
screws (fitted with the washers) are
fed up from the underside of the PCB
and go into M3 tapped holes on either
side of the transformer.
That done, feed the transformer
wires up through the adjacent holes
in the PCB (see Fig.2), then back down
again and solder them to the indicated
pads (ie, with the solder joints on the
top). The wires are colour coded and
must be connected as shown to correctly preserve the signal phase (ie,
in-phase output to XLR pin 2 [hot]).
We have marked the colours of the
wires that correspond to the 10kΩ and
600Ω windings on both the PCB itself
and the parts layout diagram.
The leads for the switch and chassis earth can now be stripped and
soldered to the PCB. Solder the other
end of the earth wire to the solder lug.
The soldered section of this terminal
should be covered with heatshrink
tubing, to prevent the lead from breaking at the solder joint.
The XLR socket is held down using
a cable tie that straps around the body
and around the PCB at the recessed cutouts on either side. The positioning of
the cable tie joiner is important. It must
be positioned as shown in the photos,
so it does not foul the case or lid.
The case is used upside-down, with
siliconchip.com.au
1 double-sided PCB, code
23111141, 105 x 24mm
1 panel label, 51 x 102mm
1 diecast box, 111 x 60 x 30mm
(Jaycar HB-5064 or Altronics H
0432)
1 6.35mm stereo switched PCBmount jack socket (CON1)
(Jaycar PS-0190, Altronics P
0073 or PA0073)
1 3.5mm stereo PCB-mount jack
socket (CON2) (Jaycar PS0133, Altronics P 0092)
1 right-angle PCB-mount XLR
male connector (CON3) (Altronics P 0874)
1 10kΩ to 600Ω Mu metal shielded transformer (T1) (Altronics
M 0705)
1 SPST rocker switch (S1) (Jaycar
SK-0984, Altronics S 3210)
the lid as the base. Note that the Altronics version has a flanged lid; if you don’t
want the flanges, it’s just a matter of
cutting them off.
Cut-out and drilling templates are
provided for the various holes required in the base – see Fig.3. These
templates can also be downloaded (no
charge) from the SILICON CHIP website
and printed out (browse to www.
siliconchip.com.au then mouseover
‘Shop’, click ‘by Year/Month’ and
select October/2014).
The diecast aluminium is very
easy to drill and file. The 6.5mm and
10.5mm-diameter holes are best made
by first drilling small pilot holes, then
carefully enlarging them to size using a tapered reamer. By contrast, the
22mm hole for the XLR connector is
2 2.2kΩ 0.25W or 0.5W 1% resistors
2 M3 x 6mm pan head machine
screws
2 M3 x 10mm countersink head
machine screws
2 3mm star washers
1 M4 x 10mm countersink head
machine screw
4 M4 x 10mm Nylon pan head
screws (optional, for feet)
1 M4 nut
1 4mm star washer
1 solder lug
1 60mm length of green medium
duty (24 x 0.2mm) hookup wire
1 120mm length of black medium
duty (24 x 0.2mm) hookup wire
1 100mm cable tie
1 100mm length of 6mm
heatshrink tubing
best made using a 22mm speed bore
drill. Alternatively, it can be made by
drilling around the inside perimeter
with a small drill, then knocking out
the centre piece and filing to shape.
This same method can be used for the
rectangular switch cut-out
You also have to drill holes for the
XLR mounting screws and the earth
screw. If using countersunk screws
(a good idea), countersink the holes
to suit. The mounting holes on the
XLR connector are untapped however
threads can be formed by simply forcing the M3 screws into the holes.
Once all the holes have been drilled,
cover the threaded ferrule on the
3.5mm socket with a short length of
6mm-diameter heatshrink tubing.
This is necessary to insulate it from
October 2014 69
si
In ve
(D
je
I)
ct
B
ox ion
ct
Pa
s
D
ir
e
Ground Lift
(Change Switch Position
When Hum Is Present)
This view shows the PCB assembly prior
to installation in the case.
the case. The heatshrink tubing must
be shrunk down so that it cannot fall
off and it should later fit snugly into
the 6.5mm hole for this socket.
We tapped the box corner holes to
an M4 thread so that M4 Nylon screws
could be used to secure the lid. The
heads of these screws then act as feet.
Alternatively, you can skip this step
and use the original metal screws. You
can then elect to either not have feet
or you could attach separate screw-on/
stick-on feet to the lid (although these
may not last long if the unit is treated
roughly).
Final assembly
The PCB assembly is inserted into
the box in a special way. First, the
6.35mm and 3.5mm jack socket ferrules are inserted into their respec-
tive holes. The PCB is then bent in
the middle by pushing down on the
transformer and pushing the XLR connector inwards. This then allows the
XLR socket to be slid into the box, after
which the PCB is released so the socket
fits into its 22mm-diameter hole. Fig.5
shows the details.
If necessary, the PCB assembly can
be removed from the case using the
reverse procedure.
The rocker switch can now be
clipped into position and the earth
lug secured to the side of the case using an M4 x 10mm screw, star washer
and nut. Finally, complete the wiring
to the switch lugs and secure the XLR
socket to the case using two M3 x
10mm countersink head screws. As
with the earth lug connection, it’s a
good idea to fit heatshrink tubing over
CO N3
CO N1
T1
PCB
CO N2
Fig.5: the PCB is installed in the case by inserting the jack socket ferrules
into their holes at one end and then bending the PCB by pushing against
transformer T1 and the XLR socket (CON3) as shown here.
70 Silicon Chip
CHIP
SILICON
www.siliconchip.com.au
Fig.4: the full-size front panel label.
It’s also available (in PDF format)
from the SILICON CHIP website.
the connections to the switch lugs to
prevent the leads from breaking at the
solder joints.
Testing
The Passive DI Box is tested by feeding in a signal from an instrument or
signal generator and measuring the
output across pins 2 & 3 of the XLR
socket.
To do this, set your multimeter to
read ‘mV AC’, plug the instrument or
generator into the DI box and play the
instrument. You should get a signal
reading of about 250mV on the meter
for an input of around 1V RMS.
If that checks out, set your multimeter to read ohms and connect it
between the ground (sleeve) connection of the instrument’s jack plug in
the DI Box and pin 1 of the XLR plug.
Now check that this connection can
be opened and closed using switch S1.
Assuming it all works as expected,
you can now fit the lid and affix the
front-panel label to the base (not the
lid). This label can be downloaded
from the SILICON CHIP Chip website
in PDF format and printed out on a
colour printer.
You have several options here. First,
you can just use paper or photo-paper
siliconchip.com.au
KEEP YOUR COPIES OF
AS GOOD AS THE DAY
THEY WERE
BORN!
Above: once the PCB is in the case, it’s secured by fitting a nut to the 6.35mm
jack socket at one end and two M3 x 6mm countersink-head machine screws
to the XLR socket at the other end.
Magazines are
sneaky things:
left to themselves, they’ll
hide, they’ll get
crushed, folded,
spindled, dogeared, pages will
disappear . . . not
good when you
want to refer to an
article in the future.
ONLY
14 95
$
INC
GST
PLUS
p&p
A SILICON CHIP binder will
keep your copies in pristine
condition – and you’ll
always be able to find them!
* Each binder holds up to 14 issues
* Made from heavy duty vinyl
* Easy-fit wire inserts
ORDER NOW AT
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
It’s a good idea to fit heatshrink tubing over the wiring connections to the
switch and the earth lug to prevent the wires breaking at the solder joints.
and affix the resulting label using a
suitable glue or neutral cure silicone.
However, this type of label is easily
damaged.
Alternatively, for a more rugged
label, print a mirror image label onto
clear overhead projector film (be sure
to use a film that’s suitable for your
printer). This is then attached using
clear or coloured silicone sealant, with
the image on the inside.
Another approach is to print onto
an A4-size synthetic ‘Dataflex’ sticky
label if using an inkjet printer, or onto
a ‘Datapol’ sticky label if using a laser
printer. This can then be trimmed to
size and affixed to the base of the case
using the label’s self-adhesive backing.
Dataflex and Datapol labels are available from www.blanklabels.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
Dataflex & Datapol Labels
(1) For Dataflex labels, go to http://
www.blanklabels.com.au/index.
php?main_page=product_
info&cPath=49_60&products_
id=335
(2) For Datapol labels go to http://
www.blanklabels.com.au/index.
php?main_page=product_
info&cPath=49_55&products_
id=326
and sample sheets are available on request to test in your printer – see panel.
Your Passive DI Box is now ready
for use. Just remember that you can’t
plug the high-impedance output from
an electric guitar directly into it. SC
Where do you
get those
HARD-TO-GET
PARTS?
Many of the components used in
SILICON CHIP projects are cutting-edge
technology and not worth your normal
parts suppliers either sourcing or
stocking in relatively low quantities.
Where we can, the SILICON CHIP
PartShop stocks those hard-to-get
parts, along with PC boards,
programmed micros, panels and all
the other bits and pieces to enable you
to complete your SILICON CHIP project.
SILICON CHIP
PARTSHOP
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
October 2014 71
CIRCUIT NOTEBOOK
Interesting circuit ideas which we have checked but not built and tested. Contributions will be
paid for at standard rates. All submissions should include full name, address & phone number.
PICAXE-based bistro
paging system
This bistro paging system was inspired by the various pagers handed
out in clubs and restaurants for meal
and drinks orders. The project has
a base station and up to 99 portable
‘guest pagers’. The base station
provides a 7-segment display and
keypad to call the guest pagers, each
of which has a buzzer and a row of
six blue LEDs to alert the guests. This
easy-to-build design does not need
rechargeable batteries or a pagerstyle vibrator.
The system communicates in the
UHF band using pre-built 433MHz
wireless modules. It transmits eight
bytes of Manchester encoded data,
containing a 6-byte ‘system code’
common to all the pagers and also
a 2-byte ‘pager code’ identifying
individual pagers. The default
system code is 123456 while each
guest pager requires a unique pager
code in the range 00 to 99. Check
the program notes on how to enter
your own codes.
The base station (Fig.1) includes a
PICAXE-20M2 (IC1) and a ZW-3100
433MHz transmitter module. The
keypad connects to analog input
pins 15-17 of IC1. The program is
able to detect individual keys using
the voltage levels present on the
resistive divider feeding the keypad.
The 2-digit 7-segment display is
multiplexed using transistors Q1 &
Q2 to drive the common cathode
pins while the anode pins are driven
by the micro via seven 100Ω currentlimiting resistors. The base station
runs on 5V DC using a 7805 regulator
and a 9V or 12V DC plugpack,
You call guest pagers using the
keypad. Press the ‘star’ key to blank
the display then enter a 2-digit pager
number followed by the hash key to
transmit the ‘pager code’. The wireless transmission turns on output
pin 14 of IC1 to power the Tx module’s Vcc pin while output pin 13
sends the Manchester encoded data
to the Tx module’s data pin.
Each key press is accompanied by
a beep from a 3.3kHz piezo buzzer
which is driven by pin 18 of IC1.
The data is transmitted using the
‘rfout’ command and received using
the ‘rfin’ command.
Each guest pager includes a PIC
AXE-14M2 (IC2) and a ZW-3102
receiver module (Fig.2). The Manchester encoded data is received by
the Rx module and fed to pin 4 of
IC2. IC2’s outputs drive LED1-LED6
(the six blue LEDs) and also a 400Hz
buzzer. The alarm sequence sounds
the buzzer six times while also lighting the LEDs one after the other in a
cycle lasting 40 seconds.
To test pagers, a jumper on LK1
gives an 8-second cycle. The pag-
Ian Robertso
n
ers are powered
is this mon
th
’s
w
in
ner
from four alkaof a $150 g
ift voucher
line AA cells.
from
Hare & Forb
es
Before handing out each guest
pager you momentarily
operate reed relay RLY1 with a magnet to turn the pager on. Orientate
the magnet to assist rather than
cancel the relay coil magnetism. To
confirm the pager is on, LED1 and
LED6 will flash and the buzzer will
beep twice. The ‘wait’ indicator
(LED7) will illuminate and output
pin 7 of IC2 will hold relay RLY1 on,
only dropping out after the pager is
called and the alarm sequence ends.
The wireless transmitter and receiver modules will each require a
suitable antenna, the simplest being
a length of stiff insulated hook-up
wire 170mm long. Depending on the
enclosure dimensions, the antenna
wire may be straight or coiled into
a spiral.
The microcontrollers have ICSP
headers for programming. Use a
PICAXE serial or USB cable to download ‘bistrobase_20m2.bas’ into IC1
and ‘bistropager_14m2.bas’ into IC2.
When programming the guest pagers, place a magnet next to the reed
relay to power IC2.
The software is available on the
SILICON CHIP website.
Ian Robertson,
Engadine, NSW.
co n tr ib u ti on
MAY THE BEST MAN WIN!
As you can see, we pay $$$ for contributions to Circuit Notebook.
Each month the BEST contribution (at the sole discretion of the editor)
receives a $150 gift voucher from Hare&Forbes Machineryhouse.
That’s yours to spend at Hare&Forbes Machineryhouse as you see fit
- buy some tools you’ve always wanted, or put it towards that big
purchase you’ve never been able to afford!
100% Australian owned Established 1930
“Setting the standard in quality & value”
www.machineryhouse.com.au
72 Silicon Chip
150
$
GIFT VOUCHER
Contribute NOW and WIN!
Email your contribution now to:
editor<at>siliconchip.com.au
or post to PO Box 139, Collaroy NSW
siliconchip.com.au
OUT
KEYPAD
(E.G., JAYCAR AB-3462)
2
(4V)
ROW1
1
2
+V
ROW2
4
5
C2
C3
(2V)
ROW3
7
8
9
C4
C5
1k
4
(1V)
ROW4
*
0
#
COL3 5
COL2 1
COL1 3
C7
IC1
PICAXE 20 M 2
17
16
15
19
1k
2
22k
ICSP
HEADER
10k
9 – 12V
DC
470 µF
25V
4
B5
B1
B6
B2
B3
B7
SER.OUT
SER.IN
B0
C6
7x 100Ω
10
C1
6
1k
6
16V
+
S1
–
14
B4
3
C0
7
IN
POWER
A
1
1k
(3V)
K
GND
10 µF
100nF
100nF
1k
D1 1N4004
REG1 7805
+5V
9
6
8
4
7
2
6
1
5
9
3
10
6
a
f
DISP1
7
b
g
e
a
4
f
2
e
1
c
170mm
LONG
ANTENNA
c
9
d
b
g
d
10
3,8
Vcc
3,8
13
433MHz
TX
MODULE
DATA
1k
12
1k
11
ANT
GND
18
C
B
C
B
Q2
+
0V
20
3x
18k
DISP2
7
Q1
E
E
PIEZO
BUZZER
7805
Q1, Q2: BC 33 7
433MHz Tx MODULE
1N4004
ANT
Vcc
DATA
GND
A
B
K
GND
IN
E
C
GND
OUT
Fig.1: the base station uses a PICAXE 20M2 microcontroller (IC1), a keypad, two 7-segment displays and a 433MHz
transmitter module to call up to 99 guest pagers. The unit is powered from a 9-12V DC plugpack.
D1 1N4148
A
K
170mm
LONG
ANTENNA
100nF
WAIT
LED7
λ A
K
1k
C1
5
433MHz
RX
MODULE
4
DATA
3
GND
MECHANICAL
400Hz
BUZZER
C0
22k
10k
B4
C2
IC1
PICAXE
14M
1
4M 2
TEST
Vcc
+V
B5
LK1
ANT
1
6
C3
B3
B2
7
8
9
10 A
11
12 A
C4
B1
2 SerIN/
C5
SerO/ 13
B0
0V
14
A
λ
K
LED6 A
λ
ALARM LEDS
λ
D2
1N4148 K
K
K LED5
LED4 A
λ
λ
A
K
λ
N
6
S
1,14
6V
BATTERY
(4x AA
CELLS)
K
LED1
ICSP
HEADER
ON
7,8
100nF
K LED3
LED2 A
RLY1
2
220Ω
433MHz Rx MODULE
LEDS
Vcc
DATA
DATA
GND
ANT
GND
GND
Vcc
RLY1: JAYCAR SY-4030 OR SIMILAR
1N4148
A
K
K
A
Fig.2: a 433MHz receiver module in each guest pager picks up the signal from the base station and feeds the data to a
PICAXE 14M2. This decodes the data and drives blue LEDs LD1-LD6 and sounds a buzzer. Reed switch RLY1 is used to
turn the unit on. Power comes from four 1.5V AA cells.
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 73
Circuit Notebook – Continued
Micromite GPS dual clock with 7-day alarm
I was so impressed with Geoff
Graham’s article on using a 28-pin
Micromite with a GPS unit to create
a simple GPS-Controlled Clock (SILICON CHIP, May 2014) that I thought
it deserved to be expanded to a fullblown clock with some additional
bells and whistles.
A GPS clock has a couple of great
advantages. First, its accuracy; it will
never gain or lose time. Secondly,
it will always recover from a power
outage with the correct time. It will
never require resetting.
So what extra features would you
want over Geoff’s original circuit?
Well, I consider the 16x2 LCD an
unsuitable display for a real clock.
A practical clock has to be readable
from the other side of the room, so I
decided that four 25mm 7-segment
LED displays (RS Cat. 235-8957)
would be more suitable for displaying the time. These units use two
diodes per segment, so smaller units
using one diode per segment would
not be direct replacements.
I decided to keep the LCD as well,
because it is capable of displaying
the date as well as any other details
you might want to extract from the
GPS signal. Also, if the LCD is an
Arduino 16x2 Keypad Shield, you
can take advantage of the six inbuilt
control buttons to perform alarmsetting functions.
The alarm is a 7-day type where
you can set different ON/OFF times
for each day. When the ON time
has occurred, a relay will switch
mains power to a GPO and when the
OFF time is reached, power will be
removed. Once the alarm information has been entered it is stored in
non-volatile memory so that after a
power outage the clock will resume
not only with the correct time but
with all the alarm settings as well.
The circuit diagram (Fig.1) shows
the EM408 GPS unit connected to
pins 21 & 22 and the console connected to pins 11 & 12 of the Micromite. This is the basic GPS clock
which was fully described in the
May 2014 issue. Note that the EM408
should be the TTL version rather
than the RS232 version (see Geoff
Graham’s website for an explanation
of the differences).
If you do use the RS232 version
it will have to be connected to the
Maximite via an RS232-to-TTL
converter such as described in the
Circuit Notebook pages of the August 2014 issue or you could use the
simpler circuit in July 2014. In the
latter case, you would also need to
change the program line:
Open “COM1:4800” As #1 to
Open “COM1:4800,INV” As #1
The four 7-segment LED displays
are driven by IC1, a BCD to 7-segment decoder. IC1 gets its BCD input
from pins 15-17 of the Micromite.
The four displays are multiplexed
using a 74HC238 wired as a 2-to-4
multiplexer. By using this chip, only
two output pins (23 & 24) of the
Micromite are needed rather than
four; this project uses all available
Micromite I/O pins. The decimal
point on the hours display is driven
by pin 3 of the Micromite and toggles
every second to create a ‘heartbeat’
for the clock.
Switch S1 is the ALARM ON/OFF
switch. When the alarm is set, the
decimal point on the minutes display
is illuminated and the set condition
is sensed by pin 26 on the Micromite.
The use of the Arduino 16x2
keypad shield with a MiniMaximite
was explained in an earlier Circuit
Notebook article (S ILICON C HIP ,
March 2014). Its connection to the
Micromite follows the same pattern.
Pins 4-7 of the Micromite control
data lines D4-D7 of the LCD, while
Table 1
No Button
Upper Limit
A0 Voltage
3.21
Lower Limit
74 Silicon Chip
Memory
Item
Down
Up
Exit
2.84
2.09
1.47
0.87
0.27
2.53
1.85
1.29
0.61
0
2.09
1.47
0.87
0.27
0
the RS and EN lines are connected
to pins 9 and 10 respectively of the
Micromite.
The LCD has its own inbuilt contrast control. The LCD shield is a 5V
device and suitable power connections of 5V and 0V are connected to
the shield where shown.
The reset button will cause the
LCD to re-initialise. I found that
the LCD would sometimes revert to
printing rubbish characters, probably due to some form of interference. Without the reset button, the
only way to restore normal LCD
operation is to switch the device off
and on. The reset button is enabled
by connecting the reset pin on the
LCD to pin 2 of the Micromite which
is pulled high to 3.3V via an 8.2kΩ
resistor as shown.
All the other buttons – EXIT, UP,
DOWN, ITEM, and MEMORY – are
activated through the analog LCD
pin, A0, which connects to pin 25
of the Micromite. Ra, a 5.6kΩ resistor, grounds this line. Ra combines
with internal resistors (not shown)
in the LCD to form a complex voltage divider. It is essential that Ra is
of the correct value and some initial
experimentation may be required.
The correct value for Ra is such
that with no button pressed, pin
A0 is as close to 3.3V as possible
without exceeding it. This should
be done before any connections
are made to the Micromite. Simply
connect the power pins of the LCD
to +5V and 0V and connect a 5.6kΩ
resistor from the A0 pin to 0V.
Then use an accurate voltmeter to
measure the voltage on the A0 pin
with no button pressed. Change the
5.6kΩ resistor if necessary to get the
desired voltage at pin A0 (≤ 3.3V).
There must be considerable variation in the LCD construction because
in one case Ra needed to be 5.6kΩ
whereas in another it was 3.9kΩ.
Unfortunately, each value will present slightly different voltage levels
to the analog input.
Next, press each button in turn
and record the voltage at A0 for each.
Draw up a table as shown in Table
1 (ie, substitute your measurements
in the “A0 Voltage” row):
The “Upper Limit” and “Lower
Limit” rows show the values used in
continued on page 104
siliconchip.com.au
TO SERIAL
TERMINAL
MEMORY
ITEM
DOWN UP
EXIT
RESET
RESET
+5V
GND
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
GND
Tx
Rx
GND
TxD
RxD
EN
D8
D9
D10
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
2
4
3
1
5
GND
D11
D12
D13
DATA IN
DATA OUT
8.2k
+3.3V
TANT
47 µF
(SEE TEXT)
Ra
5.6k
+3.3V
12
11
2
20
10
9
7
6
5
4
25
22
21
100nF
13
8
19
28-pin
MICROMITE
1
27
28
1000 µF
EL
DA
DB
DC
DD
LT
BI
4
5
6
3
2
24
OE1
OE2
OE3
A2
A1
A0
100nF
5
7
1
2
6
3
4
Oe
Of
Og
16
Vcc
8
Vss
Y7
A
K
1N4004
GND
8
Y6
Y5
Y4
Y2
Y1
Y0
Oa
Ob
Oc
7
9
10
12
13
14
15
13
12
11
9
15
14
10
IC1
4 5 1 1 B Od
Vdd
16
1k
B
B
8.2k
C
BC548
1k
1k
1k
1k
S1
7
6
4
2
1
9
B
D1
1N4004
A
K
1000 µF
+12V
c
b
B
IN
~
B
IN
5
dp
e
f
~
9V
E
C
c
b
T1
OUT
7805
Q3
BC548
K
3,8
d
g
a
DISP3
GND
39Ω
Q2
BC548
c
b
OUT
E
C
K
3,8
d
g
a
–
BR1 W04
+
DISP2
5
dp
e
f
LM1117T
Q1
BC548
GND
OUT
E
C
K
3,8
d
g
a
RLY1
DISP1
5
dp
e
f
Q5
BC548
IN
10
ALARM SET
E
39Ω
E
C
GND
OUT
REG1 LM7805
8 x 10Ω
100nF 1000 µF
Y3
IC2
74HC 2 38
11
+5V
100nF
1
+3.3V
4 x 8.2k
IN
23
26
3
15
16
17
18
14
GND
OUT
REG2: LM1117T-3.3
B
a
E
C
c
b
+~~–
W04
A
E
N
MAINS
INPUT
Q4
BC548
K
3,8
d
g
GND
5
dp
e
f
DISP4
GPO
230V
Fig.1: the circuit is based on the GPS-Controlled Clock described in May 2014 but has been considerably expanded to use an Arduino 16x2 LCD & Keypad
Shield and four 7-segment LED displays. A 7-day alarm is also included, with provision to switch mains power to a GPO.
+5V
GLOBALSAT
EM-408
GPS RECEIVER
MODULE
ARDUINO 16x2 LCD & KEYPAD SHIELD
Vcc
(CERAMIC PATCH ANTENNA)
CONTRAST
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 75
Save $$$$ over comparable analysers!
AN
EVEN BETTER
USB
SPECTRUM
ANALYSER
By JIM ROWE
USB-powered mini spectrum analysers based on SDR technology are
evolving fast. The Signal Hound USB-SA44B shows how rapidly this
technology is developing – demonstrating a performance that compares
very well indeed with that of high-end self contained analysers, for a
fraction of their price.
W
hen I reviewed the Triarchy
TSG5G35 USB ‘dongle’ spectrum analyser for the January 2014 issue of SILICON CHIP, I was
impressed by the level of performance
it provided – especially considering
its tiny price.
It did have a few shortcomings,
particularly if you compared it with
self-contained analysers like the Gratten GA4063 (SILICON CHIP November
76 Silicon Chip
2013). But it still seemed likely to have
plenty of practical applications.
So I wasn’t really expecting much
when the opportunity came a few
weeks ago to review another SDRbased USB spectrum analyser, the
Signal Hound USB-SA44B.
Boy, was I wrong!
Not long after the review sample
arrived I installed its accompanying
software on a PC running Windows 7
Pro (64bit) and started to explore the
capabilities of both the hardware and
its software.
And the more I explored, the more
impressed I became. . .
In fact I found that it’s much more
than ‘yet another USB mini spectrum
analyser based on SDR (softwaredefined radio) technology’ – more an
example of where this technology is
siliconchip.com.au
Front (above) and rear (right) panels of the Signal Hound
USB-SA44B, just a bit larger than life size. There are no
controls as such – they’re all taken care of via the supplied
software.
really headed. But let’s start at the
beginning.
The USB-SA44B comes from a
company in the USA. Originally it
was called Test Equipment Plus or
‘TEP’, which began operation in 1996
refurbishing and reselling used test
equipment.
In 2006 they began designing and
manufacturing colour LCD kits for
use in refurbishing older CRT-based
HP spectrum analysers for which the
CRTs were no longer available.
This was so successful that they
expanded their capabilities to become
a comprehensive repair service for HP/
Agilent spectrum analysers, oscilloscopes and signal generators.
In 2009 they decided to design a
compact, lightweight and inexpensive
spectrum analyser of their own. This
appeared in February 2010 as the
Signal Hound USB-SA44, which apparently sold like ‘hot cakes’.
Before long they not only came up
with an improved model (the USBSA44B, which we’re reviewing here)
but also renamed the company itself
as Signal Hound in April this year.
The TEP side of the business is still
going strongly though, repairing HP/
Agilent (and I presume the newest
incarnation, Keysight Technologies)
test equipment.
Encouraged by the success of the
USB-SA44/B they’ve also produced
a higher performance USB 3.0 based
spectrum analyser, the BB60.
Despite its higher price, the BB60A
sold out very quickly and Signal
Hound will soon be releasing a production run of a significantly improved
BB60C model.
So that’s an idea of where the USBSA44B comes from. By the way in
Australia and New Zealand, Signal
Hound products like the USB-SA44B
are distributed by Silvertone Electron-
Fig.1: A screen grab showing the SA44B’s DANL (displayed average noise level) at 4.0GHz with its input terminated in
50Ω. It shows a DANL of -140dBm, with very occasional spikes reaching about -124dBm. Note the control panel at right.
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 77
signals to allow image cancellation.
4. The two IF signals then pass
through dual IF amplifier/filters,
before passing to the ‘IF to bits’ digital receiver section, where they are
processed by quadrature I/Q digital
samplers to produce a 2MB/s output
data stream. This is then conveyed to
the PC via the USB 2.0 cable.
The output data stream from the
hardware box is processed and analysed by the Signal Hound software, to
produce the analyser’s output display
and measurements.
The software also controls the operation of the hardware, becoming the
analyser’s ‘front panel’.
Fig.2: Another screen grab showing the SA44B’s DANL at 2.2GHz. It’s even
better, displaying -150dBm with very few peaks reaching -140dBm.
ics, now based in Wagga Wagga, NSW.
You’ll find their website at www.
silvertone.com.au
So let’s look more closely at the
USB-SA44B analyser itself. As you
can see from the photo it’s not as tiny
as a dongle but nevertheless quite
compact. The case is based on an
aluminium extrusion, measuring 77
x 27mm and with a length of 167mm
(not counting the input and output
connectors at each end). It weighs
just on 290g.
At the input end there’s an SMA
socket in the centre, with a busy/ready
LED visible through a small window
on the left.
Then at the output end there’s a USB
type B socket in the centre for connection back to your PC/laptop/tablet,
plus a BNC socket on either side.
One of these is for feeding in an
external 10MHz reference if you need
higher frequency accuracy than is
provided by the internal TCXO (temperature compensated crystal oscillator), while the other is for a number
of utility purposes – some associated
with the matching Signal Hound USBTG44A tracking generator (available
separately).
higher sensitivity and a lower noise
floor. (The preamp can only be used
for frequencies above 500kHz.)
3. A pair of mixers, where the incoming signals are mixed with higher
and lower frequency local oscillator
Software & manual on CD
The USB-SA44B comes with a CDROM containing both its matching
driver and control software and the
User Manual as a PDF file, plus a 1.8mlong USB cable.
An optional accessory kit, comprising a 20dB SMA/SMA fixed attenuator,
Inside the box . . .
You’ll find an advanced narrowband SDR receiving system tuning
over the range from 1Hz to 4.4GHz,
(yes, you read that correctly!) made up
from the following elements:
1. A programmable input attenuator
with four ranges (0dB, -5dB, -10dB
and -15dB).
2. A wideband RF preamplifier
which can be switched in to achieve
78 Silicon Chip
Fig.3: A printout from the SA44B’s control software this time, showing its
DANL or ‘noise floor’ at 1GHz to be a bit below -150dBm. Just about all of
the analyser settings are printed out as well.
siliconchip.com.au
an SMA/BNC adaptor and an SMA/
SMA DC blocking adaptor, is available
separately.
The latter would be especially useful because the SA-44B’s input circuit
cannot cope with DC voltages greater
than ±0.2V.
I should also mention that the software supplied on the CD-ROM is able
to control the optional TG44A tracking
generator as well as the SA44B.
The basic specification for the
SA44B shown in the panel at right
gives a good idea of the performance
delivered by this very nicely integrated
hardware and software combination. It
compares very favourably with analysers costing many times its price (which
is $AU1198.70 plus GST in Australia
and NZ).
What I found
The first thing I did when the SA44B
arrived was to print out the User
Manual (old-fashioned, I know but I
do prefer to read a ‘hard copy’), and
then read it carefully before proceeding. It seems to be very well written
and informative.
I then realised that although I’d
planned to install the SA44B’s control
software on my old ‘workhorse’ Windows XP machine near my workbench,
this wouldn’t be a good idea because
the SA44B control software needs to
link up to Signal Hound’s website
when it initially starts up, to download
a special temperature correction file.
I had to disconnect the XP machine
from the network and internet when
Microsoft stopped supporting XP
Basic Specification
Specification –– Signal
Signal Hound
Hound USB-SA44B
USB-SA44B
Basic
Frequency Range: 1Hz to 4.4GHz
Span Modes:
Either Centre Frequency + Span
or Start + Stop Frequencies
Maximum Span: 4.4GHz
Minimum Span: 10Hz, or Zero Span
Internal Frequency Reference Accuracy: ±1ppm
Frequency Readout and Marker Accuracy: reference error ±1 sample
Resolution Bandwidth (RBW): 0.1Hz to 250kHz
Amplitude Range: Input level for 1dB gain compression
with preamp off, attenuator set for -15dB: +16dBm typical, 1Hz-150MHz
+19dBm typical, 150MHz-4.4GHz
Displayed Average Noise Level (DANL): (preamp off) (preamp on)
(with 0dB input attenuation,
10Hz: -124dBm
1Hz RBW [ie, noise floor])
100Hz - 10kHz: -130dBm
10kHz - 500kHz: -142dBm
500kHz - 10MHz: -142dBm
-153dBm
10MHz - 100MHz: -148dBm
-161dBm
100MHz - 1GHz: -144dBm
-158dBm
1GHz - 2.6GHz: -139dBm
-151dBm
2.6GHz - 3.3GHz: -135dBm
-151dBm
3.3GHz - 4.4GHz: -128dBm
-134dBm
Absolute Accuracy (Reference level <=0dBm): ±1.5dB
Absolute Accuracy (0dBm < Ref Level <+10dBm): ±2.0dB
Relative Accuracy (Ref Level <= 0dBm): ±0.25dB
Maximum Safe Input Level (15dB attenuation, preamp off): +20dBm
Maximum DC voltage input: < ±0.2V, absolute
Residual Responses (input terminated, span <= 10kHz,
0dB attenuation, preamp on): < -80dBm
earlier in the year, so this wouldn’t
be feasible. As a result, I had to install
the software on my main machine running Windows 7 Pro (64-bit) – which
is connected to the internet, of course.
Installing the USB drivers and con-
Fig.4: this shows the SA44B capturing the output of a Gratten GA-1484B signal
generator at 1.0GHz and with a level of -127dBm (100nV at 50Ω). The carrier
spike measures -128.3dBm, showing the cable loss as 1.3dBm.
siliconchip.com.au
trol software for the SA44B turned out
to be very quick and painless. I was
soon familiar with the SA44B’s GUI
and it gave every evidence of being
well written and quite intuitive to use.
It did take a little while to get the
hang of adjusting one or two of the
controls on the ‘front panel’ running
down the right-hand side of the screen
but there were no major hassles.
Then I spent an interesting couple
of hours running a variety of tests on
the SA44B.
But before I discuss the results of
this testing, I should note that although
the SA44B control and display software does not allow you to directly
print out any of your analyser displays:
it only prints out the contents of the
display window – not the control
panel alongside.
It even allows you to reverse these
printouts so they’re dark on a white
background, to save printer ink or
toner.
And the display printout does contain pretty well all the information
you’d normally need – like the start,
October 2014 79
Fig.5: this one’s taken with a tiny whip antenna connected to the SA44B
input, scanning in the vicinity of 1575GHz. There’s a small spike
of -122.3dBm at 1575MHz, presumably from a GPS satellite passing nearby.
Fig.6: finally, a scan centred on 1090MHz with the SA44B connected to an
external VHF-UHF discone antenna. It appears to be an ADSB squitter from a
passing commercial aircraft.
centre, span and stop frequencies,
the reference level, the resolution
bandwidth (RBW) and video display
bandwidth (VBW), the attenuator
setting, whether or not the preamp is
switched in, the sweep time and so
on. But there seems to be no provision
to print out the control panel as well.
What I had to do in order to provide
the full screen grabs you see in this
review was resort to the old trick of
pressing the ‘Print Scrn’ key on the
keyboard when I wanted to capture a
grab and then switch to Photoshop to
paste the grab in from the Windows
‘clipboard’, after which I could save
it as a JPEG file.
Then I had to switch back to Signal
Hound, in order to continue testing.
80 Silicon Chip
It’s a bit clumsy and it would be
good if Signal Hound gave you an
option of saving and/or printing the
entire screen.
OK then, let’s look at the test results.
Overall, the SA44B meets its specs
with flying colours. For example, Fig.1
shows its noise floor at 4.000GHz,
with the input terminated in a 50Ω
wideband SMA termination, a sweep
span of 20kHz, a reference level of
-80dBm, an RBW of 13Hz, 0dB of input
attenuation and the SA44B’s preamp
switched in.
As you can see its DANL (Displayed
Average Noise Level) is very close to
-140dBm, with only the occasional
noise peak reaching about -124dBm.
And the DANL figures at lower fre-
quencies were even better. For example at 2.2GHz I measured a figure of
-150dBm, with only a very few noise
peaks reaching -140dBm (see Fig.2),
while at 1.5GHz and below it was
slightly better again (see Fig.3).
When I tried using the SA44B to
look at the output of my Gratten GA1484B signal generator at a frequency
of 1.000GHz and with the output
level set to -127dBm (100nV at 50Ω),
I achieved the display shown in Fig.4.
As you can see it shows the signal
peak as having a level of -128.3dBm,
which is pretty good when you consider I had connected the two together
with a 1m long SMA-SMA cable made
from RG-213 coax, with a loss of about
1.3dBm.
(When I substituted a 3m long RG213 cable, the SA44B showed a further
drop of very close to 2.6dBm.)
Next I tried connecting a tiny whip
antenna to the input of the SA44B,
placing the antenna right in the window of my office.
Then I did a scan centred on
1.575GHz, to see if I could pick up
any signals from passing GPS satellites. Fig.5 shows the result: I found a
peak of -122.3dBm at 1575.0046MHz,
according to the SA44B.
Finally, Fig.6 shows the result of
a further scan done with the SA44B
connected to an outside VHF-UHF
discone antenna. It reveals the capture
of an ADSB squitter at 1.090GHz from
a passing commercial airliner. (See
‘ADSB and Flightradar 24’, SILICON
CHIP August 2013).
Summarising
The USB-SA44B delivers a level
of performance that is well and truly
comparable with self-contained analysers costing many times its price.
Not only that, it also offers many of
the features of an SDR-based measuring receiver.
In effect, the hardware of the SA44B
and its matching software seem to have
been so well integrated in a functional
sense that they really can turn your
PC into a high performance spectrum
analyser.
So if you’d like to have the features
and performance of a 4.4GHz spectrum
analyser/measuring receiver but can’t
justify an outlay of $6800 plus, the
Signal Hound USB-SA44B is well
worth considering, especially at the
price (as we mentioned earlier, a shade
over $1300 including GST).
SC
siliconchip.com.au
R ockby Electronics
100MHz 2 Ch. 7-inch LCD Color Widescreen 12V 120W Folding Solar Panel
* In-built controller for direct
Digital Oscilloscope
500MHz Sa/S sampling rate
USB Host/Device: support USB Printer
30K points memory
Easyscope software
PictBridge function
and USB Flash Drive
$358.00
Includes 2 Probes
#41880
SIGLENT: SDS1102DL
30V 5A Programmable Digital Power Supply
* 5 Sets Of Parameters Can Be Stored
$107.80
PS-3005D
www.rockby.com.au
#41121
#42333
$229.00
96mm Wide Black Waterproof Gaffer Tape
* Gaffer / Duct / Cloth
Backing Material: PE(Polyethylene) cloth
Width: 96mm
Length: 50m
Colour: Black
Adhesion strength: 65N/mm²
Thickness: 0.165mm
$15.00
#42357
19mm 36kV EPR Self-Amalgamating tape
It is a simple single channel, constant-voltage and
constant-current Power Supply with low ripple and
noise, high reliability and high accuracy.
The unit comes with overload, short circuit &
overheating protection which meets the needs of
development, laboratory, training and production
applications.
Size(mm): 110x156x260
Weight: 5kg
charging to battery
Rated voltage: 12V
V at pmax: 18.0V
I at pmax: 6.98A
Open circuit volts: 21.6V
Lead length: 4.5m
Short circuit current: 7.72A
Weight: 13kg
* Length 10M
* EPR self-amalgamating tape
* Colour black
* Material rubber
* Material thickness 0.75mm
* Dielectric strength 36kV/mm
Manufacturer: Scapa
$9.00
#42336
* Also available with USB & Serial Interface #42316 $168.30
Soldering Iron Tip Cleaner and Holder
540W 350°C SMD Board Pre-Heater
Soldering tip cleaner made of low abrasive brass
shavings.
* No water necessary
* No temperature drop as in conventional sponges
* Cleans better than conventional sponges
* Anti-slip pad
Manufacturer: Pro’sKit
* Quick heating, up to 350°C only in 10s
* Working with AT reworking station to deal
with BGA and chip IC
Air flow max: 0.18m³/min
Ext. depth: 140mm
Ext. width: 170mm
Height: 55mm
Weight: 1.1kg
MFG: Tenma
$95.00
#42360
Thermometer Module -10 to 45°C
Large clear 20mm High LCD display ABS case
Range: -10°C to +45°C (14°F to +113°F)
1x LR44 (button cell) battery (supplied)
Size(WxHxD): 57 x 32 x 11mm
Weight: 19g
Manufacturer: ProSignal
#42370
$5.50
$7.50
#40946
$5.50
*
*
*
*
*
Overall Length: 175mm
Width: 15mm
Handle Material: Plastic
Bristle Material: Brassed steel wire
Contents: Two each of 175mm
brass, steel, nylon brushes
Manufacturer: Duratool
$3.50
Device: CA-10,4
* Ergonomic design
* 20mm coin cell battery or
2 x AAA batteries option
* Assembles with three screws
* Button membrane seals the
enclosure making it meet IP 66
Colour: Grey
#42350
$6.50
#42408
130mm Micro Precision Cutter
* Designed for fine assemble and adjustment operations on electronic circuits
* Made from high carbon steel
* Accurately machined
* Conductive handle
Manufacturer: Pro’sKit
#42454
30A Modular DC Connector Pack
$6.50
#40418
Empty Cable Storage Drum
You Receive 3 x Red & 3 x Black (Inc. Terminals)
*High current DC connectors as used
in automotive and industrial applications.
Can be dovetailed together for multi-pole
connectors. 30A rated.
* 6 Connectors in total *
$5.80
#42455
Rockby Electronics Pty Ltd
Showroom & Pick-up Orders:
56 Renver Rd. Clayton Victoria 3168
Ph: (03) 9562-8559 Fax: (03) 9562-8772
6 Piece Mini Wire Brush Set
#42359
An empty cable drum for storage and carriage of loose
connecting power leads and audio/video
cables.
Stores up to 50m of 1.5mm² cable
Colour: Yellow
Manufacturer: ProPower
$20.00
P.O Box 1189 Huntingdale
Victoria 3166
ACN# 006 829 821 ABN# 3991 7350 807
Order On-line
*Stock is subject to prior sale*
Web Address: www.rockby.com.au
Email: salesdept<at>rockby.com.au
For on-line ordering and other products see our web site www.rockby.com.au
R ockby Electronics
www.rockby.com.au
15A Quality Insulated Alligator Pack
Pack Inc. 2 x black & 2 x red
Slim crocodile clip made of brass
Jaw opening: 15mm
Overall length: 55mm,4mm Socket Entry
Volts: 300
Manufacturer: Testoon
* 4 Clips in total *
#42351
4 Button IP66 Hand Held Enclosure(Pk-2)
20V MU-45 Panel Meter
Type: MU45
Resistance: 20 KOHM
F/Size: 58 x 52mm
Overall depth: 40mm
Hole size: 45mm
$6.90
s
R ockby Electronics R ockby Electronic
www.rockby.com.au
R ockby Electronics
Completing, testing &
adjusting the . . .
Opto-Theremin
In Pt.1 last month, we described
how the Opto-Theremin works and
gave the assembly details for the two
PCBs. This month, we complete the
construction and describe the test
and adjustment procedure.
Pt.2: By JOHN CLARKE
T
HE OPTO-THEREMIN’S main
PCB is housed in a black UB1
plastic utility box measuring 158 x 95
x 53mm. This box is supported on a
timber plinth (or base) using threaded
rods and three 50mm lengths of 10mm
ID aluminium tubing.
The first step is to prepare the box
by drilling the various holes. We’ve
prepared a template (in PDF format) to
make this job easy. This can be downloaded (no charge) from the SILICON CHIP
website and printed onto plain paper –
browse to www.siliconchip.com.au and
then mouseover ‘Shop’, click ‘by Year/
Month’ and select the month.
While you are there, download the
front panel artwork and the drilling
templates for the timber plinth and
the smaller UB5 case. These can again
be printed onto plain paper but for a
better result, print the panel artwork
onto photographic paper.
82 Silicon Chip
Next, cut the case template sheet
into its various sections, then attach
the templates to the case (eg, using
adhesive tape) and drill the holes to
the dimensions indicated. Use a small
pilot drill to start the larger holes, then
carefully enlarge them to their correct
sizes using larger drills and a tapered
reamer.
Be careful not to over-enlarge the
10mm-diameter the hole for the antenna. The aluminium antenna tube
should be a tight fit into this hole.
Once the holes have all been drilled,
the main label can be affixed to the
lid using silicone sealant or a suitable
adhesive. Allow the adhesive to dry,
then cut out the various holes using a
sharp craft knife. The speaker can then
be secured to the inside of the lid by
smearing a suitable adhesive (eg, super
glue) around its outside metal frame.
Once the speaker is in place, it can
be fitted with a short figure-8 connecting cable terminated in a 2-way header
plug at the far end.
The main PCB is fitted into the box
by first tilting it down at the front, so
that the pot shafts and the switch can
be slid into their respective holes. The
M3 x 6mm SCREW
PCB
M3 TAPPED
9mm SPACER
M3 NUT
BOX
M3 x 10mm SCREW
Fig.7: here’s how to install the rear
spacer assemblies. No spacers are
required at the front of the case,
since the PCB is supported along
this edge by the two pot shafts.
siliconchip.com.au
rear of the PCB can then be pushed
down into the case, after which the
assembly should be secured in position by attaching the nuts to the pots.
Do the nuts up firmly, then mark out
the positions of the two rear mounting
holes on the base of the case (eg, by
hand-twisting a 3mm drill through the
PCB holes).
That done, remove the PCB and drill
these holes in the base out to 3mm.
There’s no need for corresponding
front mounting holes, since the PCB is
supported on this side by the pot shafts.
The rear spacer assemblies can now
be installed as shown in Fig.7. First, an
M3 x 6mm screw is inserted up through
the bottom of the case. This is then
secured with an M3 nut, after which
an M3 x 9mm tapped spacer is fitted.
Don’t reinstall the PCB yet – that
step comes later, after attaching the
case to the timber plinth.
(UB1 BOX & LID)
M5 OR 3/16"
NUTS
3 x 50mm
LENGTHS OF
10mm OD
ALUMINIUM
TUBING
M5 OR 3/16"
THREADED RODS
M5 OR 3/16"
NUTS
Making the timber plinth
A piece of 151 x 90 x 19mm DAR
(dressed all round) pine timber is used
to make the base – see Fig.8. Note that
Fig.8 is not to scale, so you should
download the full-size diagram from
the SILICON CHIP website and print it
out to use as a template.
Cut the timber plinth to size, then
round off the edges and the corners
using sandpaper. The paper template
can then be attached to the base and
the three holes drilled to accept either
M5 or 3/16-inch threaded steel rod
(zinc-plated).
Countersink the holes on the underside to allow the nuts to be recessed.
Fig.8 shows the cross-sectional view
(two rods only shown).
The timber base is now used as a
template to mark out the corresponding holes in the bottom of the case.
Drill these to suit the threaded rod,
then cut the threaded steel rod into
three 75mm lengths. You will also
need to cut three 50mm lengths of
10mm-diameter aluminium tubing, to
serve as spacers.
It’s a good idea to paint the timber
base black to match the box colour.
After that, it’s just a matter of attaching
it to the case using the 75mm threaded
rods, 50mm aluminium tube spacers
and nuts as shown in Fig.8.
Take care to ensure that the threaded
rod protrudes no further into the box
than the nut, otherwise it may later
short against the tracks on the underside of the PCB.
siliconchip.com.au
HOLES COUNTERBORED TO INSET NUTS
PINE TIMBER PLINTH MEASURING 151 x 90 x 19mm
50
mm
ME
D IA
NOTE: NOT TO SCALE
T
C
ER
LE
IRC
CL
CL
Fig.8: this diagram shows how the timber plinth is attached to the base of the
case using three 50mm lengths of 10mm-diameter aluminium tubing and M5
or 3/16-inch threaded rods. Note that this diagram is not to scale. A full-size
version can be downloaded from the SILICON CHIP website and used as a
drilling template for the plinth.
The PCB can now be reinstalled in
the case and secured to the previously
installed rear spacers using M3 x 6mm
machine screws. Tighten these screws
down firmly, then install the pot nuts
and fit the two knobs. If the knob
pointers are in the wrong positions,
prise the end caps off and refit them
so that they are correct.
Volume control case
The volume control PCB is housed
in transparent blue UB5 plastic utility box measuring 83 x 54 x 31mm. A
rectangular cut-out has to be made in
the base (which becomes the top) to
accept the distance sensor, while five
holes have to be drilled in one end for
the external wiring connections and
two threaded mounting rods.
As with the larger case, it’s just
a matter of attaching the drilling
template downloaded earlier and
then drilling the holes to the sizes
indicated. The rectangular cut-out is
made by drilling small holes around
the inside perimeter, then knocking
out the centre piece and filing to shape.
October 2014 83
The PCB is installed in the
case by first angling it down
at the front and sliding
the pot shafts and the
switch actuator into their
respective holes. The rear
of the board is then slid
down into position and the
PCB secured by doing up
the pot nuts and fitting the
screws to the rear spacer
assemblies.
Be sure to make this cut-out in the
base (not the lid). The case is later
attached to the main case with the
base facing upwards and the lid on
the bottom.
Refer now to Fig.9 to see how the
volume control case is attached to
the main case. The first job is to cut
two 62mm lengths of M5 or 3/16inch threaded rod plus two lengths
of 10mm OD aluminium tube.
These aluminium tube
pieces should be 50mm long minus the
width of the nuts used (eg, if the nuts
are 4mm wide, then cut two 46mm
tube lengths).
Once you have all the pieces, attach
the two threaded rods to the volume
control case as shown in Fig.9; ie, for
each rod, use a nut inside the case and
another outside the case. We used Nylon lock nuts (metal nuts with a Nylon
thread insert) because they each have
a rounded end that the aluminium
rod fits over and because they don’t
come undone.
The next step is to fit three straight
88mm lengths of 1mm-diameter steel
wire to CON5 on the volume control
PCB. These wires are then slid into the
holes in the end of the case (between
the nuts securing the threaded rods)
and the PCB clipped into place (ie,
into the integral ribs).
If you can’t get steel wire, use 1mmdiameter tinned copper wire. This can
be straightened by clamping one end
in a vice and then stretching it slightly
by pulling on the other end with a pair
of pliers.
Final assembly
The speaker is secured to the inside
of the lid by smearing super glue or
silicone around its outside metal frame.
84 Silicon Chip
The volume control case assembly
can now be attached to the main case
as follows:
(1) Cover the front threaded rod (ie,
at the bottom in Fig.9) with a length
of 6mm-diameter heatshrink tubing.
This heatshrink layer should cover
the entire length of the thread and
can be trimmed to size after shrinking
it down.
(2) Cut another length of heatshrink
tubing about 3mm shorter than the
aluminium tubing and add this to the
rod. Push it all the way up against the
nut at the volume control case end
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.9: the volume control case is attached to the main case using two lengths of
10mm-diameter aluminium tubing and M5 (or 3/16-inch) threaded rods and nuts
(see text). Three 88mm lengths of 1mm-diameter steel wire are then fitted to CON5
on the volume control PCB, after which the board is clipped into the case, with the
wires exiting via three holes between the threaded rod assemblies. These wires
feed into matching holes in the main case and are terminated in CON2. It’s a good
idea to insulate the middle wire with heatshrink tubing.
50mm
M5 OR 3/16" NUTS
(VOLUME CONTROL PCB INSIDE UB5 BOX)
(MAIN PCB INSIDE
UB1 BOX)
1mm DIAMETER WIRES
GP2Y0A41SK0F
CON5
CON2
SHARP
M5 OR 3/16"
THREADED RODS
10mm DIAMETER
ALUMINIUM TUBING
(LID OF UB5 BOX UNDERNEATH)
THREAD COVERED IN SLEEVING TO FIT
TIGHTLY IN HOLE – NO NUT USED
M5 OR 3/16" NUTS
This close-up
view shows how
the end of one
of the threaded
rods is covered
in heatshrink
tubing so that it
is a tight fit into
its matching
hole in the main
case – see Fig.9.
before shrinking it down.
(3) Repeat step 2, adding more heatshrink layers until the aluminium tube
is a firm fit over this threaded rod.
(4) With the aluminium tubes in place,
insert the three wires and the threaded
rods into the main case, with the ends
of the wires going into CON2. The
heatshink-covered rod should be a
tight fit into its hole.
(5) Secure the other threaded rod with
a nut on the inside of the main case.
(6) Tighten CON2’s screws to secure
the three wires in place.
Making the pitch antenna
The pitch control antenna is also
made from 10mm-diameter aluminium tubing. You also need an M4 x
10mm Nylon (or polycarbonate) screw
siliconchip.com.au
The volume control PCB is clipped into the
UB5 plastic case with the three 1mm-diameter
wires exiting through holes at one end.
and two M4 Nylon (or polycarbonate)
nuts.
First, cut a 450mm length of the
tubing and clean up the ends with a
file to remove any metal burrs. That
done, gently file each corner of one
of the M4 nuts until it fits tightly into
one end (ie, the top) of the antenna.
Once it’s in position, wind the second
M4 nut all the way onto the screw and
then screw this into the captive nut in
the antenna.
This translucent ‘top piece’ provides
the blue glow at the top of the antenna
when lit by LED3 on the main PCB
(ie, the blue LED that shines up the
antenna tube).
The other three blue LEDs (LEDs1,
2 & 4) light the base of the antenna.
As an option, these three LEDs can
be covered with a translucent, halfhemispherical, hollow ball that’s slid
over the antenna and pushed down
onto the lid of the main case.
A ball salvaged from an empty can of
roll-on deodorant is suitable. All you
have to do is cut the ball in half using
a fine-blade hacksaw, file the ends to
October 2014 85
An M4 Nylon (or polycarbonate) nut
is pushed into the top of the pitch
antenna after which a nylon M4
screw with captive nut is fitted. This
translucent assembly glows blue
when lit by the LED shining up the
aluminium tube.
The pitch antenna is pushed into
the two fuse clips on the main PCB
assembly (usually after the lid is
in place). LED3 is between the two
fuse clips and shines up the antenna
tube to light the translucent screw
assembly at the top.
a smooth finish and drill a 10mm hole
in the top. It’s then simply slid over
the antenna.
As previously stated, the bottom end
of the antenna is connected into circuit
by sliding it into the two fuse clips on
the main PCB. It may be necessary to
squeeze the lugs of these fuse clips
together slightly so that the antenna
makes a good contact. Rotating the
antenna a few times will also clean
the contacts if they oxidise over time.
For the time being, leave the lid
off the case and simply support the
antenna in its fuse clips. You are now
ready for the setting-up procedure.
Setting up
The adjustment procedure is as follows:
Step 1: fit link LK1 (near the equalising
coil) to the TEST position and LK2 to
the MAX position.
Step 2: connect a 9VAC plugpack or a
86 Silicon Chip
12V DC source, switch on and check
that all the LEDs light. If they don’t
light, check that they are orientated
correctly.
Step 3: connect a DMM set to read
DC volts between TPS (near IC2) and
TP GND and adjust trimpot VR4 for a
reading of 1.7V.
Step 4: connect the DMM between TP1
and TP GND and adjust the slug in
transformer T1 for a minimum reading (note: do not use a screwdriver as
this could crack the ferrite core. Either
use the correct plastic alignment tool
or grind down an old screwdriver so
that its blade is thicker than normal and
snugly fits the slot in the slug).
If you are unable to find the minimum, then either coil L1 has been
incorrectly wound or its leads haven’t
been soldered. Check the solder joints
and check also that the Nylon washer
spacers have been installed to provide
the required 2.5mm gap between the
two core halves.
Step 5: move your hand very close to
the antenna (but don’t touch it) and
adjust T1’s slug so that the voltage
slightly increases. When it does, move
your hand away from the antenna and
check that the voltage increases even
further.
If the voltage decreases instead, then
the slug needs to be rotated the other
way. On the prototype Opto-Theremin,
we adjusted T1’s slug for 1.1V with the
hand close to the antenna and 1.7V
with the hand away from the antenna.
Step 6: move jumper LK1 to the NORMAL position, connect the loudspeaker to CON4, set VR1 to mid-position
and set VR2 fully clockwise.
Step 7: adjust transformer T2 until a
tone is heard and set it for a low frequency. This tone should then change
if you move your hand away from T2
(and away from the antenna), so this
may take some trial and error.
Step 8: rotate VR2 anticlockwise and
check that the pitch can be adjusted
to just reach a point where there is no
sound. The frequency should then
become audible again and increase as
a hand is brought close to the antenna.
If not, reset VR2 fully clockwise again
and repeat Step 7, this time adjusting
T2’s slug in the opposite direction.
Note that these adjustments require
patience and you may need to repeat
the process several times before you
get it right.
Step 9: adjust VR1 fully clockwise,
then adjust trimpot VR3 to limit the
volume so that it isn’t high enough to
cause spurious vibrations or noticeable distortion.
Voicing adjustment
Trimmer capacitor VC1 must now
be adjusted to set the voicing. It’s just
a matter of tweaking it to obtain the
required sound from the Theremin.
Note that there will be a point
where, at the lowest frequencies,
there’s a ‘snap-on’ effect whereby
either no frequency is produced or
the tone suddenly snaps on and becomes audible with hand movement.
This occurs because inter-coupling
between the pitch and reference oscillators causes both oscillators to track
together and if there’s no frequency
difference between them, there’s no
audible output from the mixer. However, as a hand is brought closer to the
antenna, the pitch oscillator’s tuning
changes and it is eventually ‘pulled’
far enough to suddenly produce a
different frequency to the reference
oscillator.
Hand volume adjustment
The hand volume adjustments are
all done on the main PCB as follows:
Step 1: move jumper LK2 back to the
NORMAL position, then check that the
volume control has a suitable handmovement range. The volume should
increase as the hand is moved away
from the sensor and vice versa.
Step 2: if you want to change the range,
connect a DMM between TPS and TP
GND and adjust trimpot VR4 for a
reading that differs from the 1.7V set
earlier. Note, however, that if VR4 is
set to give maximum volume too away
from the sensor, the volume will rise
again at close range (ie, as the hand
is brought below 40mm). This is a
quirky effect of the sensor itself and
is cured simply by backing off the
setting for VR4.
That completes the adjustments.
You can now complete the unit by
attaching the lid to the main case
and reinstalling the antenna, with
the translucent dome slid all the way
down so that it covers the three LEDs.
Take care when fitting the lid to ensure
that the four LEDs go through their
corresponding holes. You will find it
easier to do this if you apply power so
that the LEDs are lit.
Finally, fit the lid to the underside
of the volume control box and your
Opto-Theremin is ready for action. SC
siliconchip.com.au
ONLINESHOP
SILICON
CHIP
PCBs and other hard-to-get components available now direct from the S
ILICON CHIP ONLINESHOP
NOTE: PCBs from past ~12 months projects only shown here but there are boards going back to 2001 and beyond.
For a complete list of available PCBs, back issues, etc, go to siliconchip.com.au/shop
IPOD CHARGER
AUG 2013 14108131
$5.00
PC BIRDIES
AUG 2013 08104131 $10.00
RF DETECTOR PROBE FOR DMMs
AUG 2013 04107131 $10.00
BATTERY LIFESAVER
SEP 2013 11108131
$5.00
SPEEDO CORRECTOR
SEP 2013 05109131 $10.00
SiDRADIO (INTEGRATED SDR) Main PCB
OCT 2013 06109131 $35.00
SiDRADIO (INTEGRATED SDR) Front & Rear Panels
OCT 2013 06109132/3 $25.00/pr
TINY TIM AMPLIFIER (same PCB as Headphone Amp [Sept11]) OCT 2013 01309111 $20.00
TINY TIM POWER SUPPLY
DEC 2013 18110131 $10.00
AUTO CAR HEADLIGHT CONTROLLER
OCT 2013 03111131 $10.00
GPS TRACKER
NOV 2013 05112131 $15.00
STEREO AUDIO DELAY/DSP + REVERB UNIT (Feb 2014)
NOV 2013 01110131 $15.00
BELLBIRD
DEC 2013 08112131 $10.00
PORTAPAL-D MAIN BOARDS
DEC 2013 01111131-3 $35.00/set
(for CLASSiC-D Amp board and CLASSiC-D DC/DC Converter board see Nov 2012/May 2013)
LED PARTY STROBE (also suits Hot Wire Cutter [Dec 2010]) JAN 2014 16101141 $7.50
BASS EXTENDER Mk2
JAN 2014 01112131 $15.00
LI’L PULSER Mk2 Revised
JAN 2014 09107134 $15.00
10A 230VAC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
FEB 2014 10102141 $12.50
NICAD/NIMH BURP CHARGER
MAR 2014 14103141 $15.00
RUBIDIUM FREQ. STANDARD BREAKOUT BOARD
APR 2014 04105141 $10.00
USB/RS232C ADAPTOR
APR 2014 07103141 $5.00
MAINS FAN SPEED CONTROLLER
RGB LED STRIP DRIVER
HYBRID BENCH SUPPLY
2-WAY PASSIVE LOUDSPEAKER CROSSOVER
TOUCHSCREEN AUDIO RECORDER
THRESHOLD VOLTAGE SWITCH
MICROMITE ASCII VIDEO TERMINAL
FREQUENCY COUNTER ADD-ON
VALVE SOUND SIMULATOR PCB
VALVE SOUND SIMULATOR FRONT PANEL (BLUE)
TEMPMASTER MK3
44-PIN MICROMITE
OPTO-THEREMIN MAIN BOARD
OPTO-THEREMIN PROXIMITY SENSOR BOARD
ACTIVE DIFFERENTIAL PROBE BOARDS
MINI-D AMPLIFIER
MAY 2014
MAY 2014
MAY 2014
JUN 2014
JUL 2014
JUL 2014
JUL 2014
JUL 2014
AUG 2014
AUG 2014
AUG 2014
AUG 2014
SEP 2014
SEP 2014
SEP 2014
SEP 2014
10104141 $10.00
16105141 $10.00
18104141 $20.00
01205141 $20.00
01105141 $12.50
99106141 $10.00
24107141 $7.50
04105141a/b $15.00
01106141 $15.00
01106142 $10.00
21108141 $15.00
24108141 $5.00
23108141 $15.00
23108142
$5.00
04107141/2 $10.00/set
01110141 $5.00
NEW THIS MONTH:
COURTESY LIGHT DELAY
DIRECT INJECTION (D-I) BOX
DIGITAL EFFECTS UNIT
OCT 2014
OCT 2014
OCT 2014
05109141
23109141
01110131
$7.50
$5.00
$15.00
Prices above are for the Printed Circuit Board ONLY – NO COMPONENTS OR INSTRUCTIONS ETC ARE INCLUDED! P&P for PCBS (within Australia): $10 per order (ie, any number)
PRE-PROGRAMMED MICROS
Price for any of these micros is just $15.00 each + $10 p&p per order#
As a service to readers, SILICON CHIP ONLINESHOP stocks microcontrollers and microprocessors used in new projects (from 2012 on)
and some selected older projects – pre-programmed and ready to fly!
Some micros from copyrighted and/or contributed projects may not be available.
PIC12F675-I/P
PIC16F1507-I/P
PIC16F88-E/P
PIC16F88-I/P
PIC16LF88-I/P
PIC16LF88-I/SO
PIC16F877A-I/P
PIC18F2550-I/SP
PIC18F45K80
PIC18F4550-I/P
PIC18F14K50
UHF Remote Switch (Jan09), Ultrasonic Cleaner (Aug10),
Ultrasonic Anti-fouling (Sep10), Cricket/Frog (Jun12) Do Not Disturb (May13)
IR-to-UHF Converter (Jul13), UHF-to-IR Converter (Jul13)
PC Birdies *2 chips – $15 pair* (Aug13)
Wideband Oxygen Sensor (Jun-Jul12)
Hi Energy Ignition (Nov/Dec12), Speedo Corrector (Sept13),
Auto Headlight Controller (Oct13) 10A 230V Motor Speed Controller (Feb14)
Projector Speed (Apr11), Vox (Jun11), Ultrasonic Water Tank Level (Sep11),
Quizzical (Oct11) Ultra LD Preamp (Nov11), 10-Channel Remote Control
Receiver (Jun13), Revised 10-Channel Remote Control Receiver (Jul13),
Nicad/NiMH Burp Charger (Mar14)
Garbage Reminder (Jan13), Bellbird (Dec13)
LED Ladybird (Apr13)
6-Digit GPS Clock (May-Jun09), Lab Digital Pot (Jul10)
Semtest (Feb-May12)
Batt Capacity Meter (Jun09), Intelligent Fan Controller (Jul10)
USB Power Monitor (Dec12)
GPS Car Computer (Jan10), GPS Boat Computer (Oct10)
USB MIDIMate (Oct11)
PIC18F27J53-I/SP
USB Data Logger (Dec10-Feb11)
PIC18LF14K22
Digital Spirit Level (Aug11), G-Force Meter (Nov11)
PIC18F1320-I/SO
Intelligent Dimmer (Apr09)
PIC32MX795F512H-80I/PT Maximite (Mar11), miniMaximite (Nov11), Colour Maximite (Sept/Oct12),
Touchscreen Audio Recorder (Jun/Jul 14)
PIC32MX150F128D-501P/T 44-pin Micromite (Aug14) (NEW!)
PIC32MX250F128B-50I/SP Micromite (May14) – also includes FREE 47F tantalum capacitor
PIC32MX250F128B-I/SP GPS Tracker (Nov13) Micromite ASCII Video Terminal (Jul14)
PIC32MX470F512H-I/PT Stereo Audio Delay/DSP (Nov13), Stereo Echo/Reverb (Feb 14),
Digital Effects Unit (Oct14)
dsPIC33FJ128GP802-I/SP Digital Audio Signal Generator (Mar-May10), Digital Lighting Controller
(Oct-Dec10), SportSync (May11), Digital Audio Delay (Dec11) Level (Sep11)
Quizzical (Oct11), Ultra-LD Preamp (Nov11), LED Musicolor (Nov12)
dsPIC33FJ64MC802-E/P Induction Motor Speed Controller (revised) (Aug13)
dsPIC33FJ128GP306-I/PT CLASSiC DAC (Feb-May 13)
ATTiny861
VVA Thermometer/Thermostat (Mar10), Rudder Position Indicator (Jul11)
ATTiny2313
Remote-Controlled Timer (Aug10)
ATMega48-20AU
Stereo DAC (Sep-Nov09), RGB LED Strip Driver [-20AU chip] (May14)
When ordering, be sure to nominate BOTH the micro required AND the project for which it must be programmed.
SPECIALISED COMPONENTS, SHORT-FORM KITS, ETC
NEW: DIGITAL EFFECTS UNIT WM8371 DAC IC & SMD Capacitors [Same components
also suit Stereo Echo & Reverb, Feb14 & Dual Channel Audio Delay Nov 14] (Oct14)
$25.00
AD8038ARZ Video Amplifier ICs (SMD)
For Active Differential Probe (Pack of 3)
(Sept 2014) $12.50
44-PIN MICROMITE Complete kit inc PCB, micro etc
MAINS FAN SPEED CONTROLLER - AOT11N60L 600V Mosfet
RGB LED STRIP DRIVER - all SMD parts and BSO150N03 Mosfets,
(Aug14)
$35.00
(May14)
$5.00
does not include micro (see above) nor parts listed as “optional”
(May14)
$20.00
HYBRID BENCH SUPPLY- all SMD parts, 3 x BCM856DS & L2/L3
(May 14)
$45.00
USB/RS232C ADAPTOR MCP2200 USB/Serial converter IC
NICAD/NIMH BURP CHARGER
(Apr14)
$7.50
(Mar14)
1 SPD15P10 P-channel logic Mosfet & 1 IPP230N06L3 N-channel logic Mosfet
$7.50
10A 230V AC MOTOR SPEED CONTROLLER
(Feb14)
$45.00
GPS Tracker MCP16301 SMD regulator IC and 15H inductor
SMD parts for SiDRADIO
RF Probe All SMD parts
(Nov13)
$5.00
(Oct13)
$20.00
40A IGBT, 30A Fast Recovery Diode, IR2125 Driver and NTC Thermistor
(Aug13) $5.00
Same as LF-UF Upconverter parts but includes 5V relay and BF998 dual-gate Mosfet.
P&P: FLAT RATE $10.00 PER ORDER#
PCBs, COMPONENTS ETC MAY BE COMBINED (in one order) FOR $10-PER-ORDER P&P RATE
LF-HF Up-converter Omron G5V-1 5V SPDT 5V relay
(Jun13)
$2.00
“LUMP IN COAX” MINI MIXER SMD parts kit:
(Jun13)
$20.00
Includes: 2 x OPA4348AID, 1 x BQ2057CSN, 2 x DMP2215L, 1 x BAT54S, 1 x 0.22Ω shunt
LF-HF UP-CONVERTER SMD parts kit:
(Jun13)
$15.00
Includes: FXO-HC536R-125 and SA602AD and all SMD passive components
CLASSiC DAC Semi kit – Includes three hard-to-get SMD ICs:
(Feb-May13)
$45.00
CS8416-CZZ, CS4398-CZZ and PLL1708DBQ plus an accurate 27MHz crystal and ten 3mm blue LEDs
with diffused lenses
ISL9V5036P3 IGBT Used in high energy ignition and Jacob’s Ladder (Nov/Dec12, Feb13) $10.00
2.5GHz Frequency Counter
(Dec12/Jan13)
LED Kit: 3 x 4-digit blue LED displays
$15.00
MMC & Choke Kit: ERA-2SM+ Wideband MMC and ADCH-80+ Wideband Choke
$15.00
ZXCT1009 Current Shunt Monitor IC
As used in DCC Reverse Loop Controller/Block Switch (Pack of 2)
(Oct12)
$5.00
G-FORCE METER/ACCELEROMETER OR
DIGITAL SPIRIT LEVEL Short form kit (Aug11/Nov11) $44.50
$40.00
(contains PCB (04108111), programmed PIC micro, MMA8451Q accelerometer chip and 4 Mosfets)
IPP230N06L3 N-Channel logic level Mosfets
As used in a variety of SILICON CHIP Projects (Pack of 2)
$7.50
*All items subect to availability. Prices valid for month of magazine issue only. All prices in Australian dollars and included GST where applicable. # P&P prices are within Australia. O’seas? Please email for a quote
10/14
PAYPAL (24/7)
INTERNET (24/7)
MAIL (24/7)
PHONE – (9-4, Mon-Fri)
eMAIL (24/7)
FAX (24/7)
To
Use your PayPal account
siliconchip.com.au
Your order to PO Box 139
Call (02) 9939 3295 with
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Your order and card details to
Place
silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Collaroy NSW 2097 October
with order &2014 87
credit card details
with order & credit card details
(02) 9939 2648 with all details
/Shop
siliconchip.com.au
Your
You can also order and pay by cheque/money order (Mail Only). Make cheques payable to Silicon Chip Publications.
Order:
YES! You can also order or renew your
SILICON CHIP subscription via any of these methods as well!
Rohde & Schwarz HMO1002 2-cha
While this is an ‘entry-level’ scope offering from Rohde & Schwarz,
it is clearly designed by people who use their own products. This is
reflected in the many simple but helpful features that they have built
in, which all add up to make a product that is pleasing to use.
T
he first thing you notice after unpacking this scope is how small
and light it is. It’s narrower than
a typical entry-level scope and very
easy to carry via the handle moulded
into the top of the case.
The screen isn’t tiny though; while
only 640 x 480 pixels it’s quite tall and
clear, with the controls packed quite
tightly to make the space on such a
small instrument.
It made a good impression when we
88 Silicon Chip
first powered it on as it was ready to
go within a couple of seconds. Some
scopes make you wait quite some
time before you can make the first
measurement but not this one. Also,
it’s unusually quiet because it doesn’t
have (or need) an internal cooling fan.
While that might seem like a minor
point, a fan droning away can get on
your nerves after a few hours of probing and testing.
While it is a basic scope, with two
channels and 50MHz of bandwidth, it
comes with a lot of standard features.
That includes a graduated display,
1Mpoints memory, excellent vertical
sensitivity of down to 1mV/division
with low noise, a built-in 50kHz signal
generator, a 50MHz pattern generator (more on that later), two-channel
three-digit digital voltmeter and the
ability to add eight logic channels and
hardware serial decoding/triggering.
The bandwidth can be upgraded to
siliconchip.com.au
annel Mixed Signal Oscilloscope
Review by NICHOLAS VINEN
70MHz or 100MHz at any time, via a
software key. There are also software
upgrades for the serial bus decoding
and triggering.
It is supplied with two switchable
1:1/10:1 100MHz probes. Switchable
probes are quite handy since they let
you get good bandwidth when you
need it (using 10:1) and high sensitivity when that’s more important,
without having to swap the probes.
User interface
The user inerface on this scope is
above average and clearly designed
by someone who has a lot of experience using a DSO/MSO (Digital/Mixed
Signal Oscilloscope). This includes
some features and capabilities that we
haven’t seen before, plus some clever
button layout and menu functions.
For example, the Fast Fourier Transform (spectrum analysis) function
has a dedicated front-panel button to
toggle it on and off, rather than being
hidden in a “Math” menu.
It’s one of the better scope-based
FFTs we’ve seen, automatically setting up the span, bandwidth and so
on to minimise the amount of fiddling
required to get a useful display. It can
also be enabled with the scope in ‘stop’
mode, based on data already captured,
which is quite handy. The FFT update
rate is also quite fast.
Another example is the “Quick
View” mode. At the press of a single
front-panel button, this displays the
currently selected channel trace (only)
along with various useful annotations
shown directly on the waveform; see
Fig.1. Here you can see the positive
and negative peak voltages, average
(mean), rise and fall times along with
cursors showing how these are calculated.
In Fig.1 you can see another feature
that we like, which is that this unit
can display up to six measurements
at a time, in the bottom-right corner
of the screen. Many scopes will only
show four measurements simultaneously. While that’s enough most of
the time, when examining multiple
Fig.1: “Quick View” mode is available at the press of a
button and shows several critical parameters superimposed upon the waveform from a single channel. Up to
six measurements are also shown (lower right corner).
siliconchip.com.au
signals, you can definitely run out and
it’s frustrating to spend a lot of time
fiddling with the measurements menu
to get around this.
As well as the usual measurements
(frequency, peak-to-peak voltage, RMS
voltage, etc) there are some interesting ones we don’t see very often on
a DSO. These includes crest factor,
edge/pulse count, trigger period and
trigger frequency.
These latter measurements allow
you to recognise how often the trigger
conditions are being met and therefore
how many waveform acquisitions
have been used to generate the trace
display.
The HM1002 has the usual waveform acquisition modes – sampling,
envelope (min/max), averaging and
the always useful ‘high-resolution’
mode, which they label ‘smooth’. It
also has a bandwidth limiting mode as
is usual; you can switch in a 20MHz
low-pass filter on each channel to remove spurious noise. But it also has an
adjustable low-pass filter mode which
Fig.2: the fast waveform update rate (up to 10k/sec) and
graduated display means that you can see variations in
repetitive signals in quite a bit of detail. This shows what a
square wave leading edge with jitter looks like.
October 2014 89
gives much more freedom in filtering
the signal and that’s less common.
The minimum filter frequency you
can select depends on the timebase.
For example, at 1s/div you can set
the -3dB point down to 5MHz while at
500ns/div it will go down to 10MHz.
This is a very handy feature when
looking at noisy signals. In those situations, you have four main options:
examine the unfiltered signal (limit by
the scope’s analog bandwidth), use the
20MHz filter, use the high-resolution
filter or use this adjustable filter. Each
has its own advantages.
Performance
The acquisition rate is 1Gsample/
sec for one channel or 500Msample/
sec for two, quite sufficient for a 50100MHz scope. Acquisition rate is
quoted at up to 10k waveforms per
second which is well above average
and in combination with the graduated display, quite useful for looking
at periodic waveforms which are not
fully consistent (see Fig.2).
Now, it used to be that basic DSOs
came with a very small storage space of
something like 8 or 16kpoints but that
has now changed and the HMO1002
comes with 1Mpoints as standard
(512k points per channel when using
both channels). That isn’t the biggest
we’ve seen but it’s certainly a decent
size. If you get the optional logic probe
head then there are 512kpoints storage
per channel for logic data too.
The HM1002 claims to have low
noise on its analog inputs and we have
to say we are impressed. Fig.3 shows
the display with both channels set to
1mV/div sensitivity, with channel 1
connected to the compensation signal
and channel 2 grounded. As you can
see, the traces don’t have much fuzz
and signal details well below 1mV in
amplitude are visible. This is shown
without any bandwidth limiting; filtering will make the traces even cleaner.
Pattern generator
This is quite an intriguing feature.
When developing circuits, we sometimes need to send serial packets to
various ICs to check that they are
working. For example, if the output of
a DAC chip is erratic, is it the signal
source that’s introducing errors or the
DAC itself? This sort of problem can
be frustrating to solve.
With this arbitrary 4-channel pattern generator, you can program the
scope to produce SPI, I2C, I2S, biphase
(S/PDIF) signals and so on, and inject
these into your test circuit. You can
then use the scope’s normal functions
to see how the circuit behaves. These
signals are available at hook lugs on
the front panel, to which wires can
be clipped.
Fig.4 shows an SPI-like pattern
that we set up in about a minute. You
can do this on the scope itself; it’s
a bit fiddly given the limited input
controls but it isn’t too difficult. For
more complex patterns such as message sequences, you can load the data
onto a USB drive using a PC and thence
into the scope. The pattern generator
runs at an adjustable frequency up to
50MHz.
Fig.3: the 1mV/div setting is very usable and this shows off
the low noise performance of the unit. For example, this
could be handy when examining low-level audio signals.
Many scopes will only go down to 5mV/div.
90 Silicon Chip
This would be great for determining
whether serial transmission speed is
an issue in your circuit, by having
the scope transmit the same message
constantly and then ramping up the
transmission speed until it becomes
garbled or unreliable.
Signal generator & DVM
These days scopes are increasingly
coming with these sort of functions
built in as they’re handy to have on the
test bench, without the clutter introduced with multiple test instruments.
The signal generator in the HM1002 is
rather basic but will serve a variety of
purposes. It will generate sine waves
up to 50kHz, square and triangle waves
up to 10kHz and so on with adjustable
frequency, amplitude, etc. Output is
via a front panel BNC connector.
The Digital Volt Meter provides
some functions not available with the
usual measurement modes as the values displayed are based on long-term
averaging rather than just whichever
portion of the waveform happens to be
on the screen at a given time. Having
said that, as with voltage measurements, you need to set up the vertical
scale correctly for the DVM reading to
make sense.
The DVM features in this scope are
better than many others we’ve tried.
For a start, you can display two readings per channel at a time. So for example you could display RMS voltage and
crest factor simultaneously. Another
nice benefit of the DVM feature is that
you can consider these readings as up
to four extra measurements that can be
Fig.4: the built-in pattern generator can be used to produce
digital or serial signals to inject into the device under test
while you measure other parts of the circuit. The scope
also comes standard with a 50kHz analog signal generator.
siliconchip.com.au
KEEP YOUR COPIES OF
Integrated with
the x1/x10 probe
(supplied) is this
compensation
network (right)
which adjusts the
signal overshoot
and undershoot.
displayed, meaning you can see up to
ten measurements at a time, while still
leaving a decent amount of space for
traces. That’s pretty good!
The DVM readings appear in one
corner of the screen; you can choose
which. In fact, many of the displays
in this scope can be turned on and off
or moved so that you can customise
the screen layout. For example, you
can turn the trigger and trace baseline
cursors on and off, the graticule on and
off, etc. You can fill the screen with
measurements or de-clutter it entirely;
whichever you prefer.
Some scopes (frustratingly) don’t let
you turn off displays that you don’t
need and which can get in the way.
This one thankfully gives you control.
Responsiveness & features
For a small, entry-level scope, the
user interface is definitely responsive. There are no obvious delays in
responding to button presses and the
screen refresh time is good. Too much
hardware these days is laggy (we blame
lazy programmers) and this can lead
to much user frustration. Luckily, the
HM1002 doesn’t fall into this trap.
There are a lot more features than we
have covered already. We don’t have
space to list them all. Pretty much
everything you’d expect to find on a
modern DSO is there. That includes
various trigger modes, mask testing,
XY mode, reference traces, zoom, roll,
cursors, frequency counter, waveform
maths and so on.
It even has a ‘component tester’
mode which injects some current into
a device under test (eg, a diode) and
does a quick current/voltage plot to let
you check whether the component is
working properly. We aren’t sure just
how useful this is in practical situations but it certainly doesn’t hurt to
have it available.
siliconchip.com.au
Build quality
The construction of the HM1002 is
a bit lightweight. As stated earlier, that
has some benefits and it’s certainly convenient to pick up and move around.
However the membrane buttons don’t
have the best possible feel. Also, many
of the illuminated buttons are so bright
that they bleed into adjacent buttons.
We’ve come across criticisms of
the scope’s 200V maximum peak input rating whereas other scopes may
have a 400V rating and therefore are
able to withstand direct connection to
mains. But if you’re going to be probing voltages that high, you should be
using a 10:1 or even 100:1 high-voltage
probe anyway. We’ll gladly except a
200V peak voltage rating in exchange
for the excellent low noise and high
sensitivity of this unit.
Conclusion & availability
The HM1002 is an easy and convenient scope to use. It’s the lightest and
most compact ‘proper’ MSO that we’ve
used and while its specifications are
relatively modest, it has a lot of nice
conveniences which make its usability
a cut above average.
Recommended retail price of the
HM1002 is $995.00 plus GST. A special introductory offer for SILICON CHIP
readers will also include the normally
optional SPI/I2C/UART/RS232 trigger
and decode function. The logic probe
will also be half-price.
For enquiries or to purchase a unit,
contact Rohde & Schwarz Australia at
(02) 8874 5100, e-mail them at sales.
australia<at>rohde-schwarz.com or
visit the product page at their website: www.rohde-schwarz.com.au/
en/products/test_and_measurement/
Oscilloscopes/HMO1002.html
Queensland customers should visit
their local agents, Madison Technologies (www.madisontech.com.au). SC
AS GOOD AS THE DAY
THEY WERE
BORN!
Magazines are
sneaky things:
left to themselves, they’ll
hide, they’ll get
crushed, folded,
spindled, dogeared, pages will
disappear . . . not
good when you
want to refer to an
article in the future.
ONLY
14 95
$
INC
GST
PLUS
p&p
A SILICON CHIP binder will
keep your copies in pristine
condition – and you’ll
always be able to find them!
* Each binder holds up to 14 issues
* Made from heavy duty vinyl
* Easy-fit wire inserts
ORDER NOW AT
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
MaxiMite
miniMaximite
or
MicroMite
Which one do you want?
They’re the beginner’s computers that the
experts love, because they’re so versatile!
And they’ve started a cult following around the
world from Afghanistan to Zanzibar!
Very low cost, easy to program, easy to use –
the Maximite, miniMaximite and the Micromite
are the perfect D-I-Y computers for every level.
Read the articles – and you’ll be convinced . . .
You’ll find the articles at:
siliconchip.com.au/project/mite
Maximite: Mar, Apr, May 2011
miniMaximite: Nov 2011
Colour MaxiMite: Sept, Oct 2012
MicroMite: May, Jun, Aug 2014
plus loads of Circuit Notebook ideas!
PCBs & Micros available from PartShop
October 2014 91
Vintage Radio
By Malcolm Fowler
The Mullard 5-10 Ten Watt Valve Amplifier
One of the finest amplifiers available for hobbyists to build in
the early 1960s was the Mullard 5-10 ultralinear valve unit. This
had state-of-the-art performance and a working example would
give a very good account of itself in comparison to the best valve
amplifiers now available.
I
N THE EARLY 1960s, I was fortunate
enough to attend a school in the UK
where the physics master was not only
a great teacher but a hifi buff, electronics whizz and semi-professional sound
recordist. These extra-curricular interests were put to good use in the running
of a radio club and the production and
recording of school plays and concerts.
Students involved in the radio club, of
which I was a member, were recruited
to build and operate an array of audio
equipment.
We had at our disposal several
Ferrograph tape recorders, a recordcutting lathe and a multitude of
Mullard-designed mixers, preamps
and power amplifiers. The majority
of the Mullard-designed equipment,
based on “Mullard Circuits for Audio
Amplifiers” published in 1959, was
built by the students and this was my
introduction to a lifelong interest in
audio and electronics.
Fifty years later and a wave of nostalgia had me thinking of revisiting
92 Silicon Chip
these valve amplifiers, not because
I prefer valve sound but just for the
delight of it and particularly the glow
of the valves. Solid-state may give great
sound but it lacks a certain charisma!
I initially looked into building a pair
of 10-watt Mullard 5-10s from scratch
but the availability and cost of components, particularly transformers,
seemed to rule this option out. Consequently, I started looking at vintage
amplifiers suitable for restoration such
as the Leak Stereo 20 but again cost
was an issue. Leak Stereo 20s typically
sell for well in excess of $1000 and
then need to be refurbished.
Aegis 5-10 amplifiers
After some research, I eventually
came across two dissimilar Aegis 5-10
amplifiers being offered for sale on the
Internet. On the spur of the moment, I
bought them, sight unseen, for far less
than the cost of a new mains transformer. I knew relatively little about
these amplifiers other than that they
were built by the Aegis Manufacturing Company in Melbourne in the late
1950s and early 1960s and that they
adopted the Mullard 5-10 amplifier
designs in their various formats.
These amplifiers could be purchas
ed new as individual units for £40/5/(forty pounds five shillings) in 1959.
They were also incorporated by other
manufacturers into high-end console
units.
My secondhand amplifiers, complete with all their valves, survived
the journey from Queensland to Melbourne via Australia Post. As mentioned, the two units were dissimilar,
both physically and electronically. The
first (Serial No: 378), which I shall refer
to as ‘Amp1’, was built on a single-level
steel chassis and was fitted with A&R
mains and output transformers. The
circuit was exactly to the Mullard 5-10
design for “Distributed Loading” (also
called ultralinear), where the screen
grids of the output valves are fed from
tappings on the output transformer.
siliconchip.com.au
Fig.1: the circuit of the Mullard (Aegis) 10W amplifier. V1 (EF86) is a voltage gain stage and this drives an ECC83 twin
triode (V2) operating as a phase splitter. V2 in turn drives two EL84 pentodes (V3 & V4) operating in ultralinear pushpull mode. Feedback is applied from the output of the speaker transformer back to the cathode of the EF86 pentode.
This configuration is used to achieve
a compromise between the performance of the two EL84s when connected as triodes and pentodes. Sufficient power reserve is maintained yet
distortion is much lower than with a
normal pentode connection.
The second unit (Serial No: A272),
which I shall refer to as ‘Amp2’, was
built on a stepped aluminium chassis
and was fitted with a National mains
transformer and a Barco output transformer. The circuit was exactly to the
Mullard 5-10 design for “Low Loading”
where increasing the cathode resistance
and lowering the anode-to-anode load
to 6kΩ results in a reduction in quiescent current from 36mA to 24mA.
This configuration is recommended
for use with speech and music as it
has low distortion and lower power
consumption. However, it cannot cope
with continuous sinewave inputs.
Both units came with passive tone
control modules built to the Mullard
specification. I had no interest in using these as from my experience they
only detract from the performance of
the main amplifier due to reduced
sensitivity and hum and noise pick up.
Checking the components revealed
that the main filter capacitors were
beyond redemption and most of the resistors were reading at least 20% high.
siliconchip.com.au
This view shows the two Aegis valve audio amplifiers and their associated tone
control units as purchased by the author. Both amplifiers required complete
rebuilds before they could be used (the tone control units were not restored).
The valves were tested by a friend and
were found to be serviceable but of
varying quality. The two power transformers tested as good, passing both
voltage and insulation tests with flying colours. The one disappointment
was that the A&R output transformer
on Amp1 had an open-circuit primary
somewhere deep within the winding!
Due to the state of the filter capacitors and the open-circuit output transformer on Amp1, no attempt was made
to power up either of these amplifiers
in their original state.
Decision time
The difference in output formats,
the failed output transformer and the
state of the components, wiring and
connectors made it clear that complete
rebuilds would be necessary to create
two functional matched amplifiers
for stereo use. I wanted to rebuild the
amplifiers in the ‘Distributed Load’
October 2014 93
offset the cost to some extent.
I would also need to purchase a full
complement of capacitors, resistors
and other hardware to complete the
renovation. I assumed at this stage that
the valves would be acceptable, at least
initially. I was hooked – it was certain
that I was going to proceed!
Purchasing the parts
These two under-chassis views show one of the Aegis amplifiers (Amp1) before
restoration (top) and after restoration (above). Note the turret board with the
valve sockets and other parts at the bottom.
This is the rebuilt turret board for Amp1. It was fitted with new valve sockets
and new capacitors, resistors and wiring. Note the spacers between the sockets
and the associated earth bus bar.
output format as this, in my opinion, is
the best of the Mullard alternatives. To
do this, I would need a new matched
pair of output transformers which
94 Silicon Chip
wasn’t going to be cheap. However, I
already had a purchaser in the wings
for the Barco ‘Low Loading’ output
transformer in Amp2 so this would
The biggest purchase decision involved the output transformers. After
some considerable research, I decided
to order a pair of Transcendar output
transformers from the USA. These
have an 8kΩ primary impedance,
screen grid taps at 40% and a power
rating of 30W. The transformers are
built to order and are very competitive
with locally equivalent products, even
with freight costs included.
The capacitors and resistors were
ordered from Digi-Key in one lot so
as to minimise the impact of shipping.
The reason I ordered from Digi-Key is
that I had a wide choice of well-known
brands, full specifications and in most
cases the prices were very competitive.
Add to that a shipping time of around
six days and it stacked up well.
I selected Panasonic EE series electrolytics for the filter capacitors, Vishay BC for the low-voltage electrolytics,
Cornell Dubilier for polyester film and
mica capacitors, Vishay Dale for the
wirewound resistors and Vishay BC for
all other resistors which were 1W 5%
metal film types. The required axial
format and working voltages limited
the choice of capacitors in certain
instances.
New Belton Micalex valve sockets
(fitted with skirts for the EF86) were
also ordered, while the wiring ordered
was stranded 22AWG hookup wire
from Alpha Wire. This wire, trademarked as ‘EcoWire’, is insulated with
a wall thickness of only 0.23mm PPE
(polyphenylene ether) and has a 600V
DC rating. It’s not cheap but it is great to
work with as the insulation, similar to
PTFE, is not affected by the heat of soldering and the overall diameter makes
it easy to fit into relatively tight spots.
Other hardware such as potentiometers, fuseholders, speaker terminals,
RCA sockets, switches and mains IEC
connectors came from my existing
stocks on hand.
Dismantling & preparation
Both amplifiers were completely
dismantled back to bare chassis and
siliconchip.com.au
Use Safety Fuses
Note that the fuseholders shown fitted
to these units are not recommended for
mains or other high-voltage (HT) work.
These days, mains safety fuses (eg, Jaycar SZ-2025 or Altronics S5977) should
be used to eliminate the possibility of
electric shock when removing the fuse.
all unnecessary connectors removed.
New holes were then cut as necessary
to provide for the speaker terminals,
volume control, RCA input socket,
IEC mains input, mains switch and
two fuseholders (mains and HT). The
remaining holes from previous fittings were blanked off with steel or
aluminium plate, depending on the
particular chassis.
The aluminium chassis was much
easier to work with but the rigidity of
the steel chassis made it the preferred
option. After a thorough degrease, all
metalwork was spray-painted, first
with primer and then “Old Gold”
hammertone finish enamel. The two
chassis were then put aside to allow
the paint to thoroughly harden.
The turret boards with valve sockets
incorporated were stripped down,
desoldered and all terminals cleaned
with a Dremel wire brush. The original valve sockets were removed by
drilling out the mounting rivets and
the boards given a final clean with
isopropyl alcohol.
It was my original intention to ‘restuff’ the old filter capacitors with
new, physically much smaller, 450V
DC capacitors. However, the cases
disintegrated during the removal of
the bases so that idea was shelved in
favour of new sub-chassis tag boards.
Rebuild
Once the components arrived, I reassembled the turret boards. The new
valve sockets were secured using M3
machine screws and nuts. The new
valve sockets didn’t have central spigots on which to mount a ground bus
bar, so I fitted spacers to the tagstrip
between each valve socket. A solder
tag was then fitted to the top of each
spacer to create a mounting point for
the bus bar. All ground connections
were made to this bus bar which itself
was earthed only at the input socket.
All the links were then installed
followed by the components, care
being taken to insulate long leads
siliconchip.com.au
These photographs show the two fully-restored amplifiers with their transformer
covers removed. Note that the fuseholders shown here are not the recommended
types for mains and high-voltage work (see panel).
where relevant. Once the turret board
was fully assembled, it was checked,
checked again and then checked again
– first against diagrams I had made of
the original installation, then against
the Mullard schematic and finally
against photographs I had taken of the
original board.
The new connectors, volume control, power socket and fuses were then
fitted to the chassis. The transformers
were then re-attached, albeit in a dif-
ferent orientation. It was necessary to
change the orientation so that the coils
of the mains transformers and the new
output transformers would be at 90° to
each other to minimise hum pick up.
I checked these locations by first
powering up each main transformer
and then connecting my oscilloscope
to an output transformer secondary.
The scope was then monitored while
I changed the orientation of the output
transformer. My conclusion was that
October 2014 95
The chassis of both units were completely re-sprayed, first with primer and then with “Old Gold”
hammer-finish enamel. The transformer covers were also re-sprayed to make them look like new.
orientating the output transformer at
90° relative to the mains transformer
made a big difference! On Amp2, it was
necessary to modify the transformer
cover slightly to accommodate the output transformer, as it was not possible
to re-orientate the mains transformer.
The turret boards were then reinstalled and the necessary connections
to the transformers, sockets and fuses
etc completed. The filter capacitors
and their associated dropper resistors
were assembled on a tagstrip close to
the original location for these parts.
Although a fiddly process, it was very
satisfying to see the end approaching.
The moment of truth
Once everything was complete, I
repeated the checking procedure – I
didn’t want expensive smoke coming
out of those new output transformers!
It was then time to fire up the first
amplifier. I set Amp1 up with a full
complement of valves and connected
an 8Ω dummy load to its output. I
then connected my multimeter to the
HT line and slowly ramped up the
voltage from the Variac.
First, the neon indicator in the
mains switch came on, then the valves
started to glow and the HT voltage began to increase. I increased the Variac
voltage to 180VAC and let it stay at
that for some time. It all seemed good;
there was no smoke and the voltages
looked about right. I then increased
the voltage to 240VAC and it all still
seemed to be OK.
The next step was to connect a
Links For Additional Information
Mullard Circuits for Audio Amplifiers – First published April 1959 (51MB PDF download):
www.basaudio.net/blog/wp-content/uploads/2013/01/19400164Mullard-Circuits-for-Audio-Amplifiers.pdf
Mullard 5-10 Amplifier: www.r-type.org/articles/art-003e.htm
Aegis Basic 10W Ultra-linear Amplifier: www.radiomuseum.org/r/aegis_ultra_
linear_basic_amp_510.html
Transcendar Transformers: www.transcendar.com/3.html
96 Silicon Chip
speaker and a signal source and much
to my satisfaction, undistorted sound
was the result. In short, it all seemed
to be performing correctly although
there was a little more background
noise than I would have liked – not
hum, just “white” noise. I then put
Amp2 through the same process with
the same result.
Once this initial trial was over, I
decided to check all voltages against
the Mullard specifications and run a
frequency response curve using TrueRTA software. It’s worth noting that
at this stage, both units still had their
original valves.
The voltages were largely in line
with Mullard’s figures. However, the
heater voltage in Amp1 and the HT
in Amp2 were a little too high for my
peace of mind. Another issue of note
was that the anode voltage on the EF86
and the corresponding grid voltage
on the ECC83 were about 20% low,
although the sound was fine and I was
assured that this was acceptable by
those ‘that know’. It was also thought
that this may be due to “tired” EF86
valves.
The frequency response at 1W using TrueRTA was within -2dB from
20Hz to 20kHz. The noise floor was
siliconchip.com.au
The completed valve amplifiers (one for each channel) are used in a stereo set-up with a pair of Celestion Ditton 15
loudspeakers. A CD player (not shown) is used as the signal source.
obviously higher than specification
at somewhere around the -54dB mark
(the specification is at least -75dB at
10W).
Tweaking & listening
The HT voltage in Amp2 was reduced to below 320V DC by installing a 195Ω resistor prior to the first
filter capacitor. A pair of back-to-back
Schottky diodes were also installed in
the heater supply of Amp1, thereby
reducing the heater voltage by 0.4VAC
to just below 6.3VAC overall.
It was always my intention to use
these two amplifiers in a stereo configuration, initially using a CD player as a
signal source and Celestion Ditton 15
loudspeakers which I had purchased
new in 1970. The input sensitivity of
each amplifier is 40mV for full output
and this needed to be attenuated to suit
the CD player’s output and to allow an
‘upstream’ remote motorised stereo
volume control to be included.
The suggested Mullard attenuation
for use with their 2-valve and 3-valve
preamplifiers proved to be just right.
This modification was made ‘downstream’ of the inbuilt volume control
which is really there for the purpose
of setting the balance between the two
amplifiers.
Subsequent listening tests proved
to be very satisfactory. The increased
background noise was annoying but
easily forgotten; I particularly liked
siliconchip.com.au
the sound of classical piano, violin
and solo vocals.
New valves
As the weeks went by, I really felt
that I had to install a new set of valves
of known quality to see what improvement could be achieved. I disappeared
into the world of ‘New Old Stock’
(NOS) valves, new manufacturers,
Mullard valves that aren’t Mullard at
all, JJs versus EH etc. It’s a whole new
world out there and most of the emphasis is aimed at guitar amplifiers where
they want controlled breakdown and
distortion and ‘musicality’!
Fortunately, there is another sector that is more focused on audio
and this tends to be where NOS is
hallowed and overpriced. A genuine
1956 Amperex Bugleboy ECC83 from
the Mullard Blackburn factory could
compete with Penfolds Grange in price
and desirability!
To cut a long story short, I managed
to obtain pair of NOS Tesla EZ81s
from Bulgaria, a pair of Siemens EF86
pentodes from Serbia, and a pair of
matched Raytheon ECC83 triodes
and matched pairs of Raytheon EL84
pentodes from the USA. These valves
were all produced in the 1960s, had
never been used and tested as new.
Interestingly, the Raytheon valves
were all originally produced in Japan
by Hitachi and branded as ‘Baldwin’,
for use in organs. I was told that only
the best valves were reserved for the
audio amplifiers in organs!
The new valves were installed and
the lack of background noise was immediately apparent; both amplifiers
now measured at better than -78dB.
I listened for many hours to run the
valves in and it was (and still is) a very
pleasant experience.
After about 40 hours, I rechecked
all the voltages. They were very close
to specification and identical between
Amp1 and Amp2. It still seemed to
me that the anode voltage of the EF86
was too low so I decided to reduce
the anode load resistor from 120kΩ
to 100kΩ. That increased the voltage
and slightly reduced the voltage gain.
I can’t say that I’ve noticed any difference in the sound but it makes me feel
better to be within the middle of the
specification rather than at one end!
I am satisfied that the amplifiers are
now complete. The covers have been
put in place and custom labels affixed.
A remote stereo volume control is
operational and I enjoy the listening
experience and the glow from the
valves. I make no claim that they sound
better than my Luxman L410 which I
love but they do make a very satisfying
SC
and alternative sound!
Acknowledgement: I would like to
acknowledge my physics teacher Dr
K. G. (Doc) Britton, Rydal School, UK
1941-1976.
October 2014 97
ASK SILICON CHIP
Got a technical problem? Can’t understand a piece of jargon or some technical principle? Drop us a line
and we’ll answer your question. Send your email to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au
Doubts about bass
response of the Majestic
Has anyone pointed out that the
low-frequency response given in
Fig.1 of the “Majestic” speaker article
is impossible with the Etone driver,
given its 3% efficiency and the size
of the enclosure? In the August 1976
edition of “Audio” magazine, W.J.J.
Hoge described a sub-woofer with
a 20Hz -3dB cut-off frequency and
1% efficiency. The enclosure volume
was 600 litres! You have published a
design that has around one third the
volume and three times the efficiency
with an unspecified cut-off frequency
somewhere below 20Hz.
Using equations from Richard
Small’s “Vented-Box Loudspeaker
Systems Part 1: Small-Signal Analysis” (Journal of the Audio Engineering
Society June 1973), for a completely
lossless system, with the alignment
of absolute maximum efficiency, to
achieve 3% efficiency and a -3dB
cut-off of 20Hz, an enclosure volume
of 1000 litres is required. Using Mr
Hoge’s design as a guide to practical
system efficiency, an enclosure upwards of 1800 litres is more likely. (I.
M., via email).
• Allan Linton-Smith replies: the
overall response of the system is not
just a result of the enclosure design. It
is also the result of the crossover network which was presented separately
in the June 2014 issue. The crossover
for the Majestic woofer has been deliberately designed for a 3dB point above
500Hz but the tweeter -3dB point is
around 4kHz while it is also heavily
attenuated.
In fact, as you can see from the
frequency response curve in Fig.1 on
page 24 of the June 2014 issue, the
woofer response is not flat to 20Hz
but drops off gradually from 100Hz
and the response dips at 1kHz. The
overall response is calculated as being
from 20Hz to 20kHz within +6dB and
-3dB, compared to the reference level
at 1kHz.
You might say we have combined a
low-frequency “hump” at 100Hz with
a tightly controlled tweeter to give a
commendably flat overall response.
In answer to your question of the
“unspecified cut-off frequency somewhere below 20Hz”, none of our Bruel
& Kjaer microphones are calibrated
below 20Hz so we could not justify any
measurement below this frequency.
We doubt any hifi speaker manufacturer would ever quote such a figure.
Having said that, the Audio Precision
impedance measurement in Fig.3 is
an electrical measurement (not a SPL
measurement) and indicates that there
is a significant resonance at 10-12Hz.
This undoubtedly demonstrates that
there will be some sound (albeit in
audible) present at this wavelength.
Unfortunately, mathematical calculations based on simplified systems can
often be wrong when you are dealing
with multiple or innovative design
features. We do not doubt your calculations show that it is “impossible”
but there are a lot of unknowns. For
example, the Thiele-Small parameters
quoted by manufacturers can often be
way out, especially Fs and Vas figures,
and don’t forget damping factor, cone
compliance, stiffness and other unknown variables.
The overall result is mainly due to
a combination of small improvements
we incorporated through hard work
and trial and error and we can theorise all day about the cabinet volume
“seen” by the woofer but cannot always
explain this mathematically. However,
we do know that it works and our
response curves are as accurate as our
measurement system will allow.
Can Majestic be built
with a bottom panel?
The adjectives describing the Majestic Loudspeaker System in the June
Performance Likely To Suffer If Cabinet Is Changed
I love speaker projects and it’s
great to see a really big one like the
Majestic system featured in the June
& September 2014 issues. However,
I have a quick question. The woofer
specifications don’t list an Xmax
(maximum cone excursion) that I
can find. I was wondering how it
would actually handle cone excursions at the higher power levels as
it may be limited there rather than
what the motor (voice coil etc) can
handle power wise.
I was looking to make a much
slimmer, taller and deeper box and
would start with a simple one-port
98 Silicon Chip
design since what was published is
well beyond my capabilities with
horns etc. However, not being able
to model the excursion (I use WinISD alpha) is putting me off. (A. G.,
Brisbane, Qld).
• Allan Linton-Smith replies:
Etone do not specify Xmax for that
particular driver but I have driven it
to a measured 300 watts RMS with
music (hard rock) and it handled it
with ease!
The actual construction of the
Majestic is easier than it looks!
The internal carcase (Bunnings 450
base cabinet) can be constructed in
a couple of hours but if you change
the dimensions you will not necessarily get the same result.
If 300 watts is not enough for you
and you need power handling up to
1000 watts RMS at 97dB/watt <at> 1
metre then you might like to consider
spending a little more and use the
Celestion 15-inch 28/FTR15-4080FD
which fits exactly in the hole we
recommended for the Etone 1525.
This has an Xmax of 6mm and
we have also tested this speaker at
high power levels successfully. You
can purchase this driver from www.
elfa.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
2014 issue were so impressive that I
had to build and try them. While we
wait for the replacement horn design, I
would like to ask a question about the
bottom of the speakers.
From the original article, in the base
there is a port with a hyperbolic plywood structure which indicates that
the speakers are designed to sit on the
floor, supported by the cabinet sides
and rear pieces. What if the speakers
were to be mounted on a wall? Is it
just a simple matter of adding a solid
base panel? (C. W., Newcastle, NSW).
• Yes, you can build the Majestic with
a bottom panel but that will increase
the overall height of the enclosure.
Wants scaled-down
version of Majestic
I read the article on the Majestic
loudspeaker in the June 2014 issue
with interest. They look great as are
their stated specifications but I don’t
like the $1300 price tag. I understand
they are significantly cheaper than
other similar speakers on the market.
With that said, I wonder if it would
be possible to produce a scaled-down
pair of good-quality speakers that
may end up being able to be made
for around $600? I understand that
the quality and specifications would
probably be reduced proportionately.
The speakers would be 2-way and I
imagine that the Majestic’s crossover
network would be used. The scaleddown speakers could, perhaps, be
called “The Jestors” because they aren’t
quite majestic but are watered-down
impersonators instead. A reduced
price tag would also make them attractive to a larger segment of the
population.
• It may be possible to do a scaleddown version of the Majestic but it
really depends on the available woofers and their Thiele-Small parameters
as these are primarily what determine
the enclosure dimensions for the lowfrequency response. We would not
necessarily use the same crossover
network. However, it is extremely unlikely that a smaller driver and cabinet
would result in a frequency response
down to 20Hz. That was one of the key
performance factors we were striving
for. In fact, we were hoping to get down
to around 25Hz but we comfortably
exceeded that.
Mind you, the main component of
the Majestic cost is the cabinet with
siliconchip.com.au
Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller
I made the Wideband Oxygen Sensor Controller from the September
& October 2009 issues, tested it and
made the setting as described on the
magazine. The readings are all OK
and it’s generally working fine.
However, near the stoichiometric
point, there is an oscillation which
should not be there. The reading is
smooth right until the stoichiometric
point, then it jumps all over at this
point and past that it’s smooth again.
I see this behaviour on some other
wideband controllers. Some have it,
some don’t. How can this be fixed
in the SILICON CHIP design? (M. K.,
via email).
• You can adjust the display response by increasing the value of
the capacitor at the input to the
wideband output buffer (IC2c). The
original capacitor is 220nF at pin 10.
You can increase this to, for example,
10µF (with the plus lead orientated
so it connects to pin 10 of IC2c).
This will slow the response time to
around one second.
Changes around the stoichiometric point can be simply due to
the way the vehicle’s engine works
at stoichiometric. When using the
wideband controller, the wideband
sensor replaces the original narrowband sensor and the narrowband
output from the wideband controller
is then used to simulate the narrowband sensor for the vehicle engine
management computer (ECU).
The air/fuel ratio will oscillate
at stoichiometric since that is just
its high-quality finish. There is nothing to stop constructors from building
their own cabinets and thereby saving
a large amount of money.
Optimising damping
in the Majestic
I have a minor question regarding
the Majestic Loudspeaker System. I
understand that sometimes bass reflex
designs can include the series resistance of the inductor for optimising the
damping. Is this the case with your
design? (It’s easy to add three parallel 3.9Ω resistors as replacement if
required). (J. E., via email).
• We are not sure what you mean by
the way the vehicle’s ECU works
with a narrowband sensor (or signal
from the wideband sensor). That is
because the signal is essentially a
switch in voltage for mixtures rich
and lean from stoichiometric.
The engine is operated at slightly
lean mixtures when the narrowband
sensor signal output goes above
0.45V and slightly rich when the
sensor output signal goes below
0.45V. This occurs over typically a
one second period.
The oscillation occurs when the
mixture control is in closed loop
operation, where the ECU attempts to
maintain the stoichiometric mixture
about the threshold voltage (typically
0.45V) of the sensor between rich
and lean. Outside closed loop (open
loop), the mixture goes to rich or lean
with values that are a function of
predefined conditions stored in the
ECU’s memory and it does not rely
on the oxygen sensor.
This rich/lean oscillation at stoichiometric is typical of all vehicles
that originally used a narrowband
oxygen sensor. New vehicles that are
designed to use a wideband sensor
do not oscillate the mixture at stoichiometric.
By the way, we published an improved Wideband Oxygen Sensor
Controller in the June-August 2012
issues. You can see a 2-page preview
of the June 2012 article at www.
siliconchip.com.au/Issue/2012/June/
Wideband+Oxygen+Sensor+Contro
ller+Mk.2%2C+Pt.1
“include the series resistance of the
inductor”. In fact, for optimum damping of the woofer, it is important that
the resistance of the inductor is as low
as possible.
Possibly, you are referring to the
technique of “impedance equalisation” that’s often employed in the
network to the woofer. This takes the
form of a series capacitor and a resistor (equal to the DC resistance of the
woofer), which is then connected in
parallel with the woofer.
The combination of this RC network
and the woofer is a special case of a
parallel tuned circuit which behaves
like a resistor. It effectively cancels
the inductance of the woofer itself and
October 2014 99
Water Cooler Causes EM Interference
Some time ago, I began using
bottled water from a bench-top
dispenser of the type that utilises
a large plastic bottle on top. My
family appreciates the ability of the
dispenser to cool the water.
I believe the cooling system
uses a Peltier Effect thermoelectric
device. This cooling system may
be switched on or off. When it is
switched on, a small fan also operates. I believe its task is to remove
the heat from the Peltier device.
My problem is that when the
cooling unit is switched on it causes
radio interference to the extent that
the radio is unintelligible. This interference is transmitted back through
the house wiring and is also radiated
through the air. This is evidenced by
the fact that two radios were used to
check the situation. One was mains
powered (about 10 metres from the
source) and the other a battery operated unit about three metres from
the source.
Any suggestions would be very
welcome as I would like to solve the
problem before the warmer months
arrive. (G. H., via email).
• We suggest you try fitting one
or two clip-on ferrite filters to the
power cord (available from eBay and
elsewhere). Failing that, try using a
power board with an in-built filter.
This strategy assumes that the interference is radiated by the mains wiring in your home. However, the unit
itself may be radiating interference
and that will require modification
to the drive circuitry for the Peltier
device or more effective shielding.
prevents it from reducing the required
treble roll-off in the crossover.
We have not employed impedance
equalisation in the Majestic because
the 15-inch woofer naturally rolls
off its high-frequency response quite
rapidly above 2kHz.
for values between about 10nF and
1µF and are suitable in applications
where linearity isn’t critical, such as
bypassing and AC-coupling.
The term MMC now seems to being
supplanted by “MLCC” which stands
for multi-layer ceramic capacitor.
What are MMC
capacitors?
Can DVD motors be
run as steppers?
Excuse my ignorance but I am having difficulty locating some capacitors
for a project of yours. What does MMC
mean with regards to a capacitor. Your
2.GHz frequency counter project (SILICON CHIP, December 2012, January &
February 2013) calls for 25 100nF
through-hole MMC caps and five 10nF
through-hole MMC caps.
I have tried different suppliers but
it’s very confusing as to the correct
type. Are they metallised polyester?
(E. B., via email).
• MMC stands for “Monolithic Multilayer Ceramic”. This type of throughhole ceramic capacitor is normally
encapsulated in plastic (usually blue
or yellow), as opposed to the disc type.
Ceramic disc, metallised polyester
or polyester film capacitors would
also likely work for this project and in
just about any other situation where
multilayer ceramic capacitors are
specified. The main reason we specify
MMC capacitors is because they are
the cheapest non-polarised capacitor
Does anyone at SILICON CHIP know
how the disc drive motors in DVD
burners are wired internally and can
the Mini Stepper Motor Controller featured in the May 2002 issue be modified to drive them? (B. Z., via email).
• DVD motors cannot be used as
steppers. We have a comprehensive
article on converting such motors
into high-power brushless motors
in the July 2012 issue. You can see a
2-page preview of the article at www.
siliconchip.com.au//Issue/2012/July/
Modifying+CD-ROM+Motors+For+
High+Power+Operation
100 Silicon Chip
Cleaning up a composite
video sync signal
Have you ever published a composite video sync reinsertion project
or kit?
We need to clean up the video signal
coming out of an 1980s industrial control panel so that a modern monitor can
be used. There is virtually no vertical
sync; the monitor says “no signal”. (H.
R., Plymouth, NZ).
• Although intended to clean up
Macrovision signals in the composite
video on video tape, the Dr Video Mk2
from the June 2004 issue (or Dr Video
from April 2001) should also clean up
the sync signal.
Power tool soft starter
is not working
I have had much pleasure in constructing the Soft Starter For Power
Tools (SILICON CHIP, July 2012) and am
confident that it complies with the design. Regrettably, when I connected it
to my 9.5-inch circular saw, I detected
no discernible difference in the tool’s
performance. It does not wind up, ie,
start off slower than normal. The motor just kicks off at full speed as usual.
I appreciate how difficult it would
be to diagnose a problem from a feeble
complaint that a kit constructed by a
hobbyist failed to perform but I am
hoping you may be able to direct me to
a likely or common cause for this. Or
perhaps you can provide me with some
clue to assist with the diagnosis (eg,
check that both thermistors heat up).
I would dearly like to have this
addition to my workshop and would
appreciate any advice you might offer.
(D. R., via email).
• It could be that the relay contacts
are fused shut or that the circuit activates the relay immediately without
the delay. A fused contact can be diagnosed by measuring the resistance
across the contacts.
For the circuit, check that the 220nF
capacitor is soldered in correctly (ie,
no dry joints) and that all parts are
correctly positioned on the PCB. Using
the correct value resistors across the
comparator inputs is important. If you
use a socket for the LM339 check that
all the pins are inserted in the socket
and not bent in underneath.
You should check that the thermistors are about 10Ω each when cold.
Check also that the Neutral in and out
wiring is correct.
Doubts about
battery life extension
I am sceptical about a battery sulphation prevention device being promoted at http://digitalpulsegenerator.
com.au/ Is it likely to be effective?
At another website – http://battery
siliconchip.com.au
Dim Digits On The GPS Clock
About five years ago I built the
6-Digit GPS Clock (SILICON CHIP,
May & June 2009). Early this year
the large digits were each becoming
quite dim and now cannot be read
during daytime and are even too dim
to be seen properly at night from the
rear of my small house.
Have you come across this problem and if so what could be wrong?
It is expensive to replace them but
I can’t think what else could cause
the dimming. (R. B., Flaxton, Qld).
• We haven’t come across this problem before and as far as we know
most of the 6-Digit GPS Clocks are
still running at full original brightness. This includes our original
prototype which has been running
continuously since about March
2009. It has the ‘autodim’ mod
ification (SILICON CHIP, September
2009) but in daylight it still runs
university.com/learn/article/sulfation_and_how_to_prevent_it – there
is discussion on the different types of
battery sulphation (hard or soft) and
how soft sulphation can be reversed
by an over-charge to 15V or 16V (for
a 12V car battery) for 24 hours. Is any
of this really valid? (D. M, via email).
• This device looks like it could be a
permanently fitted version of our Battery Zapper published a few years ago.
It probably won’t do any harm but as
the discussion in your following URL
shows, most of the deterioration in
car batteries is caused by the fact that
they are never fully charged. Short of
having a 3-stage charger permanently
connected to your battery whenever it
with the original brightness.
You don’t actually mention whether you fitted the autodim circuit
but it’s possible that if you did so,
your dimming problem might be
due to the LDR light sensor on this
add-on board having drifted quite
significantly in value. This seems
much more likely than any other
component having become faulty or
changed in value – or the ‘large digit’
LEDs having ‘worn out’ or otherwise
dropped in efficiency.
So if you have fitted the autodim
modification board, try replacing
the LDR as your first step in tracking
down the cause of your problem.
If that doesn’t work, you might
try replacing some or all of the LED
segment driver transistors (Q8-Q14)
and perhaps digit driver transistors
Q15-Q18, as one or more of these
may have become faulty.
is stationary, the next best thing would
be to have a float charger connected
when the car is garaged.
Even so, the idea that any approach,
including the digital pulse generator,
can increase battery life by up to three
times is ridiculous. Most car batteries
will typically last about four or five
years without any special care, before
they need replacement. And even if
you do everything right and you are
religious about connecting a float
charger, anything over six or seven
years can be regarded as exceptional.
We would also be very wary about
putting a battery on a charger at 16V
for 24 hours. That is likely to cause
severe gassing and will substantially
MISS THIS ONE?
Published in Dec 2012
2.5GHz 12-digit
Frequency Counter
with add-on GPS accuracy
Wow! 10Hz - >2.5GHz in two ranges;
1us - 999,999s with a 12-digit LED display.
It’s a world beater and it’s the perfect
addition to any serious hobbyist’s bench –
or the professional engineer, technician,
in fact anyone who is into electronics!
You’ll find it one of the handiest pieces of
test gear you could ever own and you can
build it yourself.
All the hard-to-get bits (PCBs, micros,
LEDs, panels, etc) are available from
the SILICON CHIP PartShop.
You’ll find the construction details at
http://siliconchip.com.au/project/2.5ghz
PCBs, micro etc available from PartShop
heat the battery and boil off a good deal
of water. That will definitely cause a
drastic reduction in battery life.
60Hz transformers can
saturate with 50Hz mains
My friend, a local manufacturer of
Aspen power amplifiers, has had problems with poor quality transformers
imported from China and sold locally.
The core was saturating and resultant
harmonics imposed on the rails were
audible. Could you write a warning
WARNING!
SILICON CHIP magazine regularly describes projects which employ a mains power supply or produce high voltage. All such
projects should be considered dangerous or even lethal if not used safely.
Readers are warned that high voltage wiring should be carried out according to the instructions in the articles. When working on these projects use extreme care to ensure that you do not accidentally come into contact with mains AC voltages or
high voltage DC. If you are not confident about working with projects employing mains voltages or other high voltages, you
are advised not to attempt work on them. Silicon Chip Publications Pty Ltd disclaims any liability for damages should anyone
be killed or injured while working on a project or circuit described in any issue of SILICON CHIP magazine.
Devices or circuits described in SILICON CHIP may be covered by patents. SILICON CHIP disclaims any liability for the infringement of such patents by the manufacturing or selling of any such equipment. SILICON CHIP also disclaims any liability
for projects which are used in such a way as to infringe relevant government regulations and by-laws.
Advertisers are warned that they are responsible for the content of all advertisements and that they must conform to the
Competition & Consumer Act 2010 or as subsequently amended and to any governmental regulations which are applicable.
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 101
Soft Starter For 110VAC Power Tools
I found your article/plans/etc for
the Power Tool Soft Starter (SILICON
CHIP, July 2012) and I have a tool
that really needs this but I am in
the USA where we use 110VAC at
60Hz. My saw is rated for 110VAC
at 15A (max).
Do you think I could make it work?
I’ve tried checking with others and
they said the limiting factor was
10A and that would be the limit at
110VAC as well. (P. T., via email).
• This question has been asked before and we have had reports of success. However, there is some concern
since the components, including the
PCB, are under about twice as much
heat stress at 15A as they are at 10A
(it goes by the square). However, we
think there is enough safety margin
built into the design for it to still be
reliable.
These are the modifications you
need. First, change the 330nF X2
capacitor to 680nF X2. You should be
able to find one which fits the board
however be careful since there may
be some 680nF X2 capacitors that
are larger than the space allocated.
Suitable capacitors will have a pin
spacing of either 0.6-inch or 0.9-inch
and will be no more than 0.4-inch
wide and 1-inch long. Given the
higher frequency (60Hz vs 50Hz),
it’s possible that a 470nF capacitor
will work but it’s hard to say for sure;
try the higher value first, if possible.
The other issue is current-handling. Our 230VAC power outlets
are generally rated at 10A giving a
maximum power of 2.3kW while we
believe that North American power
outlets are rated at 15A, giving a
power of up to 1.8kW at 120VAC.
article to aid in proper selection?
It is worth mentioning that only
using toroidal transformers from local
company Harbuch solved the problem
entirely. (J. D., via email).
• Thanks for your suggestion but
we have no-one on staff who is experienced in this area of transformer
design.
We referred the question to Harbuch Transformers (who have been
in contact with Aspen). Harbuch state
that typical problems with overseassourced transformers relate to the fact
102 Silicon Chip
Power tools running at 120VAC will
draw nearly twice as much current
as those running from 230VAC for
the same power rating.
The unit is designed to handle up
to 10A. The specified relay is rated at
16A, the NTC thermistors at 15A and
the shunt at 14A (2W) or 17A (3W) –
note that the shunt was accidentally
left off the parts list. It should be a
2512 SMD chip resistor, 0.01Ω, 2W
or 3W. So if you use a 3W shunt, the
circuit should handle 15A however
we have not tested it at that current.
The biggest limitation on current
handling is the current carrying capabilities of the PCB tracks. The design
uses the top and bottom layers in
parallel where possible so should in
theory be able to handle 15A. However, they are thinner than ideal in
some places for such a high current.
In short, if you change the X2 capacitor to 680nF and use a 3W shunt,
it should work. You should definitely
fit a fast-blow fuse rated at no more
than 15A to protect the PCB tracks in
case of a short on the output.
Jaycar and Altronics both have kits
for this design – see www.jaycar.com.
au/productView.asp?ID=KC5511
and www.siliconchip.com.au/Shop/
Altronics/K6043
You will need to substitute appropriate mains power cables. The
easiest way to do this is simply get an
extension cord with about the right
cable diameter and an earth pin and
cut it in half. Obviously it needs to
be rated with a high enough current
to run power tools.
You can then order the two other
replacement parts from a local source
such as Digi-Key or Mouser. The folthat they are designed for a primary
voltage of 220VAC or 230VAC and
60Hz rather than for Australian mains
voltages which are 50Hz and which
can typically range from 230-250VAC.
The net result is often core saturation,
poor regulation and undesirable hum.
Arduino VHF/UHF
scanner wanted
Can you make a Scanner VHF/
UHF Tuner Project? Old TV & VCR
tuners are free and so are old AM/FM
lowing parts should be acceptable:
(1) Digi-Key:
www.digikey.com/product-detail/
en/ECQ-UAAF684M/P14784-ND/
2674016
www.digikey.com/product-detail/en/CRA2512-FZ-R010ELF/
CRA2512-FZ-R010ELFTR-ND/
1775029
(2) Mouser:
http://au.mouser.com/ProductDetail/
Panasonic/ECQ-UAAF684M/?qs=sG
AEpiMZZMv1cc3ydrPrF6ifjA0FxyZ
BChh3r6S1vU8%3d
http://au.mouser.com/ProductDetail/
Bourns/CRA2512-FZ-R010ELF/?qs=
sGAEpiMZZMtlleCFQhR%2fzcj8n2
8v3AVE14N6Jrqfgps%3d
Substitute these two parts in the
kit plus the new mains cables and
it should be suitable for use at 110120VAC.
Note that our wiring instructions
are for Australian mains wiring
standards which is brown for Active,
blue for Neutral and green/yellow
striped for Earth. Your cable will
most likely be black and/or red for
Active (ie, Line) white for Neutral
and green for Ground. So we suggest
you double-check that the wiring is
correct before plugging it in.
There is one caveat: a constructor
reported that the recycle time (ie,
how long to wait between successive restarts to get the full soft start
effect) was longer than we originally
stated at 60s. We think this is due to
the higher operating current causing
the thermistors to heat up faster. In
theory, this could be improved by
adding more thermistors in a series/
parallel combination but we doubt
that they could be easily fitted.
car radios. You could use them in an
Arduino-controlled radio scanner.
A TV tuner takes in RF signals in
the 50-861MHz range and converts
them to an IF between 36MHz and
46MHz for the IF output. So can you
use an old analog TV tuner as a VHF/
UHF scanner? Possibly you could try
programming an Arduino to control
the Phase Locked Loop (PLL) if the
TV tuner is a PLL type.
As a do-it-yourself home hobbyist, I
do not have the radiocommunications
test equipment needed to set the intersiliconchip.com.au
MARKET CENTRE
Cash in your surplus gear. Advertise it here in SILICON CHIP
FOR SALE
Audio + Video: Professional quality
Quest AV brand equipment is made
and sold in Australia exclusively by
Quest Electronics. Ph 0431 920 667.
sales<at>questronix.com.au
PCB MANUFACTURE: single to multi
layer. Bare board tested. One-offs to
any quantity. 48 hour service. Artwork
design. Excellent prices. Check out our
specials: www.ldelectronics.com.au
LEDs: BRAND NAME and generic
LEDs. Heatsinks, fans, LED drivers,
power supplies, LED ribbon, kits, components, hardware, tritium markers. We
can order almost anything in! www.
ledsales.com.au
PCBs MADE, ONE OR MANY. Any
format, hobbyists welcome. Sesame
Electronics Phone 0434 781 191.
sesame<at>sesame.com.au
www.sesame.com.au
PCBs & Micros: SILICON CHIP can supply PCBs and programmed microcon-
trollers for all recent projects. Order from
our Online Shop at www.siliconchip.
com.au or phone (02) 9939 3295.
KIT ASSEMBLY & REPAIR
VINTAGE RADIO REPAIRS: electrical mechanical fitter with 36 years ex
perience and extensive knowledge of
valve and transistor radios. Professional
and reliable repairs. All workmanship
guaranteed. $10 inspection fee plus
charges for parts and labour as required.
Labour fees $35 p/h. Pensioner discounts available on application. Contact
Alan on 0425 122 415 or email bigal
radioshack<at>gmail.com
KEITH RIPPON KIT ASSEMBLY &
REPAIR:
* Australia & New Zealand;
* Small production runs.
Phone Keith 0409 662 794.
keith.rippon<at>gmail.com
WANTED
WANTED: EARLY HIFIs, AMPLIFIERS,
Speakers, Turntables, Valves, Books,
Quad, Leak, Pye, Lowther, Ortofon,
DOWNLOAD OUR CATALOG at
www.iinet.net.au/~worcom
WORLDWIDE ELECTRONIC COMPONENTS
PO Box 631, Hillarys, WA 6923
Ph: (08) 9307 7305 Fax: (08) 9307 7309
Email: worcom<at>iinet.net.au
KEEP YOUR COPIES OF
AS GOOD AS THE DAY
THEY WERE BORN!
ONLY
95
$
1P4LUS
p&p
A superb-looking
SILICON CHIP
binder will keep
your magazines in
pristine condition.
* Holds up to 14 issues
* Heavy duty vinyl
* Easy wire inserts
ORDER NOW AT
www.siliconchip.com.au/shop
SME, Western Electric, Altec, Marantz,
McIntosh, Tannoy, Goodmans, Wharfe
dale, radio and wireless. Collector/
Hobbyist will pay cash. (07) 5471 1062.
johnmurt<at>highprofile.com.au
ADVERTISING IN MARKET CENTRE
Classified Ad Rates: $32.00 for up to 20 words plus 95 cents for each additional word. Display ads in Market Centre
(minimum 2cm deep, maximum 10cm deep): $82.50 per column centimetre per insertion. All prices include GST.
Closing date: 5 weeks prior to month of sale. To book, email the text to silicon<at>siliconchip.com.au and include your
name, address & credit card details, or phone Glyn (02) 9939 3295 or 0431 792 293.
Ask SILICON CHIP
. . . continued from page 102
mediate frequencies in this project and
I also have no analog TV signals to test
if the TV tuner is working.
Some VHF/UHF scanners cost
just $100 so why bother with this?
Well, the idea is that it’s home-made
and not all frequencies are covered
by most VHF/UHF scanners; there
are frequency gaps between bands.
It could also be modified for radio
telescope work by adding a powerful
siliconchip.com.au
broadband RF preamplifier and dish.
And it could be used for DRM/digital
communications listening. I got this
idea from www.uzzors2k.4hv.org (J.
C., Mitchell Park, SA).
• There doesn’t seem much point
in using an old VHF/UHF tuner as
a scanner. PAL analog transmissions
have now ceased and all TV is digital.
If you want to scan all the bands,
the easiest and cheapest way is to use
a DVB-TV dongle with your computer,
as described in our story in the April
2013 issue. This theme was further
expanded in following issues with the
description of a software defined radio
(SDR). To see a preview of the April
story, go to www.siliconchip.com.au/
Issue/2013/April/How+To+Get+Digita
l+TV+On+Your+Laptop+Or+PC
VOX circuit
required
As a member of a volunteer emergency service, we have a bank of
transceivers, ie, 27MHz discrete VHF
channel sets. I am enquiring if there
is a kit in your vast storage of DIY kits
continued page 104
October 2014 103
Circuit Notebook – continued from page 74
the program to define each button.
As long as your measured values
for the A0 voltage fall comfortably
between the upper and lower limits
for each button, the buttons will be
successfully decoded. However, if
your measurement falls uncomfortably close to one limit, you will have
to alter the upper and lower limits
in the program to suit.
Ideally, choose limits so that they
are midway between your measured
values and there must be no gaps or
overlaps in the spread of the limits.
So, for example, the ideal value
for the upper limit for the memory
button would be (2.53 + 3.21) ÷ 2 =
2.87 and for the lower limit (2.53 +
1.85) ÷ 2 = 2.19. In the software, I
have used average limits that should
detect which button was pressed
regardless of whether a 5.6kΩ or
3.9kΩ resistor is used.
If you need to alter the limits they
are all found in the “instruction”
subroutine but there is also one line
in the main program loop: “if v <=
2.84 . . .” which may need changing.
When first turned on the GPS
unit will initially obtain a lock on
the available satellites and then the
program will display the current
Australian Eastern Standard Time on
both displays. If another time zone
is required, the program line: “Timezone = 10.0” needs to be modified
appropriately.
To set the alarm times, press any
of the five alarm setting keys. The
alarm ON HOUR time for SUNDAY is
first displayed on the LCD. Use the
UP and DOWN buttons to change to
the desired time. Pressing the ITEM
button will change the setting shown
to change successively to ON MIN-
UTE, OFF HOUR, OFF MINUTE and
finally cycle back to ON HOUR. All
these values can be changed with
the UP/DOWN buttons.
When satisfied that Sunday’s settings are correct, press the MEMORY
button and these values will be
saved to memory and the day will
advance to MONDAY. Proceed to
set individual alarms for each day
of the week and when each day has
been saved to memory press EXIT
to revert to normal time display
mode. This will also save the alarm
data to non-volatile memory so that
after a power failure the alarm data
is not lost and does not have to be
re-entered.
One practical point to note is that
you must be firm when pressing the
LCD’s microswitches. Because they
form part of the voltage divider chain
for A0, if they are tentatively pressed
they may introduce some contact
resistance of their own which will
cause a false voltage to occur at A0
– so be firm!
If switch S1 is set to ON, then
between the alarm ON and OFF
times set for each day, pin 14 on the
Micromite will turn on transistor
Q5, which in turn activates relay
RLY1 and supplies mains power the
GPO. The ‘ALARM ACTIVE’ LED also
lights as a visible indication that the
GPO is powered.
Power comes from a transformer
with a 9V secondary winding. A
bridge rectifier provides 10-12V DC
for the relay. Voltage regulators REG1
(7805, heatsink required) and REG2
(LM1117T) follow in series to supply
the 5V and 3.3V rails.
Jack Holliday,
Nathan, Qld. ($85)
Advertising Index
4D Systems Pty Ltd...................... 23
Altronics.........................loose insert
Blamey & Saunders Hearing.......... 9
Emona Instruments........................ 6
Hare & Forbes.............................. 41
Harbuch Electronics..................... 12
High Profile Communications..... 103
Icom Australia................................ 5
Jaycar .............................. IFC,49-56
Keith Rippon .............................. 103
Keysight Technologies.............. OBC
KitStop............................................ 8
LD Electronics............................ 103
LEDsales.................................... 103
Microchip Technology..................... 7
Mikroelektronika......................... IBC
Ocean Controls............................ 11
Quest Electronics....................... 103
Radio, TV & Hobbies DVD.............. 8
Rockby Electronics....................... 81
Rohde & Schwarz.......................... 3
Sesame Electronics................... 103
Silicon Chip Binders......... 71,91,103
Silicon Chip Online Shop............. 87
Silicon Chip PCBs........................ 39
Silicon Chip Subscriptions........... 57
Silvertone Electronics.................. 10
Wiltronics...................................... 13
Worldwide Elect. Components... 103
that will activate a LED when voltage
is applied to the speaker of a radio
set. This device will allow the radio
operator to identify the set that was
activated, while the operator may have
been distracted or temporarily out of
the room.
After trawling through your archives, the nearest project that may
do the job, with some major modifications, is the solar powered alarm that
was printed in the March 2010 edition.
I look forward to your valued opinion
104 Silicon Chip
as to a solution. (K. B., Hawkesbury,
NSW).
• A voice activated switch (VOX) is
what you need. This monitors signal
across the loudspeaker and switches a
relay (or LED in your case). A delay is
incorporated. We published a VOX in
September 1994 (Jaycar kit KC5172),
in July 2011 and in “Shorts Circuits
3” (Jaycar KJ8084).
For the September 1994 and “Short
Circuits 3” versions, you would need
a resistive attenuator to reduce the
signal level to the VOX from the
loudspeaker if you have a direct loudspeaker connection rather than the
electret microphone. The electret bias
resistor would be removed.
Photostat copies or back issues
can be purchased from our website.
A 1-page preview of the July 2011
article is at www.siliconchip.com.
au/Issue/2011/July/Build+A+VoiceSC
Activated+Relay+%28VOX%29
siliconchip.com.au
siliconchip.com.au
October 2014 105
|